qcrh20131231_10k.htm

 

U.S. SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549 

FORM 10-K

  

 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES

EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

Commission file number: 0-22208

 

QCR HOLDINGS, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 Delaware  

 

42-1397595 

(State of incorporation) 

 

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 

                                                                                                                                          

3551 7th Street, Moline, Illinois 61265

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

(309) 743-7761

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act:

Common stock, $1.00 Par Value The NASDAQ Global Market

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act:

Preferred Share Purchase Rights

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.          

 

Yes [   ]

No [ X ] 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act.                                                  

 

Yes [   ]

No [ X ]

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for past 90 days.

 

Yes [ X ]  

No [   ] 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).      

 

Yes [ X ]   

No [   ] 

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers in response to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. [   ]

 

 
 

 

  

 Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer [   ]  

Accelerated filer [   ]

Non-accelerated filer [   ]

Smaller reporting company [ X ]

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).                                              

 

Yes [   ]    

No [ X ]  

 

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant, based on the last sales price quoted on The NASDAQ Global Market on June 30, 2013, the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, was approximately $74,572,956.

 

As of February 28, 2014, the Registrant had outstanding 7,898,059 shares of common stock, $1.00 par value per share.

 

Documents incorporated by reference:

Part III of Form 10-K - Proxy statement for annual meeting of stockholders to be held in May 2014.

 

 
2

 

 

QCR HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

INDEX

 

                                                                 

     

Page

Number(s)

Part I

     
 

Item 1.

Business

4-13

 

Item 1A.

Risk Factors

13-23

 

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments

23

 

Item 2.

Properties

23

 

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

23

 

Item 4.

Mine Safety Disclosures

24

       

Part II

     
 

Item 5.

Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

24-25

 

Item 6.

Selected Financial Data

26

 

Item 7.

Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

27-58

 

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

58-59

 

Item 8.

Financial Statements

60-132

 

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

133

 

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures

133-136

 

Item 9B.

Other Information

136

       

Part III

     
 

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

136

 

Item 11.

Executive Compensation

136

 

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

136

 

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

137

 

Item 14.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

137

       

Part IV

     
 

Item 15.

Exhibits

137-140

       

Signatures

 

141-142

 

 
3

 

 

Part I

 

Item 1.     Business

 

General. QCR Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) is a multi-bank holding company headquartered in Moline, Illinois, that was formed in February 1993 under the laws of the state of Delaware. The Company serves the Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Waterloo/Cedar Falls and Rockford communities through the following three wholly-owned banking subsidiaries, which provide full-service commercial and consumer banking and trust and asset management services:

 

 

Quad City Bank and Trust Company (“QCBT”), which is based in Bettendorf, Iowa, and commenced operations in 1994;

 

Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company (“CRBT”), which is based in Cedar Rapids, Iowa, and commenced operations in 2001; and

 

Rockford Bank and Trust Company (“RB&T”), which is based in Rockford, Illinois, and commenced operations in 2005.

 

On May 13, 2013, the Company acquired Community National Bancorporation (“Community National”) and its banking subsidiary Community National Bank (“CNB”). Community National and CNB commenced operations in 1997 and historically provided full-service commercial and consumer banking, and trust and asset management services, to Cedar Falls, Mason City, and Waterloo, Iowa and Austin, Minnesota. At acquisition, CNB had a total of eight branch facilities with four in the Waterloo/Cedar Falls area where CNB was headquartered, two in Mason City, and two in Austin. On October 4, 2013, the Company finalized the sale of the two branches in Mason City. On October 11, 2013, the Company finalized the sale of the two branches in Austin. On October 26, 2013, CNB merged with and into CRBT. CNB’s merged branch offices operate as a division of CRBT under the name “Community Bank & Trust.” In December 2013, one of the branch facilities in Cedar Falls was closed due to lack of sufficient customer activity. See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion of the acquisition and sales of certain branches.

 

The Company also engages in direct financing lease contracts through m2 Lease Funds, LLC (“m2”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of QCBT based in Brookfield, Wisconsin. QCBT previously owned 80% of m2. In August 2012, QCBT entered into an amendment to the operating agreement of m2 and purchased the remaining 20% noncontrolling interest. See Note 22 to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion of the acquisition.

 

Velie Plantation Holding Company (“VPHC”), previously owned 91% by the Company, was engaged in holding the real estate property known as the Velie Plantation in Moline, Illinois, which is the location for the Company’s headquarters. In October 2012, the Company acquired the remaining 9% noncontrolling interest, and effective December 31, 2012, VPHC was dissolved and liquidated.

 

Quad City Bancard, Inc. (“Bancard”), previously a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, conducted the Company’s credit card issuing and merchant credit cards acquiring operations. During 2008, Bancard sold its merchant credit card acquiring business. The resulting gain on sale, net of taxes and related expenses, was approximately $3.0 million. The comparative financial results associated with the merchant credit card acquiring business have been reflected as discontinued operations throughout the annual report. Effective December 31, 2009, Bancard was dissolved and liquidated. The credit card issuing operation was merged in as a department of QCBT. In January 2013, QCBT sold its credit card portfolio (approximately $10.2 million in credit card loan receivables) and the related credit card issuing operations to a third party. In connection with the transaction, the Company recorded a pre-tax gain, net of transaction-related costs, of $593 thousand. See Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion of these sales.  

 

 
4

 

 

Subsidiary Banks. QCBT was capitalized on October 13, 1993, and commenced operations on January 7, 1994. QCBT is an Iowa-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System with depository accounts insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) to the maximum amount permitted by law. QCBT provides full service commercial and consumer banking and trust and asset management services in the Quad Cities and adjacent communities through its five offices that are located in Bettendorf and Davenport, Iowa and in Moline, Illinois. QCBT, on a consolidated basis with m2, had total segment assets of $1.25 billion and $1.18 billion as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

CRBT is an Iowa-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System with depository accounts insured by the FDIC to the maximum amount permitted by law. The Company commenced operations in Cedar Rapids in June 2001, operating a branch of QCBT. The Cedar Rapids branch operation then began functioning under the CRBT charter in September 2001. As previously discussed, the merged branches of CNB operate as a division of CRBT under the name “Community Bank & Trust.” CRBT provides full-service commercial and consumer banking and trust and asset management services to Cedar Rapids and Waterloo/Cedar Falls, Iowa and adjacent communities through its five facilities. The headquarters for CRBT is located in downtown Cedar Rapids with one other branch located in northern Cedar Rapids and two branches located in Waterloo and one branch located in Cedar Falls. CRBT had total segment assets of $804.2 million and $625.7 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

RB&T is an Illinois-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System with depository accounts insured by the FDIC to the maximum amount permitted by law. The Company commenced operations in Rockford, Illinois in September 2004, operating a branch of QCBT, and that operation began functioning under the RB&T charter in January 2005. RB&T provides full-service commercial and consumer banking and trust and asset management services to Rockford and adjacent communities through its headquarters located on Guilford Road at Alpine Road in Rockford and its branch facility located in downtown Rockford. RB&T had total segment assets of $339.4 million and $313.8 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

See Note 21 to the consolidated financial statements for additional business segment information.

 

Other Operating Subsidiaries. m2, which is based in Brookfield, Wisconsin, is engaged in the business of leasing machinery and equipment to commercial and industrial businesses under direct financing lease contracts. On August 26, 2005, QCBT acquired 80% of the membership units of m2. John Engelbrecht, the Chief Executive Officer of m2, retained 20% of the membership units. On August 31, 2012, QCBT acquired the 20% noncontrolling interest previously owned by John Engelbrecht.

 

VPHC was engaged in holding the real estate property known as the Velie Plantation Mansion in Moline, Illinois. Beginning in 1998, the Company held a 20% equity investment in VPHC. The Company acquired additional membership units in 2006 (37%), in 2009 (16%), and in 2010 (18%), bringing its total equity investment to 91%. During the fourth quarter of 2012, the Company acquired the remaining 9% noncontrolling interest and, effective as of December 31, 2012, VPHC was dissolved and liquidated.  

 

 
5

 

 

Trust Preferred Subsidiaries. As part of the acquisition of Community National during 2013, the Company acquired two new non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities. Following is a listing of the Company’s non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities, including pertinent information as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

Name

Date Issued

 

Amount Issued

 

Interest Rate

 

Interest

Rate as of

12/31/13

   

Interest

Rate as of

12/31/12

 

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust II

February 2004

  $ 12,372,000  

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

    3.10 %     3.21 %

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust III

February 2004

    8,248,000  

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

    3.10 %     3.21 %

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust IV

May 2005

    5,155,000  

1.80% over 3-month LIBOR

    2.04 %     2.14 %

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust V

February 2006

    10,310,000  

1.55% over 3-month LIBOR

    1.79 %     1.89 %
Community National Statutory Trust II September 2004     3,093,000   2.17% over 3-month LIBOR     2.42 %     N/A  
Community National Statutory Trust III March 2007     3,609,000   1.75% over 3-month LIBOR     1.99 %     N/A  
        42,787,000   Weighted Average Rate     2.51 %     2.68 %

 

Securities issued by all of the trusts listed above mature thirty years from the date of issuance, but are all currently callable at par at anytime.

 

Other Ownership Interests. The Company invests limited amounts of its capital in stocks of financial institutions and mutual funds. In addition to its wholly-owned subsidiaries, the Company owns a 20% equity position in Nobel Real Estate Investors, LLC. In June 2005, CRBT entered into a joint venture as a 50% owner of Cedar Rapids Mortgage Company, LLC which provided residential real estate mortgage lending services. During the first quarter of 2013, CRBT and the partner mutually terminated the joint venture. CRBT continues to provide residential real estate mortgage lending services through its consumer banking division.

 

The Company previously owned a 2.25% equity investment in Trisource Solutions, LLC (“Trisource”). On July 2, 2010, the Company exercised a put option and sold its equity investment back to the majority owner of Trisource for $750 thousand received in monthly installments of $10 thousand through July 2012, and a final balloon payment of $584 thousand received in August 2012. The gain (materially all of the sales proceeds) was recognized on a cash basis.

 

Business. The Company’s principal business consists of attracting deposits and investing those deposits in loans/leases and securities. The deposits of the subsidiary banks are insured to the maximum amount allowable by the FDIC. The Company’s results of operations are dependent primarily on net interest income, which is the difference between the interest earned on its loans/leases and securities and the interest paid on deposits and borrowings. The Company’s operating results are affected by economic and competitive conditions, particularly changes in interest rates, government policies and actions of regulatory authorities, as described more fully in this Form 10-K. Its operating results also can be affected by trust fees, investment advisory and management fees, deposit service charge fees, gains on the sale of residential real estate and government guaranteed loans, earnings from bank-owned life insurance (“BOLI”) and other income. Operating expenses include employee compensation and benefits, occupancy and equipment expense, professional and data processing fees, advertising and marketing expenses, bank service charges, FDIC and other insurance, loan/lease expenses and other administrative expenses.

 

The Company and its subsidiaries collectively employed 400 and 356 full-time equivalents (“FTEs”) at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The majority of the increase in FTEs during 2013 was the result of the acquisition of Community National.

 

The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”) is the primary federal regulator of the Company and its subsidiaries. In addition, QCBT and CRBT are regulated by the Iowa Superintendent of Banking (“Iowa Superintendent”) and RB&T is regulated by the State of Illinois Department of Financial and Professional Regulation (“DFPR”). The FDIC, as administrator of the Deposit Insurance Fund, also has regulatory authority over the subsidiary banks.

 

 
6

 

 

Lending/Leasing. The Company and its subsidiaries provide a broad range of commercial and retail lending and investment services to corporations, partnerships, individuals, and government agencies. The subsidiary banks actively market their services to qualified lending and deposit clients. Officers actively solicit the business of new clients entering their market areas as well as long-standing members of the local business community. The Company has an established lending/leasing policy which includes a number of underwriting factors to be considered in making a loan/lease, including, but not limited to, location, loan-to-value ratio, cash flow, collateral and the credit history of the borrower.

 

In accordance with Iowa regulation, the legal lending limit to one borrower for QCBT and CRBT, calculated as 15% of aggregate capital, was $15.0 million and $9.0 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2013. In accordance with Illinois regulation, the legal lending limit to one borrower for RB&T, calculated as 25% of aggregate capital, totaled $9.9 million as of December 31, 2013.

 

The Company recognizes the need to prevent excessive concentrations of credit exposure to any one borrower or group of related borrowers. As such, the Company has established an in-house lending limit, which is lower than each subsidiary bank’s legal lending limit, in an effort to manage individual borrower exposure levels.

 

The in-house lending limit is the maximum amount of credit each subsidiary bank will extend to a single borrowing entity or group of related entities. Under the in-house limit, total credit exposure to a single borrowing entity or group of related entities will not exceed the following, subject to certain exceptions:

 

Quad City Bank & Trust:  

$ 10.0 million 

Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust: 

$ 7.5 million  

Rockford Bank & Trust: 

$ 3.7 million  

                

On a consolidated basis, the in-house lending limit is $15.0 million, which is the maximum amount of credit that all affiliated banks, when combined, will extend to a single borrowing entity or group of related entities, subject to certain exceptions.

 

In addition, m2’s in-house lending limit is $1.0 million to a single leasing entity or group of related entities.

 

As part of the loan monitoring activity at the three subsidiary banks, credit administration personnel interact closely with senior bank management. For example, the internal loan committee of each subsidiary bank meets weekly. The Company has a separate in-house loan review function to analyze credits of the subsidiary banks. To complement the in-house loan review, an independent third-party performs external loan reviews. Management has attempted to identify problem loans at an early stage and to aggressively seek a resolution of those situations.

 

The Company recognizes that a diversified loan/lease portfolio contributes to reducing risk in the overall loan/lease portfolio. The specific loan/lease portfolio mix is subject to change based on loan/lease demand, the business environment and various economic factors. The Company actively monitors concentrations within the loan/lease portfolio to ensure appropriate diversification and concentration risk is maintained.  

 

 
7

 

 

Specifically, each subsidiary bank’s total loans as a percentage of average assets may not exceed 85%. In addition, following are established policy limits and the actual allocations for the three subsidiary banks as of December 31, 2013 for the loan portfolio on a per loan type basis, reflected as a percentage of the subsidiary bank’s average gross loans: 

 

           

As of December 31, 2013

 

Type of Loan *

 

Maximum

Percentage per

Loan Policy **

   

QCBT

   

CRBT

   

RB&T

 
                                 

One-to-four family residential

    30 %     15 %     13 %     21 %

Multi-family

    15 %     3 %     7 %     3 %

Farmland

    5 %     0 %     2 %     0 %

Non-farm, nonresidential

    50 %     25 %     41 %     45 %

Construction and land development

    20 %     6 %     5 %     5 %

Commercial and industrial

    60 %     21 %     26 %     24 %

Loans to individuals

    10 %     1 %     2 %     1 %

Lease financing

    20 %     20 %     0 %     0 %

All other loans

    15 %     9 %     4 %     1 %
              100 %     100 %     100 %
                                 

Bank stock loans ***

    15 %     7 %     2 %     0 %

 

* The loan types above are as defined and reported in the subsidiary banks’ quarterly Reports of Condition and Income (also known as Call Reports).

** The maximum percentages listed are the same for all subsidiary banks except for CRBT, where the maximum percentage for one-to-four family residential is 25%, the maximum percentage for construction and land development is 15%, and the maximum percentage for lease financing receivables is 5%. Additionally, both CRBT and RB&T have maximum percentages for all other loans and bank stock loans of 10%.

*** Bank stock loans are not a separate reportable line item on the Call Reports. The loans are reported within “all other loans” above.

 

The following table presents total loans/leases by major loan/lease type and subsidiary as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. Residential real estate loans held for sale are included in residential real estate loans below.  

 

   

Quad City

   

m2

   

Cedar Rapids

   

Rockford

   

Intercompany

   

Consolidated

 
   

Bank & Trust

   

Lease Funds

   

Bank & Trust

   

Bank & Trust

   

Elimination

   

Total

 
       $    

%

      $    

%

      $    

%

      $    

%

      $       $    

%

 

As of December 31, 2013:

 

(dollars in thousands)

 
                                                                                         

Commercial and industrial loans

  $ 209,150       38 %   $ -       0 %   $ 161,032       31 %   $ 61,506       24 %   $ -     $ 431,688       30 %

Commercial real estate loans

    239,965       44 %     -       0 %     290,625       55 %     142,819       57 %     (1,656 )     671,753       46 %

Direct financing leases

    -       0 %     128,902       96 %     -       0 %     -       0 %     -       128,902       9 %

Residential real estate loans

    65,678       12 %     -       0 %     45,457       9 %     36,221       14 %     -       147,356       10 %

Installment and other consumer loans

    36,791       7 %     -       0 %     28,427       5 %     10,816       4 %     -       76,034       5 %

Deferred loan/lease origination costs, net of fees

    45       0 %     4,814       4 %     (537 )     0 %     225       0 %     -       4,547       0 %
    $ 551,629       100 %   $ 133,716       100 %   $ 525,004       100 %   $ 251,587       100 %   $ (1,656 )   $ 1,460,280       100 %

As of December 31, 2012:

                                                                                       
                                                                                         

Commercial and industrial loans

  $ 203,542       36 %   $ -       0 %   $ 130,261       35 %   $ 60,441       26 %   $ -     $ 394,244       31 %

Commercial real estate loans

    258,133       45 %     -       0 %     201,659       54 %     136,025       58 %     (1,838 )     593,979       46 %

Direct financing leases

    -       0 %     103,686       96 %     -       0 %     -       0 %     -       103,686       8 %

Residential real estate loans

    60,666       11 %     -       0 %     27,863       7 %     27,053       11 %     -       115,582       9 %

Installment and other consumer loans

    47,621       8 %     -       0 %     17,425       4 %     11,675       5 %     -       76,721       6 %

Deferred loan/lease origination costs, net of fees

    (77 )     0 %     3,907       4 %     (738 )     0 %     84       0 %     -       3,176       0 %
    $ 569,885       100 %   $ 107,593       100 %   $ 376,470       100 %   $ 235,278       100 %   $ (1,838 )   $ 1,287,388       100 %

 

Proper pricing of loans is necessary to provide adequate return to the Company’s stockholders. Loan pricing, as established by the subsidiary banks’ internal loan committees, shall include consideration for the cost of funds, loan maturity and risk, origination and maintenance costs, appropriate stockholder return, competitive factors, and the economic environment. The portfolio contains a mix of loans with fixed and floating interest rates. Management attempts to maximize the use of interest rate floors on its variable rate loan portfolio. Refer to Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk for more discussion on the Company’s management of interest rate risk.

 

 
8

 

 

Commercial and Industrial Lending

 

As noted above, the subsidiary banks are active commercial and industrial lenders. The current areas of emphasis include loans to small and mid-sized businesses with a wide range of operations such as wholesalers, manufacturers, building contractors, business services companies, other banks, and retailers. The banks provide a wide range of business loans, including lines of credit for working capital and operational purposes, and term loans for the acquisition of facilities, equipment and other purposes. Since 2010, the subsidiary banks have been active in participating in lending programs offered by the Small Business Administration (“SBA”) and the United States Department of Agriculture (“USDA”). Under these programs, the government entities will generally provide a guarantee of repayment ranging from 50% to 85% of the principal amount of the qualifying loan.

 

Loan approval is generally based on the following factors:

 

 

Ability and stability of current management of the borrower;

 

Stable earnings with positive financial trends;

 

Sufficient cash flow to support debt repayment;

 

Earnings projections based on reasonable assumptions;

 

Financial strength of the industry and business; and

 

Value and marketability of collateral.

 

For commercial and industrial loans, the Company assigns internal risk ratings which are largely dependent upon the aforementioned approval factors. The risk rating is reviewed annually or on an as needed basis depending on the specific circumstances of the loan. See Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information, including the internal risk rating scale.

 

As part of the underwriting process, management reviews current borrower financial statements. When appropriate, certain commercial and industrial loans may contain covenants requiring maintenance of financial performance ratios such as, but not limited to:

 

 

Minimum debt service coverage ratio;

 

Minimum current ratio;

 

Maximum debt to tangible net worth ratio; and/or

 

Minimum tangible net worth.

 

Establishment of these financial performance ratios depends on a number of factors, including risk rating and the specific industry.

 

Collateral for these loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory, equipment, and real estate. The lending policy specifies approved collateral types and corresponding maximum advance percentages. The value of collateral pledged on loans must exceed the loan amount by a margin sufficient to absorb potential erosion of its value in the event of foreclosure and cover the loan amount plus costs incurred to convert it to cash. Approved non-real estate collateral types and corresponding maximum advance percentages for each are listed below.

 

Approved Collateral Type  

 

Maximum Advance %   

     

Financial Instruments 

 

 

U.S. Government Securities    

 

90% of market value 

Securities of Federal Agencies

 

90% of market value 

Municipal Bonds rated by Moody’s As “A” or better 

 

80% of market value 

Listed Stocks 

 

75% of market value 

Mutual Funds 

 

75% of market value 

Cash Value Life Insurance 

 

95%, less policy loans 

Savings/Time Deposits (Bank) 

 

100% of current value 

 

 

 

General Business    
Accounts Receivable   80% of eligible account
 Inventory   50% of value
Fixed Assets (Existing)    50% of net book value, or
    75% of orderly liquidation appraised value
Fixed Assets (New)  

80% of cost

Leasehold Improvements   0%

 

 
9

 

 

Generally, if the above collateral is part of a cross-collateralization with other approved assets, then the maximum advance percentage may be higher.

 

The lending policy specifies maximum term limits for commercial and industrial loans. For term loans, the maximum term is generally 7 years. Generally, term loans range from 3 to 5 years. For lines of credit, the maximum term is typically 365 days.

 

In addition, the subsidiary banks often take personal guarantees or cosignors to help assure repayment. Loans may be made on an unsecured basis if warranted by the overall financial condition of the borrower.

 

Commercial Real Estate Lending

 

The subsidiary banks also make commercial real estate loans. Commercial real estate loans are subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial and industrial loans, in addition to those standards and processes specific to real estate loans. Collateral for these loans generally includes the underlying real estate and improvements, and may include additional assets of the borrower. The lending policy specifies maximum loan-to-value limits based on the category of commercial real estate (commercial real estate loans on improved property, raw land, land development, and commercial construction). These limits are the same limits as, or in some situations, more conservative than, those established by regulatory authorities. Following is a listing of these limits as well as some of the other guidelines included in the lending policy for the major categories of commercial real estate loans:

 

Commercial Real Estate Loan Types

 

Maximum Advance Rate **

 

Maximum

Term

Commercial Real Estate Loans on Improved Property *

 

80%

 

7 years

Raw Land

 

Lesser of 90% of project cost, or 65% of

"as is" appraised value

 

12 months

Land Development

 

Lesser of 90% of project cost, or 75% of

appraised value

 

24 months

Commerical Construction Loans

 

Lesser of 90% of project cost, or 80% of

appraised value

 

365 days

 

* Generally, the debt service coverage ratio must be a minimum of 1.25x for non-owner occupied loans and 1.15x for owner-occupied loans. For loans greater than $500 thousand, the subsidiary banks sensitivity test this ratio for deteriorated economic conditions, major changes in interest rates, and/or significant increases in vacancy rates.

** These maximum rates are consistent with, or in some situations, more conservative than, those established by regulatory authorities.

 

The lending policy also includes guidelines for real estate appraisals and evaluations, including minimum appraisal and evaluation standards based on certain transactions. In addition, the subsidiary banks often take personal guarantees to help assure repayment.

 

In addition, management tracks the level of owner-occupied commercial real estate loans versus non-owner occupied loans. Owner-occupied loans are generally considered to have less risk. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, approximately 39% and 35%, respectively, of the commercial real estate loan portfolio was owner-occupied.

 

 
10

 

 

The Company’s lending policy limits non-owner occupied commercial real estate lending to 300% of total risk-based capital, and limits construction, land development, and other land loans to 100% of total risk-based capital. Exceeding these limits warrants the use of heightened risk management practices in accordance with regulatory guidelines. As of December 31, 2013, all three subsidiary banks were in compliance with these limits.

 

Following is a listing of the significant industries within the Company’s commercial real estate loan portfolio as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Lessors of Nonresidential Buildings

  $ 229,284       34 %   $ 178,060       30 %

Lessors of Residential Buildings

    64,659       10 %     61,460       10 %

Land Subdivision

    29,117       4 %     28,854       5 %

Hotels

    20,975       3 %     26,710       4 %

Nursing Care Facilities

    19,212       3 %     9,050       2 %

New Car Dealers

    16,597       2 %     27,079       5 %

Lessors of Other Real Estate Property

    15,509       2 %     12,765       2 %

Other *

    276,400       42 %     250,001       42 %

Total Commercial Real Estate Loans

  $ 671,753       100 %   $ 593,979       100 %

 

* “Other” consists of all other industries. None of these had concentrations greater than $15.0 million, or 2% of total commercial real estate loans.

 

Direct Financing Leasing

 

m2 leases machinery and equipment to commercial and industrial customers under direct financing leases. All lease requests are subject to the credit requirements and criteria as set forth in the lending/leasing policy. In all cases, a formal independent credit analysis of the lessee is performed.

 

The following private and public sector business assets are generally acceptable to consider for lease funding:

 

 

Computer systems;

 

Photocopy systems;

 

Fire trucks;

 

Specialized road maintenance equipment;

 

Medical equipment;

 

Commercial business furnishings;

 

Vehicles classified as heavy equipment;

 

Aircraft;

 

Equipment classified as plant or office equipment; and

 

Marine boat lifts.

 

m2 will generally refrain from funding leases of the following type:

 

 

Leases collateralized by non-marketable items;

 

Leases collateralized by consumer items, such as vehicles, household goods, recreational vehicles, boats, etc.;

 

Leases collateralized by used equipment, unless its remaining useful life can be readily determined; and

 

Leases with a repayment schedule exceeding 7 years.

 

 
11

 

 

Residential Real Estate Lending

 

Generally, the subsidiary banks’ residential real estate loans conform to the underwriting requirements of Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae to allow the subsidiary banks to resell loans in the secondary market. The subsidiary banks structure most loans that will not conform to those underwriting requirements as adjustable rate mortgages that adjust in one to five years, and then retain these loans in their portfolios. During 2011 and 2012, the subsidiary banks originated and held a limited amount of 15-year fixed rate residential real estate loans that met certain credit guidelines. Servicing rights are not presently retained on the loans sold in the secondary market. The lending policy establishes minimum appraisal and other credit guidelines.

 

As mentioned above, the subsidiary banks sell the majority of their residential real estate loans in the secondary market. The following table presents the originations and sales of residential real estate loans for the Company.

   

For the year ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Originations of residential real estate loans

  $ 62,691     $ 151,676     $ 117,914  

Sales of residential real estate loans

  $ 56,103     $ 104,740     $ 83,926  

Percentage of sales to originations

    89 %     69 %     71 %

 

 

Installment and Other Consumer Lending

 

The consumer lending department of each subsidiary bank provides many types of consumer loans, including home improvement, home equity, motor vehicle, signature loans and small personal credit lines. The lending policy addresses specific credit guidelines by consumer loan type. In particular, for home equity loans and home equity lines of credit, the minimum credit bureau score is 680. For both home equity loans and lines of credit, the maximum advance rate is 90% of value with a minimum credit bureau score of 720, and the maximum advance rate is 80% of value with a credit bureau score of 680 to 719. The maximum term on home equity loans is 10 years and maximum amortization is 15 years. The maximum term on home equity lines of credit is 5 years.

 

*****

 

In some instances for all loans/leases, it may be appropriate to originate or purchase loans/leases that are exceptions to the guidelines and limits established within the lending policy described above. In general, exceptions to the lending policy do not significantly deviate from the guidelines and limits established within the lending policy and, if there are exceptions, they are generally noted as such and specifically identified in loan/lease approval documents.

 

 

Competition. The Company currently operates in the highly competitive Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, and Rockford markets. Competitors include not only other commercial banks, credit unions, thrift institutions, and mutual funds, but also insurance companies, finance companies, brokerage firms, investment banking companies, and a variety of other financial services and advisory companies. Many of these competitors are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as the Company. Many of these unregulated competitors compete across geographic boundaries and provide customers increasing access to meaningful alternatives to banking services. The Company competes in markets with a number of much larger financial institutions with substantially greater resources and larger lending limits.

 

Appendices. The commercial banking business is a highly regulated business. See Appendix A for a summary of the federal and state statutes and regulations that are applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries. Supervision, regulation and examination of banks and bank holding companies by bank regulatory agencies are intended primarily for the protection of depositors rather than stockholders of bank holding companies and banks.

 

See Appendix B for tables and schedules that show selected comparative statistical information relating to the business of the Company required to be presented pursuant to federal securities laws. Consistent with the information presented in the Form 10-K, results are presented for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

 
12

 

 

Internet Site, Securities Filings and Governance Documents. The Company maintains Internet sites for itself and each of its three banking subsidiaries. The Company makes available free of charge through these sites its annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and other reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 after it electronically files such material with, or furnishes it to, the Securities and Exchange Commission. Also available are many of its corporate governance documents, including the Code of Conduct and Ethics Policy. The sites are www.qcrh.com, www.qcbt.com, www.crbt.com, and www.rkfdbank.com.

 

 

Item 1A. Risk Factors  

 

In addition to the other information in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, stockholders or prospective investors should carefully consider the following risk factors:

 

Difficult market conditions have affected the financial industry and may adversely affect us in the future.

 

Dramatic declines in the U.S. housing market over the past few years, with falling home prices and increasing foreclosures, unemployment and under-employment, have negatively impacted the credit performance of mortgage loans and resulted in significant write-downs of asset values by financial institutions, including government-sponsored entities as well as major commercial banks and investment banks.  These write-downs, initially of mortgage-backed securities but spreading to credit default swaps and other derivative and cash securities, in turn, have caused many financial institutions to seek additional capital from private and government entities, to merge with larger and stronger financial institutions and, in some cases, to fail. While these challenges are generally less severe than in recent years, their impact continues to be felt.

 

Reflecting concern about the stability of the financial markets in general and the strength of counterparties, many lenders and institutional investors have reduced or ceased providing funding to borrowers, including other financial institutions.  This market turmoil and tightening of credit have led to an increased level of commercial and consumer delinquencies, erosion of consumer confidence, increased market volatility and widespread reduction of business activity in general.  The resulting economic pressure on consumers and erosion of confidence in the financial markets has already adversely affected our industry and may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.  Although we believe that these difficult conditions in the financial markets have recently improved, a worsening of these conditions would likely exacerbate the adverse effects of these difficult market conditions on us and other financial institutions.  In particular, we may face the following risks in connection with these events:

 

 

Our ability to assess the creditworthiness of our customers may be impaired if the models and approaches we use to select, manage and underwrite the loans become less predictive of future behaviors.

 

 

The models used to estimate losses inherent in the credit exposure require difficult, subjective, and complex judgments, including forecasts of economic conditions and how these economic predictions might impair the ability of the borrowers to repay their loans, which may no longer be capable of accurate estimation and which may, in turn, impact the reliability of the models.

 

 

Our ability to borrow from other financial institutions or to engage in sales of mortgage loans to third parties on favorable terms, or at all, could be adversely affected by further disruptions in the capital markets or other events, including deteriorating investor expectations.

 

 

Competitive dynamics in the industry could change as a result of consolidation of financial services companies in connection with current market conditions.

 

 

We expect to face increased regulation of our industry.  Compliance with such regulation may increase our costs and limit our ability to pursue business opportunities.

 

 
13

 

 

 

We expect to face increased capital requirements, both at the Company level and at each of the subsidiary banks.  In this regard, the Collins Amendment to the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) requires the federal banking agencies to establish minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements that will apply to both insured banks and their holding companies. Furthermore, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, in September 2010 announced an agreement to a strengthened set of capital requirements for internationally active banking organizations, known as Basel III. In July 2013, the U.S. banking authorities approved the implementation of the Basel III regulatory capital reforms and issued rules effecting certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act. The increased capital requirements may limit our ability to pursue business opportunities and adversely affect our results of operations and growth prospects.

  

 

We may be required to pay significantly higher FDIC premiums because market developments have significantly depleted the Deposit Insurance Fund, or DIF, and reduced the ratio of reserves to insured deposits. Furthermore, the Dodd-Frank Act requires the FDIC to increase the DIF’s reserves against future losses, which will necessitate increased assessments on depository institutions.  Although the precise impact on us will not be clear until implementing rules are issued, any future increases in assessments applicable to us will decrease our earnings and could have a material adverse effect on the value of, or market for, our common stock.

 

If current levels of market disruption and volatility continue or worsen to recessionary conditions, and/or if negative developments in the domestic and international credit markets continue, there can be no assurance that we will not experience an adverse effect, which may be material, on our ability to access capital and on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

The acquisition of Community National, and potential future acquisitions, could be difficult to integrate, divert the attention of key personnel, disrupt our business, dilute stockholder value and adversely affect our financial results.

 

On May 13, 2013, we acquired Community National and CNB. As part of our business strategy, we may consider acquisitions of other banks or financial institutions or branches, assets or deposits of such organizations. There is no assurance, however, that we will determine to pursue any of these opportunities or that if we determine to pursue them that we will be successful.  Acquisitions involve numerous risks, any of which could harm our business, including:

 

 

difficulties in integrating the operations, technologies, products, existing contracts, accounting processes and personnel of the target company and realizing the anticipated synergies of the combined businesses;

 

 

difficulties in supporting and transitioning customers of the target company;

 

 

diversion of financial and management resources from existing operations;

 

 

the price we pay or other resources that we devote may exceed the value we realize, or the value we could have realized if we had allocated the purchase price or other resources to another opportunity;

 

 

risks of entering new markets or areas in which we have limited or no experience or are outside our core competencies;

 

 

potential loss of key employees, customers and strategic alliances from either our current business or the business of the target company;

 

 

assumption of unanticipated problems or latent liabilities; and

 

 

inability to generate sufficient revenue to offset acquisition costs.

 

Future acquisitions may involve the issuance of our equity securities as payment or in connection with financing the business or assets acquired, and as a result, could dilute the ownership interests of existing stockholders. In addition, consummating these transactions could result in the incurrence of additional debt and related interest expense, as well as unforeseen liabilities, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. The failure to successfully evaluate and execute acquisitions or otherwise adequately address the risks associated with acquisitions could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. 

 

 
14

 

 

We must effectively manage our credit risk.

 

There are risks inherent in making any loan, including risks inherent in dealing with specific borrowers, risks of nonpayment, risks resulting from uncertainties as to the future value of collateral and risks resulting from changes in economic and industry conditions. We attempt to minimize our credit risk through prudent loan application approval procedures, careful monitoring of the concentration of our loans within specific industries and periodic independent reviews of outstanding loans by our credit review department and an external third party. However, we cannot assure you that such approval and monitoring procedures will reduce these credit risks.

 

The majority of our subsidiary banks’ loan portfolios are invested in commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans, and we focus on lending to small to medium-sized businesses. The size of the loans we can offer to commercial customers is less than the size of the loans that our competitors with larger lending limits can offer. This may limit our ability to establish relationships with the area’s largest businesses. Smaller companies tend to be at a competitive disadvantage and generally have limited operating histories, less sophisticated internal record keeping and financial planning capabilities and fewer financial resources than larger companies. As a result, we may assume greater lending risks than financial institutions that have a lesser concentration of such loans and tend to make loans to larger, more established businesses. Collateral for these loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate. However, depending on the overall financial condition of the borrower, some loans are made on an unsecured basis. In addition to commercial and commercial real estate loans, our subsidiary banks are also active in residential mortgage and consumer lending. Should the economic climate fail to meaningfully improve or if it worsens, our borrowers may experience financial difficulties, and the level of nonperforming loans, charge-offs and delinquencies could rise, which could negatively impact our business through increased provision for loan/lease losses (“provision”), reduced interest income on loans/leases, and increased expenses incurred to carry and resolve problem loans/leases.

 

Commercial and industrial loans make up a large portion of our loan/lease portfolio.

 

Commercial and industrial loans were $431.7 million, or approximately 30% of our total loan/lease portfolio, as of December 31, 2013. Our commercial and industrial loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Most often, this collateral is accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate. Credit support provided by the borrower for most of these loans and the probability of repayment is based on the liquidation value of the pledged collateral and enforcement of a personal guarantee, if any exists. Whenever possible, we require a personal guarantee on commercial loans. As a result, in the case of loans secured by accounts receivable, the availability of funds for the repayment of these loans may be substantially dependent on the ability of the borrower to collect amounts due from its customers. The collateral securing these loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise, and may fluctuate in value based on the success of the business. In addition, if the U.S. economy experiences a prolonged recovery period, it could harm or continue to harm the businesses of our commercial and industrial customers and reduce the value of the collateral securing these loans.

 

Our loan/lease portfolio has a significant concentration of commercial real estate loans, which involve risks specific to real estate values.

 

Commercial real estate lending comprises a significant portion of our lending business. Specifically, commercial real estate loans were $671.8 million, or approximately 46% of our total loan/lease portfolio, as of December 31, 2013. Of this amount, $261.2 million, or approximately 39%, was owner-occupied. The market value of real estate securing our commercial real estate loans can fluctuate significantly in a short period of time as a result of market conditions in the geographic area in which the real estate is located Adverse developments affecting real estate values in one or more of our markets could increase the credit risk associated with our loan portfolio. Additionally, real estate lending typically involves higher loan principal amounts and the repayment of the loans generally is dependent, in large part, on sufficient income from the properties securing the loans to cover operating expenses and debt service. Economic events or governmental regulations outside of the control of the borrower or lender could negatively impact the future cash flow and market values of the affected properties.

 

 
15

 

 

The problems that have occurred in the residential real estate and mortgage markets throughout much of the U.S. in prior years also affected the commercial real estate market. In our market areas, we generally experienced a downturn in credit performance by our commercial real estate loan customers in prior years relative to historical norms, and despite recent improvements in certain aspects of the economy, a level of uncertainty continues to exist in the economy and credit markets, there can be no guarantee that we will not experience further deterioration in the performance of commercial real estate and other real estate loans in the future. In such case, we may not be able to realize the amount of security that we anticipated at the time of originating the loan, which could cause us to increase our provision and adversely affect our operating results, financial condition and/or capital.

 

Our allowance for loan/lease losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb losses in our loan/lease portfolio.

 

We establish our allowance for loan/lease losses (“allowance”) in consultation with management of our subsidiaries and maintain it at a level considered adequate by management to absorb loan/lease losses that are inherent in the portfolio. The amount of future loan/lease losses is susceptible to changes in economic, operating and other conditions, including changes in interest rates, which may be beyond our control, and such losses may exceed current estimates. At December 31, 2013, our allowance as a percentage of total gross loans/leases was 1.47%, and as a percentage of total nonperforming loans/leases was approximately 104.70%. In addition, we had net charge-offs as a percentage of gross average loans/leases of 0.31% for the year ended December 31, 2013. Because of the concentration of commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans in our loan portfolio, which tend to be larger in amount than residential real estate and installment loans, the movement of a small number of loans to nonperforming status can have a significant impact on this ratio. Although management believes that the allowance as of December 31, 2013 was adequate to absorb losses on any existing loans/leases that may become uncollectible, in light of the current economic environment, which remains challenging, we cannot predict loan/lease losses with certainty, and we cannot assure you that our allowance will prove sufficient to cover actual loan/lease losses in the future, particularly if economic conditions are more difficult than what management currently expects. Additional provisions and loan/lease losses in excess of our allowance may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

System failure or breaches of our network security could subject us to increased operating costs as well as litigation and other liabilities.

 

The computer systems and network infrastructure we use could be vulnerable to unforeseen problems. Our operations are dependent upon our ability to protect our computer equipment against damage from physical theft, fire, power loss, telecommunications failure or a similar catastrophic event, as well as from security breaches, denial of service attacks, viruses, worms and other disruptive problems caused by hackers. Any damage or failure that causes an interruption in our operations could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Computer break-ins, phishing and other disruptions could also jeopardize the security of information stored in and transmitted through our computer systems and network infrastructure, as well as that of our customers engaging in internet banking activities, which may result in significant liability to us and may cause existing and potential customers to refrain from doing business with us. Although we, with the help of third-party service providers, intend to continue to implement security technology and establish operational procedures to prevent such damage, there can be no assurance that these security measures will be successful. In addition, advances in computer capabilities, new discoveries in the field of cryptography or other developments could result in a compromise or breach of the algorithms we and our third-party service providers use to encrypt and protect customer transaction data. Any interruption in, or breach of security of, our computer systems and network infrastructure, or that of our internet banking customers, could damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose us to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

 
16

 

 

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer or employee fraud and data processing system failures and errors.

 

Employee errors and employee and customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation. Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information. It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases. Employee errors could also subject us to financial claims for negligence.

 

We maintain a system of internal controls and insurance coverage to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud. Should our internal controls fail to prevent or detect an occurrence, and if any resulting loss is not insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits, such failure could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

We may be materially and adversely affected by the highly regulated environment in which we operate.

 

The Company and its bank subsidiaries are subject to extensive federal and state regulation, supervision and examination. Banking regulations are primarily intended to protect depositors’ funds, FDIC funds, customers and the banking system as a whole, rather than stockholders. These regulations affect our lending practices, capital structure, investment practices, dividend policy and growth, among other things.

 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to regulation and supervision primarily by the Federal Reserve. QCBT and CRBT, as Iowa-chartered state member banks, are subject to regulation and supervision primarily by both the Iowa Superintendent and the Federal Reserve. RB&T, as an Illinois-chartered state member bank, is subject to regulation and supervision primarily by both the DFPR and the Federal Reserve. We and our banks undergo periodic examinations by these regulators, who have extensive discretion and authority to prevent or remedy unsafe or unsound practices or violations of law by banks and bank holding companies.

 

The primary federal and state banking laws and regulations that affect us are described in Appendix A to this report. These laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies and interpretations are constantly evolving and may change significantly over time. For example, on July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law, which significantly changed the regulation of financial institutions and the financial services industry. The Dodd-Frank Act, together with the regulations to be developed thereunder, includes provisions affecting large and small financial institutions alike, including several provisions that affect how community banks, thrifts and small bank and thrift holding companies are and will be regulated. In addition, in recent years the Federal Reserve has adopted numerous new regulations addressing banks’ overdraft and mortgage lending practices. Further, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau was recently established, with broad powers to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws, and additional consumer protection legislation and regulatory activity is anticipated in the near future.

 

In September 2010, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, adopted Basel III, which constitutes a strengthened set of capital requirements for banking organizations in the U.S. and around the world. In July 2013, the U.S. federal banking authorities approved the implementation of the Basel III regulatory capital reforms and issued rules effecting certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act (the “Basel III Rules”).  The Basel III Rules are applicable to all U.S. banks that are subject to minimum capital requirements, as well as to bank and savings and loan holding companies other than “small bank holding companies” (generally bank holding companies with consolidated assets of less than $500 million).  The Basel III Rules not only increase most of the required minimum regulatory capital ratios, but they introduce a new Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio and the concept of a capital conservation buffer.  The Basel III Rules also expand the definition of capital as in effect currently by establishing criteria that instruments must meet to be considered Additional Tier 1 Capital (Tier 1 Capital in addition to Common Equity) and Tier 2 Capital.  A number of instruments that now qualify as Tier 1 Capital will not qualify, or their qualifications will change.  The Basel III Rules also permit smaller banking organizations to retain, through a one-time election, the existing treatment for accumulated other comprehensive income, which currently does not affect regulatory capital.  The Basel III Rules have maintained the general structure of the current prompt corrective action framework, while incorporating the increased requirements. The prompt corrective action guidelines were also revised to add the Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio.  In order to be a “well-capitalized” depository institution under the new regime, a bank and holding company must maintain a Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio of 6.5% or more; a Tier 1 Capital ratio of 8% or more; a Total Capital ratio of 10% or more; and a leverage ratio of 5% or more.  Generally, financial institutions become subject to the new Basel III Rules on January 1, 2015.  

 

 
17

 

 

U.S. financial institutions are also subject to numerous monitoring, recordkeeping, and reporting requirements designed to detect and prevent illegal activities such as money laundering and terrorist financing. These requirements are imposed primarily through the Bank Secrecy Act, (“BSA”) which was most recently amended by the USA Patriot Act. We have instituted policies and procedures to protect us and our employees, to the extent reasonably possible, from being used to facilitate money laundering, terrorist financing and other financial crimes. There can be no guarantee, however, that these policies and procedures are effective.

 

Failure to comply with applicable laws, regulations or policies could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil monetary penalties, and/or damage to our reputation, which could have a material adverse effect on us. Although we have policies and procedures designed to mitigate the risk of any such violations, there can be no assurance that such violations will not occur.

 

In addition to the foregoing laws and regulations, the policies of the Federal Reserve also have a significant impact on us. Among other things, the Federal Reserve’s monetary policies directly and indirectly influence the rate of interest earned on loans and paid on borrowings and interest-bearing deposits, and can also affect the value of financial instruments we hold and the ability of borrowers to repay their loans, which could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

Monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

In addition to being affected by general economic conditions, our earnings and growth are affected by the policies of the Federal Reserve.  An important function of the Federal Reserve is to regulate the money supply and credit conditions.  Among the instruments used by the Federal Reserve to implement these objectives are open market operations in U.S. government securities, adjustments of the discount rate and changes in reserve requirements against bank deposits.  These instruments are used in varying combinations to influence overall economic growth and the distribution of credit, bank loans, investments and deposits.  Their use also affects interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

 

The monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve have had a significant effect on the operating results of commercial banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future.  The effects of such policies upon our business, financial condition and results of operations cannot be predicted, especially in light of the recent change in Federal Reserve leadership.

 

Interest rates and other conditions impact our results of operations.

 

Our profitability is in large part a function of the spread between the interest rates earned on investments and loans/leases and the interest rates paid on deposits and other interest bearing liabilities. Like most banking institutions, our net interest spread and margin will be affected by general economic conditions and other factors, including fiscal and monetary policies of the federal government, that influence market interest rates and our ability to respond to changes in such rates. At any given time, our assets and liabilities will be such that they are affected differently by a given change in interest rates. As a result, an increase or decrease in rates, the length of loan/lease terms, the mix of adjustable and fixed rate loans/leases in our portfolio, the length of time deposits and borrowings, and the rate sensitivity of our deposit customers could have a positive or negative effect on our net income, capital and liquidity. We measure interest rate risk under various rate scenarios and using specific criteria and assumptions. A summary of this process, along with the results of our net interest income simulations is presented at “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” included under Item 7A of Part II of this Form 10-K. Although we believe our current level of interest rate sensitivity is reasonable and effectively managed, significant fluctuations in interest rates may have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. 

 

 
18

 

 

We are required to maintain capital to meet regulatory requirements, and if we fail to maintain sufficient capital, whether due to losses, an inability to raise additional capital or otherwise, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, as well as our ability to maintain regulatory compliance, would be adversely affected.

 

The Company and each of its banking subsidiaries are required by federal and state regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support their operations and with the implementation of the Basel III Rules, we understand that the capital requirements imposed by the regulators will increase in the future. We intend to grow our business organically and to explore opportunities to grow our business by taking advantage of attractive acquisition opportunities, and such growth plans may require us to raise additional capital to ensure that we have adequate levels of capital to support such growth on top of our current operations. Our ability to raise additional capital, when and if needed or desired, will depend on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a number of other factors, including investor perceptions regarding the banking industry and market conditions, and governmental activities, many of which are outside our control, and on our financial condition and performance. Accordingly, we cannot assure you that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us. Our failure to meet these capital and other regulatory requirements could affect customer confidence, our ability to grow, our costs of funds and FDIC insurance costs, our ability to pay dividends on common and preferred stock and to make distributions on our trust preferred securities, our ability to make acquisitions, and our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Failure to pay interest on our debt or dividends on our preferred stock may adversely impact our ability to pay common stock dividends.

 

As of December 31, 2013, we had $40.3 million of junior subordinated debentures held by six business trusts that we control. Interest payments on the debentures, which totaled $1.1 million for 2013, must be paid before we pay dividends on our capital stock, including our common stock. We have the right to defer interest payments on the debentures for up to 20 consecutive quarters. However, if we elect to defer interest payments, all deferred interest must be paid before we may pay dividends on our capital stock. As of December 31, 2013, we had 29,867 shares of senior non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock issued and outstanding, which we issued to the U.S. Department of the Treasury (the “Treasury”) as part of the Small Business Lending Fund Program (“SBLF”). The terms of the senior preferred stock impose limits on our ability to pay dividends on and repurchase shares of our common stock and other securities. In general, we may declare and pay dividends on our common stock or any other stock junior to the senior preferred stock, or repurchase shares of any such stock, only if after payment of such dividends or repurchase of such shares, our Tier 1 Capital would be at least 90% of our consolidated Tier 1 Capital on the date of issuance of the senior preferred stock. If we fail to declare and pay dividends on the senior preferred stock in a given quarter, then during such quarter and for the next three quarters following such missed dividend payment we may not pay dividends on or repurchase any common stock or any other securities that are junior to (or in parity with) the senior preferred stock, except that dividends may be paid on parity stock to the extent necessary to avoid any material breach of a covenant by which our company is bound. Although we expect to be able to pay all required dividends on the senior preferred stock (and to continue to pay dividends on common stock at current levels), there is no guarantee that we will be able to do so. Deferral, of either interest payments on the debentures or preferred dividends on the preferred shares, could cause a subsequent decline in the market price of our common stock because we would not be able to pay dividends on our common stock.

 

As a bank holding company, our sources of funds are limited.

 

We are a bank holding company, and our operations are primarily conducted by our subsidiary banks, which are subject to significant federal and state regulation. When available, cash to pay dividends to our stockholders is derived primarily from dividends received from our subsidiary banks. Our ability to receive dividends or loans from our subsidiary banks is restricted. Dividend payments by our subsidiaries to us in the future will require generation of future earnings by them and could require regulatory approval if any proposed dividends are in excess of prescribed guidelines. Further, as a structural matter, our right to participate in the assets of our subsidiary banks in the event of a liquidation or reorganization of any of the banks would be subject to the claims of the creditors of such bank, including depositors, which would take priority except to the extent we may be a creditor with a recognized claim. As of December 31, 2013, our subsidiary banks had deposits and other liabilities in the aggregate of approximately $2.19 billion.

 

 
19

 

 

Declines in asset values may result in impairment charges and adversely affect the value of our investments, financial performance and capital.

 

The market value of investments in our securities portfolio has become increasingly volatile in recent years, and as of December 31, 2013, we had gross unrealized losses of $31.9 million, or 4.4% of amortized cost, in our investment portfolio (modestly offset by gross unrealized gains of $2.9 million). The market value of investments may be affected by factors other than the underlying performance of the servicer of the securities or the mortgages underlying the securities, such as ratings downgrades, adverse changes in the business climate and a lack of liquidity in the secondary market for certain investment securities. On a quarterly basis, we formally evaluate investments and other assets for impairment indicators. We may be required to record additional impairment charges if our investments suffer a decline in value that is considered other-than-temporary. If we determine that a significant impairment has occurred, we would be required to charge against earnings the credit-related portion of the other-than-temporary impairment, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations in the periods in which the write-offs occur. Based on management’s evaluation, it was determined that the gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2013 are temporary and primarily a function of an increase in certain market interest rates.

 

Liquidity risks could affect operations and jeopardize our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Liquidity is essential to our business. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of securities and/or loans and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity. Our primary sources of funds consist of cash from operations, deposits, investment maturities and calls, and loan/lease repayments. Additional liquidity is provided by federal funds purchased from the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago (the “Federal Reserve Bank”) or other correspondent banks, Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) advances, wholesale and customer repurchase agreements, brokered time deposits, and the ability to borrow at the Federal Reserve Bank’s Discount Window. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance or capitalize our activities or on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us directly or the financial services industry or economy in general, such as disruptions in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry.

 

During the recent recession and early stages of recovery, the financial services industry and the credit markets generally were materially and adversely affected by significant declines in asset values and by a lack of liquidity.  The liquidity issues were particularly acute for regional and community banks, as many of the larger financial institutions significantly curtailed their lending to regional and community banks to reduce their exposure to the risks of other banks.  In addition, many of the larger correspondent lenders reduced or even eliminated federal funds lines for their correspondent customers. Furthermore, regional and community banks generally have less access to the capital markets than do the national and super-regional banks because of their smaller size and limited analyst coverage. Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to originate loans/leases, invest in securities, meet our expenses, pay dividends to our stockholders, or fulfill obligations such as repaying our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity, business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Our business is concentrated in and dependent upon the continued growth and welfare of the Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, and Rockford markets.

 

We operate primarily in the Quad Cities, Cedar Rapids, Waterloo/Cedar Falls, and Rockford markets, and as a result, our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows are subject to changes in the economic conditions in those areas. We have developed a particularly strong presence in Bettendorf, Cedar Falls, Cedar Rapids, Davenport, and Waterloo, Iowa and Moline and Rockford, Illinois and their surrounding communities. Our success depends upon the business activity, population, income levels, deposits and real estate activity in these markets. Although our customers’ business and financial interests may extend well beyond these market areas, adverse economic conditions that affect these market areas could reduce demand for our products and services, affect the ability of our customers to repay their loans to us, increase the levels of our nonperforming and problem loans, and generally affect our financial condition and results of operations. Because of our geographic concentration, we are less able than other regional or national financial institutions to diversify our credit risks across multiple markets.  

 

 
20

 

 

We face intense competition in all phases of our business from other banks and financial institutions.

 

The banking and financial services businesses in our markets are highly competitive. Our competitors include large regional banks, local community banks, savings and loan associations, securities and brokerage companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, finance companies, money market mutual funds, credit unions and other non-bank financial services providers. Many of these competitors are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as we are. Many of our unregulated competitors compete across geographic boundaries and are able to provide customers with a feasible alternative to traditional banking services.

 

Increased competition in our markets may result in a decrease in the amounts of our loans and deposits, reduced spreads between loan rates and deposit rates or loan terms that are more favorable to the borrower. Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our ability to grow and remain profitable. If increased competition causes us to significantly discount the interest rates we offer on loans or increase the amount we pay on deposits, our net interest income could be adversely impacted. If increased competition causes us to modify our underwriting standards, we could be exposed to higher losses from lending activities. Additionally, many of our competitors are much larger in total assets and capitalization, have greater access to capital markets, have larger lending limits and offer a broader range of financial services than we can offer.

 

The soundness of other financial institutions could negatively affect us. 

 

Our ability to engage in routine funding and other transactions could be negatively affected by the actions and commercial soundness of other financial institutions. Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. Defaults by, or even rumors or questions about, one or more financial services institutions, or the financial services industry generally, have led to market-wide liquidity problems and losses of depositor, creditor and counterparty confidence and could lead to losses or defaults by us or by other institutions. We could experience increases in deposits and assets as a result of the difficulties or failures of other banks, which would increase the capital we need to support our growth.

 

Our community banking strategy relies heavily on our subsidiaries’ independent management teams, and the unexpected loss of key managers may adversely affect our operations.

 

We rely heavily on the success of our bank subsidiaries’ independent management teams. Accordingly, much of our success to date has been influenced strongly by our ability to attract and to retain senior management experienced in banking and financial services and familiar with the communities in our market areas. Our ability to retain the executive officers and current management teams of our operating subsidiaries will continue to be important to the successful implementation of our strategy. It is also critical, as we manage our existing portfolio and grow, to be able to attract and retain qualified additional management and loan officers with the appropriate level of experience and knowledge about our market areas to implement our community-based operating strategy. The unexpected loss of services of any key management personnel, or the inability to recruit and retain qualified personnel in the future, could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

We have a continuing need for technological change, and we may not have the resources to effectively implement new technology.

 

The financial services industry continues to undergo rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. In addition to enabling us to better serve our customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and the potential for cost reduction. Our future success will depend in part upon our ability to address the needs of our customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands for convenience as well as to create additional efficiencies in our operations as we continue to grow our market share. Many of our larger competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. As a result, they may be able to offer additional or superior products to those that we will be able to offer, which would put us at a competitive disadvantage. Accordingly, we cannot provide you with assurance that we will be able to effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing such products and services to our customers.

 

 
21

 

 

Our reputation could be damaged by negative publicity.

 

Reputational risk, or the risk to our business, financial condition or results of operations from negative publicity, is inherent in our business. Negative publicity can result from actual or alleged conduct in a number of areas, including legal and regulatory compliance, lending practices, corporate governance, litigation, inadequate protection of customer data, ethical behavior of our employees, and from actions taken by regulators, ratings agencies and others as a result of that conduct. Damage to our reputation could impact our ability to attract new or maintain existing loan and deposit customers, employees and business relationships.

 

The repeal of federal prohibitions on payment of interest on business demand deposits could increase our interest expense.

 

All federal prohibitions on the ability of financial institutions to pay interest on business demand deposit accounts were repealed as part of the Dodd-Frank Act. As a result, some financial institutions have commenced offering interest on these demand deposits to compete for customers. If competitive pressures require us to pay interest on these demand deposits to attract and retain business customers, our interest expense would increase and our net interest margin would decrease. This could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Further, the effect of the repeal of the prohibition could be more significant in a higher interest rate environment as business customers would have a greater incentive to seek interest on demand deposits.

 

The preparation of our consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and judgments, which are subject to an inherent degree of uncertainty and which may differ from actual results.

 

Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles and general reporting practices within the financial services industry, which require us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. Some accounting policies, such as those pertaining to our allowance, require the application of significant judgment by management in selecting the appropriate assumptions for calculating financial estimates. By their nature, these estimates and judgments are subject to an inherent degree of uncertainty and actual results may differ from these estimates and judgments under different assumptions or conditions, which may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations in subsequent periods.

 

From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board and the Securities and Exchange Commission change the financial accounting and reporting standards or the interpretation of those standards that govern the preparation of our external financial statements. These changes are beyond our control, can be difficult to predict and could materially impact how we report our financial condition and results of operations.

 

Changes in these standards are continuously occurring, and given the current economic environment, more drastic changes may occur. The implementation of such changes could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

Secondary mortgage and government guaranteed loan market conditions could have a material impact on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

Currently, we sell a majority of the residential real estate and government guaranteed loans we originate. The profitability of these operations depends in large part upon our ability to make loans and to sell them in the secondary market at a gain. Thus, we are dependent upon the existence of an active secondary market and our ability to profitably sell loans into that market.

 

In addition to being affected by interest rates, the secondary markets are also subject to investor demand for residential mortgages and government guaranteed loans and investor yield requirements for those loans. These conditions may fluctuate or even worsen in the future. As a result, a prolonged period of secondary market illiquidity may reduce our loan production volumes and could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.  

 

 
22

 

 

Customers may decide not to use banks to complete their financial transactions, which could result in a loss of income to us.

 

Technology and other changes are allowing customers to complete financial transactions using nonbanks that historically have involved banks at one or both ends of the transaction. For example, customers can now pay bills and transfer funds directly without going through a bank. The process of eliminating banks as intermediaries, known as disintermediation, could result in the loss of fee income as well as the loss of customer deposits.

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

 

There are no unresolved staff comments.

 

Item 2.     Properties

 

The following table is a listing of the Company’s operating facilities for its subsidiary banks:

 

Facility Address

 

Facility

Square

Footage

Facility Owned or

Leased

       

Quad City Bank & Trust

     

2118 Middle Road in Bettendorf, IA

 

6,700

Owned

4500 Brady Street in Davenport, IA

 

36,000

Owned

3551 7th Street in Moline, IL

 

30,000

Owned

5405 Utica Ridge Road in Davenport, IA

 

7,400

Leased

1700 Division Street in Davenport, IA

 

12,000

Owned

       

Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust

     

500 1st Avenue NE, Suite 100 in Cedar Rapids, IA

 

36,000

Owned

5400 Council Street in Cedar Rapids, IA

 

5,900

Owned

422 Commercial Street in Waterloo, IA *

 

25,000

Owned

11 Tower Park Drive in Waterloo, IA *

 

6,000

Owned

312 1st Street in Cedar Falls, IA *

 

3,000

Owned

       

Rockford Bank & Trust

     

127 North Wyman Street in Rockford, IL **

 

7,800

Leased

4571 Guilford Road in Rockford, IL

 

20,000

Owned

308 West State Street in Rockford, IL**      1,100 Leased

 

* Branches of Community Bank & Trust.

** RB&T is in the process of transitioning its second branch facility from North Wyman Street to West State Street during the first quarter of 2014. Total operating facilities for RB&T will remain at two.

 

The subsidiary banks intend to limit their investment in premises to no more than 50% of their capital. Management believes that the facilities are of sound construction, in good operating condition, are appropriately insured, and are adequately equipped for carrying on the business of the Company.

 

No individual real estate property or mortgage amounts to 10% or more of consolidated assets.

 

Item 3.     Legal Proceedings

 

There are no material pending legal proceedings to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party other than ordinary routine litigation incidental to their respective businesses.

 

 
23

 

 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

 

Not applicable.

 

Part II

 

Item 5.     Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

 

Market Information. The common stock, par value $1.00 per share, of the Company is listed on The NASDAQ Global Market under the symbol “QCRH”. The stock began trading on NASDAQ on October 6, 1993. The Company transferred its listing from the NASDAQ Capital Market to the NASDAQ Global Market on March 1, 2010. As of December 31, 2013, there were 7,884,462 shares of common stock outstanding held by approximately 2,700 holders of record. The following table sets forth the high and low sales prices of the common stock, as reported by NASDAQ for the periods indicated.

 

   

2013 Sales Price

   

2012 Sales Price

   

2011 Sales Price

 
   

High

   

Low

   

High

   

Low

   

High

   

Low

 

First quarter

  $ 16.960     $ 13.050     $ 12.450     $ 8.500     $ 8.670     $ 7.220  

Second quarter

    16.500       13.180       14.500       10.700       9.470       7.290  

Third quarter

    16.510       14.960       14.980       12.620       9.928       8.701  

Fourth quarter

    18.200       15.650       15.500       11.400       9.234       8.420  

 

Dividends on Common Stock. On May 1, 2013, the Company declared a cash dividend of $0.04 per share, or $229 thousand, which was paid on July 8, 2013, to stockholders of record as of June 21, 2013. On November 7, 2013, the Company declared a cash dividend of $0.04 per share, or $230 thousand, which was paid on January 7, 2014, to stockholders of record as of December 20, 2013. In the future, it is the Company’s intention to continue to consider the payment of dividends on a semi-annual basis. The Company anticipates an ongoing need to retain much of its operating income to help provide the capital to redeem the Series F Noncumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (the “Series F Preferred Stock),” in the short-term and for continued growth in the long-term, but believes that operating results have reached a level that can sustain dividends to stockholders as well. See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for a detailed discussion of preferred stock.

 

The Company is heavily dependent on dividend payments from its subsidiary banks to make dividend payments on the Company’s preferred and common stock. Under applicable state laws, the banks are restricted as to the maximum amount of dividends that they may pay on their common stock. Iowa and Illinois law provide that state-chartered banks in those states may not pay dividends in excess of their undivided profits.

 

The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its stockholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies. The payment of dividends by any financial institution or its holding company is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and a financial institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized.

 

The Company also has certain contractual restrictions on its ability to pay dividends. The Company has issued junior subordinated debentures in six private placements (including two that were assumed in the acquisition of Community National). Under the terms of the debentures, the Company may be prohibited, under certain circumstances, from paying dividends on shares of its common stock. Additionally, the Company has issued shares of non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock and under the terms of this preferred stock, the Company may be prohibited, under certain circumstances, from paying dividends on shares of its common stock. See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for additional detail on the preferred stock. None of these circumstances existed through the date of filing of this Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

 
24

 

  

Purchase of Equity Securities by the Company. There were no purchases of common stock by the Company for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

Stockholder Return Performance Graph. The following graph indicates, for the period commencing December 31, 2008 and ending December 31, 2013, a comparison of cumulative total returns for the Company, the NASDAQ Composite Index, and the SNL Bank NASDAQ Index prepared by SNL Securities, Charlottesville, Virginia. The graph was prepared at the Company’s request by SNL Securities. The information assumes that $100 was invested at the closing price on December 31, 2008 in the common stock of the Company and in each index, and that all dividends were reinvested.

 

 


 
25

 

 

Item 6.     Selected Financial Data

 

The following “Selected Financial Data” of the Company is derived in part from, and should be read in conjunction with, our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto. See Item 8 Financial Statements. Results for past periods are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for any future period.

 

   

Years Ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

   

2010

   

2009

 

 

 

(dollars in thousands, except per share data)

 
STATEMENT OF INCOME DATA      

Interest income

  $ 81,872     $ 77,376     $ 77,723     $ 80,097     $ 85,611  

Interest expense

    17,767       19,727       23,578       30,233       34,949  

Net interest income

    64,105       57,649       54,145       49,864       50,662  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    5,930       4,371       6,616       7,464       16,976  

Non-interest income

    25,814       16,621       17,462       15,406       15,547  

Non-interest expense

    64,433       52,259       50,993       48,549       46,937  

Income tax expense

    4,618       4,534       3,868       2,449       247  

Net income

    14,938       13,106       10,130       6,808       2,049  

Less: net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    -       488       438       221       277  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

    14,938       12,618       9,692       6,587       1,772  

Less: preferred stock dividends and discount accretion

    3,168       3,496       5,284       4,128       3,844  

Net income (loss) attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

    11,770       9,122       4,408       2,459       (2,072 )
                                         

PER COMMON SHARE DATA

                                       

Net income (loss) - Basic (1)

  $ 2.13     $ 1.88     $ 0.93     $ 0.54     $ (0.46 )

Net income (loss) - Diluted (1)

    2.08       1.85       0.92       0.53       (0.46 )

Cash dividends declared

    0.08       0.08       0.08       0.08       0.08  

Dividend payout ratio

    3.76

%

    4.26

%

    8.60

%

    14.81

%

    (17.39

)%

                                         

BALANCE SHEET DATA

                                       

Total assets

  $ 2,394,953     $ 2,093,730     $ 1,966,610     $ 1,836,635     $ 1,779,646  

Securities

    697,210       602,239       565,229       424,847       370,520  

Total loans/leases

    1,460,280       1,287,388       1,200,745       1,172,539       1,244,320  

Allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases

    21,448       19,925       18,789       20,365       22,505  

Deposits

    1,646,991       1,374,114       1,205,458       1,114,816       1,089,323  

Borrowings

    563,381       547,758       590,603       566,060       542,895  

Stockholders' equity:

                                       

Preferred

    29,799       53,163       63,386       62,214       58,578  

Common

    117,778       87,271       81,047       70,357       67,017  
                                         

KEY RATIOS

                                       

Return on average assets (2)

    0.64

%

    0.62

%

    0.51

%

    0.36

%

    0.10

%

Return on average common stockholders' equity (3)

    11.48       10.84       5.82       3.58       (2.97 )

Return on average total stockholder's equity (2)

    10.24       8.90       7.09       5.03       1.43  

Net interest margin, tax equivalent yield (4)

    3.03       3.10       3.08       2.92       3.14  

Efficiency ratio (5)

    71.66       70.36       71.21       74.38       70.89  

Loans to deposits

    88.66       93.69       99.61       105.18       114.23  

Nonperforming assets to total assets

    1.28       1.41       2.06       2.73       2.27  

Allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases to total loans/leases

    1.47       1.55       1.56       1.74       1.81  

Allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases to nonperforming loans/leases

    104.70       78.47       58.70       49.49       74.94  

Net charge-offs to average loans/leases

    0.31       0.27       0.70       0.79       1.00  

Average total stockholders' equity to average total assets

    6.26       7.00       7.17       7.13       7.18  

 

(1) Income (loss) amounts are attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

(2) Numerator is net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

(3) Numerator is net income (loss) available to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

(4) Interest earned and yields on nontaxable investments and nontaxable loans are determined on a tax equivalent basis using a 34% tax rate

(5) Non-interest expenses divided by the sum of net interest income before provision for loan/lease losses and non-interest income

 

 
26

 

 

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

 

The following discussion provides additional information regarding our operations for the years ending December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, and our financial condition at December 31, 2013 and 2012. This discussion should be read in conjunction with “Selected Financial Data” and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto included or incorporated by reference elsewhere in this document.

 

OVERVIEW

 

The Company was formed in February 1993 for the purpose of organizing QCBT. Over the past twenty years, the Company has grown to include two additional banking subsidiaries (including the 2013 acquisition of CNB which was merged into one of the Company’s legacy banking subsidiaries) and a number of nonbanking subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2013, the Company had $2.39 billion in consolidated assets, including $1.46 billion in total loans/leases and $1.65 billion in deposits.

 

The Company recognized net income and net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. of $14.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013. After preferred stock dividends of $3.2 million, the Company reported net income available to common stockholders of $11.8 million, or diluted earnings per common share (“EPS”) of $2.08. For the same period in 2012, the Company recognized net income of $13.1 million, and net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. of $12.6 million, which excludes the net income attributable to noncontrolling interests of $488 thousand. After preferred stock dividends of $3.5 million, the Company reported net income available to common stockholders of $9.1 million, or EPS of $1.85. By comparison, for 2011, the Company recognized net income of $10.1 million, and net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. of $9.7 million, which excludes the net income attributable to noncontrolling interests of $438 thousand. After preferred stock dividends and discount accretion of $5.3 million, the Company reported net income available to common stockholders of $4.4 million, or EPS of $0.92. The $5.3 million of preferred stock dividends and discount accretion included $1.2 million of accelerated discount accretion on the repurchased Treasury Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”) preferred shares. Excluding the impact of the accelerated accretion, the Company’s EPS for 2011 would have been $1.18.

 

Following is a table that represents the various net income measurements for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

Year Ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 13,106,240     $ 10,129,869  

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    -       488,473       438,221  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

  $ 14,938,245     $ 12,617,767     $ 9,691,648  
                         

Less: Preferred stock dividends and discount accretion

    3,168,302       3,496,085       5,283,885

*

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

  $ 11,769,943     $ 9,121,682     $ 4,407,763  
                         

Diluted earnings per common share

  $ 2.08     $ 1.85     $ 0.92  
                         

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

    5,646,926       4,919,559       4,789,026  

 

*Includes $1.2 million of accelerated accretion of discount on the CPP preferred shares repurchased during the third quarter of 2011. See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for detailed discussion of preferred stock.

 

 
27

 

 

Following is a table that represents the major income and expense categories.

 

   

Year Ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Net interest income

  $ 64,105,437     $ 57,649,260     $ 54,144,856  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    (5,930,420 )     (4,370,767 )     (6,616,014 )

Noninterest income

    25,813,828       16,621,295       17,461,878  

Noninterest expense

    (64,432,658 )     (52,258,947 )     (50,992,652 )

Federal and state income tax

    (4,617,942 )     (4,534,601 )     (3,868,199 )

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 13,106,240     $ 10,129,869  

 

With the acquisition of Community National and CNB on May 13, 2013, the Company’s 2013 results were significantly impacted. In comparison to 2012, following are some noteworthy changes:

 

 

Net interest income grew $6.5 million, or 11%, propelled by the addition of CNB for more than half of the year as well as some modest organic growth in earning assets.

 

Excluding the acquisition-related gains (bargain purchase gain of $1.8 million upon acquisition and gains on CNB branch sales of $2.3 million), noninterest income increased $5.0 million, or 30%, led by wealth management fees, deposit service fees, and gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans.

 

Excluding acquisition and data conversion costs totaling $2.4 million, noninterest expense increased $9.8 million, or 19%, with most of this increase attributable to the addition of CNB’s cost structure for more than half of the year.

 

NET INTEREST INCOME AND MARGIN

 

Net interest income, on a tax equivalent basis, grew $7.2 million, or 12%, in 2013 compared to 2012. The increase in net interest income was primarily driven by the addition of CNB for more than half of the year. Secondarily, the Company’s legacy charters experienced modest organic growth in earning assets during 2013. A comparison of yields, spreads and margins from 2013 to 2012 shows the following (on a tax equivalent basis):

 

 

The average yield on interest-earning assets decreased 34 basis points from 4.18% to 3.84%.

 

The average cost of interest-bearing liabilities decreased 28 basis points from 1.37% to 1.09%.

 

The net interest spread declined 6 basis points from 2.81% to 2.75%.

 

The net interest margin declined 11 basis points from 3.14% to 3.03%.

 

Net interest income, on a tax equivalent basis, grew $4.9 million, or 9% in 2012 compared to 2011. Interest income (on a tax equivalent basis) grew slightly as growth in earning assets coupled with diversification of the securities portfolio outpaced the impact of declining yields. In addition, interest expense continued its significant decline as the Company continued its shift in mix of funding from wholesale (FHLB advances, wholesale structured repurchase agreements (“structured repos”), and brokered time deposits) to core deposits. For 2012, average earning assets increased by $122.2 million, or 7%, while average interest-bearing liabilities grew modestly by $15.7 million, or 1%, when compared with average balances for 2011. Primarily funding the growth in average earning assets, noninterest-bearing deposits grew $95.9 million, or 30%. A comparison of yields, spreads and margins from 2012 to 2011 shows the following (on a tax equivalent basis):

 

 

The average yield on interest-earning assets decreased 23 basis points from 4.41% to 4.18%.

 

The average cost of interest-bearing liabilities decreased 28 basis points from 1.65% to 1.37%.

 

The net interest spread improved 5 basis points from 2.76% to 2.81%.

 

The net interest margin improved 6 basis points from 3.08% to 3.14%.

 

 
28

 

 

The Company’s management closely monitors and manages net interest margin. From a profitability standpoint, an important challenge for the Company’s subsidiary banks and leasing company is the improvement of their net interest margins. Management continually addresses this issue with pricing and other balance sheet management strategies including, but not limited to, the use of alternative funding sources. Over the past three years, the Company’s management has emphasized improving its funding mix by reducing its reliance on wholesale funding, which tends to be at a higher cost than deposits. In addition, with deposit growth outpacing loan growth, the Company’s management has focused on growing and diversifying its securities portfolio.

 

The following strategies were executed by the Company to reduce reliance on wholesale funding or reducing the cost of portions of the Company’s wholesale funding.

 

QCBT executed a balance sheet restructuring during the first quarter of 2011. Specifically, the bank utilized excess liquidity and prepaid $15.0 million of FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 4.87% and a weighted average maturity of May 2012. The fees for prepayment totaled $832 thousand. The Company sold $37.4 million of government sponsored agency securities and recognized pre-tax gains of $880 thousand which more than offset the prepayment fees. The proceeds from the sales of the government sponsored agency securities were reinvested into government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities with reduced risk-weighting for regulatory capital purposes and yields that were comparable to the sold securities. The resulting impacts were significant and included:

 

 

Significantly reduced interest expense and improved net interest margin

 

Stronger regulatory capital

 

Reduced reliance on wholesale funding

 

Separately, during the first quarter of 2011, QCBT modified $20.4 million of fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 4.33% and a weighted average maturity of October 2013 into new fixed rate advances with a weighted average interest rate of 3.35% and a weighted average maturity of February 2014. Additionally, during the fourth quarter of 2011, RB&T modified $13.0 million of fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 3.37% and a weighted average maturity of March 2013 into new fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 2.29% and a weighted average maturity of February 2016.

 

During the second quarter of 2012, the Company’s subsidiary banks modified $25.0 million of fixed rate structured repos with a weighted average interest rate of 3.77% and a weighted average maturity of December 2015 into new fixed rate structured repos with a weighted average interest rate of 3.21% and a weighted average maturity of April 2019.

 

During the first quarter of 2013, QCBT modified $50.0 million of structured repos with a weighted average interest rate of 3.21% and a weighted average maturity of February 2016 into new fixed rate structured repos with a weighted average interest rate of 2.65% and a weighted average maturity of May 2020. During the second quarter of 2013, CRBT modified $20.0 million of fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average rate of 4.82% and a weighted average maturity of October 2016 into new fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 4.12% and a weighted average maturity of June 2019.

 

These modifications serve to reduce interest expense and improve net interest margin, and minimize the exposure to rising rates through the duration extension of fixed rate liabilities.  

 

 
29

 

 

The Company’s average balances, interest income/expense, and rates earned/paid on major balance sheet categories are presented in the following table: 

 

   

Years Ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

Average

Balance

   

Interest

Earned

or Paid

   

Average

Yield or

Cost

   

Average

Balance

   

Interest

Earned

or Paid

   

Average

Yield or

Cost

   

Average

Balance

   

Interest

Earned

or Paid

   

Average

Yield or

Cost

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

ASSETS

                                                                       

Interest earning assets:

                                                                       

Federal funds sold

  $ 14,577     $ 19       0.13

%

  $ 3,003     $ 6       0.20

%

  $ 49,510     $ 92       0.19  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    43,909       275       0.63       54,834       378       0.69       29,691       405       1.36  

Investment securities (1)

    700,344       16,140       2.30       603,568       14,268       2.36       501,470       12,344       2.46  

Restricted investment securities

    16,083       559       3.48       15,172       507       3.34       15,573       558       3.58  

Gross loans/leases receivable (1) (2) (3) (4)

    1,425,364       67,484       4.73       1,219,623       64,100       5.26       1,177,705       64,808       5.50  

Total interest earning assets

  $ 2,200,277       84,477       3.84     $ 1,896,200       79,259       4.18     $ 1,773,949       78,207       4.41  
                                                                         

Noninterest-earning assets:

                                                                       

Cash and due from banks

  $ 44,336                     $ 40,770                     $ 48,797                  

Premises and equipment, net

    35,820                       31,502                       30,848                  

Less allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases

    (21,500 )                     (19,162 )                     (19,902 )                

Other

    71,671                       76,383                       73,346                  

Total assets

  $ 2,330,604                     $ 2,025,693                     $ 1,907,038                  
                                                                         

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

                                                                       

Interest-bearing liabilities:

                                                                       

Interest-bearing demand deposits

  $ 672,038       1,879       0.28

%

  $ 545,739       2,679       0.49

%

  $ 530,340       3,927       0.74  

Time deposits

    404,495       2,836       0.70       352,582       3,540       1.00       363,337       5,012       1.38  

Short-term borrowings

    164,710       293       0.18       170,065       248       0.15       144,267       290       0.20  

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    207,684       6,863       3.30       201,704       7,280       3.61       211,361       7,972       3.77  

Junior subordinated debentures

    39,495       1,143       2.89       36,085       1,039       2.88       36,085       1,228       3.40  

Other borrowings (4)

    140,888       4,753       3.37       137,226       4,941       3.60       142,281       5,149       3.62  

Total interest-bearing liabilities

  $ 1,629,310       17,767       1.09     $ 1,443,401       19,727       1.37     $ 1,427,670       23,578       1.65  
                                                                         

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

  $ 518,406                     $ 412,039                     $ 316,110                  

Other noninterest-bearing liabilities

    36,982                       28,460                       26,558                  

Total liabilities

  $ 2,184,698                     $ 1,883,900                     $ 1,770,338                  
                                                                         

Stockholders' equity

    145,906                       141,793                       136,700                  

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 2,330,604                     $ 2,025,693                     $ 1,907,038                  
                                                                         

Net interest income

          $ 66,710                     $ 59,532                     $ 54,629          
                                                                         

Net interest spread

                    2.75 %                     2.81 %                     2.76 %
                                                                         

Net interest margin

                    3.03 %                     3.14 %                     3.08 %
                                                                         

Ratio of average interest earning assets to average interest-bearing liabilities

    135.04 %                     131.37 %                     124.25 %                

 

 

(1)

Interest earned and yields on nontaxable investment securities and loans are determined on a tax equivalent basis using a 34% tax rate in each year presented.

 

(2)

Loan/lease fees are not material and are included in interest income from loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.

 

(3)

Non-accrual loans/leases are included in the average balance for gross loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.

 

(4)

In accordance with ASC 860, effective January 1, 2010, the Company accounts for some participations sold, including sales of government-guaranteed portions of loans during the recourse period, as secured borrowings. As such, these amounts are included in the average balance for gross loans/leases receivable and other borrowings. For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, this totaled $0.0 million, $0.0 million, and $2.5 million, respectively. During the second quarter of 2011, SBA removed the recourse provision for sales which allowed for sale accounting treatment at the time of sale; thus, the decline in average balance.

 

 
30

 

 

The Company’s components of change in net interest income are presented in the following table:

 

   

For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

 
                         
   

Inc./(Dec.)

   

Components

   

Inc./(Dec.)

   

Components

 
   

from

   

of Change (1)

   

from

   

of Change (1)

 
   

Prior Year

   

Rate

   

Volume

   

Prior Year

   

Rate

   

Volume

 
   

2013 vs. 2012

   

2012 vs. 2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

   

(dollars in thousands)

 

INTEREST INCOME

                                               

Federal funds sold

  $ 13     $ (3 )   $ 16     $ (86 )   $ 6     $ (92 )

Interest-bearing deposits at other financial institutions

    (103 )     (33 )     (70 )     (27 )     (263 )     236  

Investment securities (2)

    1,872       (366 )     2,238       1,924       (506 )     2,430  

Restricted investment securities

    52       21       31       (51 )     (37 )     (14 )

Gross loans/leases receivable (2) (3) (4) (5)

    3,384       (6,754 )     10,138       (1,444 )     (3,701 )     2,257  
                                                 

Total change in interest income

  $ 5,218     $ (7,135 )   $ 12,353     $ 316     $ (4,501 )   $ 4,817  
                                                 

INTEREST EXPENSE

                                               

Interest-bearing demand deposits

  $ (800 )   $ (1,327 )   $ 527     $ (1,248 )   $ (1,359 )   $ 111  

Time deposits

    (704 )     (1,174 )     470       (1,472 )     (1,328 )     (144 )

Short-term borrowings

    45       53       (8 )     (42 )     (88 )     46  

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    (417 )     (628 )     211       (692 )     (336 )     (356 )

Junior subordinated debentures

    104       5       99       (189 )     (189 )     -  

Other borrowings (5)

    (188 )     (318 )     130       (208 )     (26 )     (182 )
                                                 

Total change in interest expense

  $ (1,960 )   $ (3,389 )   $ 1,429     $ (3,851 )   $ (3,326 )   $ (525 )
                                                 

Total change in net interest income

  $ 7,178     $ (3,746 )   $ 10,924     $ 4,167     $ (1,175 )   $ 5,342  

 

 

(1)

The column "Inc/(Dec) from Prior Year" is segmented into the changes attributable to variations in volume and the changes attributable to changes in interest rates.
The variations attributable to simultaneous volume and rate changes have been proportionately allocated to rate and volume.

 

(2)

Interest earned and yields on nontaxable investment securities and loans are determined on a tax equivalent basis using a 34% tax rate in each year presented.

 

(3)

Loan/lease fees are not material and are included in interest income from loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.

 

(4)

Non-accrual loans/leases are included in the average balance for gross loans/leases receivable in accordance with accounting and regulatory guidance.

 

(5)

In accordance with ASC 860, effective January 1, 2010, the Company accounts for some participations sold, including sales of government-guaranteed portions of loans during the recourse period, as secured borrowings. As such, these amounts are included in the average balance for gross loans/leases receivable and other borrowings.  For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, this totaled $0.0 million, $0.0 million, and $2.5 million, respectively. During the second quarter of 2011, SBA removed the recourse provision for sales which allowed sale accounting treatment at the time of the sale; thus, the decline in average balance.

 

The Company’s operating results are also impacted by various sources of noninterest income, including trust department fees, investment advisory and management fees, deposit service fees, gains from the sales of residential real estate loans and government guaranteed loans, earnings on BOLI, and other income. Offsetting these items, the Company incurs noninterest expenses which include salaries and employee benefits, occupancy and equipment expense, professional and data processing fees, FDIC and other insurance expense, loan/lease expense, and other administrative expenses.

 

The Company’s operating results are also affected by economic and competitive conditions, particularly changes in interest rates, income tax rates, government policies, and actions of regulatory authorities.

 

 
31

 

 

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

The Company’s financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The financial information contained within these statements is, to a significant extent, financial information that is based on approximate measures of the financial effects of transactions and events that have already occurred.

 

Based on its consideration of accounting policies that involve the most complex and subjective decisions and assessments, management has identified its most critical accounting policy to be that related to the allowance for loan/lease losses (also referred to as “allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases” or “allowance”). The Company’s allowance methodology incorporates a variety of risk considerations, both quantitative and qualitative, in establishing an allowance that management believes is appropriate at each reporting date. Quantitative factors include the Company’s historical loss experience, delinquency and charge-off trends, collateral values, governmental guarantees, payment status, changes in nonperforming loans/leases, and other factors. Quantitative factors also incorporate known information about individual loans/leases, including borrowers’ sensitivity to interest rate movements. Qualitative factors include the general economic environment in the Company’s markets, including economic conditions throughout the Midwest, and in particular, the economic health of certain industries. Size and complexity of individual credits in relation to loan/lease structure, existing loan/lease policies and pace of portfolio growth are other qualitative factors that are considered in the methodology. As the Company adds new products and increases the complexity of its loan/lease portfolio, it enhances its methodology accordingly. Management may report a materially different amount for the provision in the statement of operations to change the allowance if its assessment of the above factors were different. The discussion regarding the Company’s allowance should be read in conjunction with the Company’s financial statements and the accompanying notes presented elsewhere in this Form 10-K, as well as the portion of this Management’s Discussion and Analysis section entitled “Financial Condition – Allowance for Estimated Losses on Loans/Leases.” Although management believes the level of the allowance as of December 31, 2013 was adequate to absorb losses inherent in the loan/lease portfolio, a decline in local economic conditions, or other factors, could result in increasing losses that cannot be reasonably predicted at this time.

 

The Company’s assessment of other-than-temporary impairment of its available-for-sale securities portfolio is another critical accounting policy as a result of the level of judgment required by management. Available-for-sale securities are evaluated to determine whether declines in fair value below their cost are other-than-temporary. In estimating other-than-temporary impairment losses management considers a number of factors including, but not limited to: (1) the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost; (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer; (3) the current market conditions; and (4) the intent of the Company to not sell the security prior to recovery and whether it is not more-likely-than-not that the Company will be required to sell the security prior to recovery. The discussion regarding the Company’s assessment of other-than-temporary impairment should be read in conjunction with the Company’s financial statements and the accompanying notes presented elsewhere in this Form 10-K.

 

 
32

 

 

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

OVERVIEW. Net income attribute to QCR Holdings, Inc. for 2013 was $14.9 million, or EPS of $2.08 after preferred stock dividends of $3.2 million. Comparing 2013 to 2012, annual earnings grew 18%, and EPS increased 12%. Net interest income grew $6.5 million, or 11%, in 2013 with the acquisition of CNB and organic growth in the Company’s legacy markets. Provision increased $1.6 million, or 36%, as the Company added specific allowances to several existing nonperforming loans as workouts of those loans continued to progress. Noninterest income jumped $9.2 million, or 55%, propelled by acquisition-related gains of $4.1 million (bargain purchase gain of $1.8 million and the gains on branch sales of $2.3 million), growth in wealth management fee income of $1.5 million, increased gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans of $1.1 million, as well as increases across many of the core recurring noninterest income sources as a result of the acquisition of CNB. Noninterest expenses grew $12.2 million, or 23%, in 2013. Acquisition and data conversion costs totaled $2.4 million for the year. The addition of CNB’s cost structure contributed to increased costs for more than half of the year.

 

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. for 2012 was $12.6 million, or EPS of $1.85 after preferred stock dividends of $3.5 million. Comparing 2012 to 2011, annual earnings grew 30%, and EPS more than doubled. Net interest income grew $3.5 million, or 6%, as growth and shift in mix of earning assets and funding outpaced the impact of declining yields on loans and securities. Provision declined $2.2 million as loan quality continued to improve. Noninterest income fell $841 thousand which was primarily the result of increased losses on other real estate owned (“OREO”) as most of the other recurring sources realized modest gains year-over-year. Noninterest expenses grew $1.3 million, or 2%, during 2012. The large majority of this increase was salaries and employee benefits as health insurance costs continued to increase, incentive compensation grew due to improved financial performance, and the continuation of customary annual salary and benefits increases across the employee base.

 

INTEREST INCOME. For 2013, interest income grew $4.5 million, or 6%, with the addition of the CNB’s earning assets (approximately $255.9 million at acquisition which was later reduced by the branch sales in October 2013). In total, the Company’s average interest-earning assets increased $304.1 million, or 16%, year-over-year. This growth more than offset the continued impact of declining yields on loans and securities. Average loans/leases grew 17% and average securities jumped 16%. Of the latter, the Company continued to grow and diversify its securities portfolio, included increasing its portfolio of tax exempt municipal securities. The large majority of these are privately placed debt issuances located in the Midwest and require a thorough underwriting process before investment. Execution of this strategy has led to increased interest income on a tax equivalent basis over the past several years. Management understands that this strategy has extended the duration of its securities portfolio and continually evaluates the combined benefit of increased interest income and reduced effective income tax rate and the impact on interest rate risk.

 

For 2012, interest income declined modestly ($347 thousand, or less than 1%) as growth in earning assets and diversification of the securities portfolio fell short of the impact of declining yields on loans and securities. The Company’s average interest-earning assets increased $122.2 million, or 7%, year-over-year. The Company grew securities ($102.1 million, or 20%) and loans ($41.9 million, or 4%), while its federal funds sold position declined $46.5 million as the Company invested some of its excess liquidity. As growth in deposits continued to outpace loan growth during 2012, the Company continued to grow and diversify its securities portfolio, including increasing the portfolio of government guaranteed residential mortgage-backed securities as well as more than tripling the portfolio of tax exempt municipal securities. Notably, the significant increase in tax exempt municipal debt securities expanded interest income on a tax equivalent basis to reflect net growth year-over-year.

 

The Company intends to continue to grow quality loans and leases as well as diversify the securities portfolio to maximize yield while minimizing credit and interest rate risk.

 

 
33

 

 

INTEREST EXPENSE. Comparing 2013 to 2012, interest expense declined $2.0 million, or 10%, year-over-year. Average interest-bearing liabilities grew 13% in 2013 with most of this in deposits as borrowings were flat. The acquisition of CNB was the primary contributor to the deposit growth. More than offsetting the growth, the Company was successful in continuing to manage down its cost of funds as follows:

 

 

Continued reduction of interest rates paid across all deposits without runoff (the average cost of interest-bearing deposits fell from 0.61% for 2012 to 0.44% for 2013);

 

The impact of the aforementioned balance sheet restructuring strategies executed in 2012 and 2013; and

 

Continued shift of funding from borrowings (higher cost of funds) to deposits.

 

Comparing 2012 to 2011, interest expense declined $3.9 million, or 16%, year-over-year. With average interest-bearing liabilities increasing slightly, the following were major contributors to the decline in interest expense:

  

 

Continued reduction of interest rates paid across all deposits without runoff (the average cost of interest-bearing deposits fell from 1.00% for 2011 to 0.61% for 2012);

 

The impact of the aforementioned balance sheet restructuring strategies executed in 2011 and 2012; and

 

Continued shift of funding from wholesale borrowings and brokered and other time deposits to core deposits, including non-interest bearing deposits.

 

The Company’s management intends to continue to shift the mix of funding from wholesale funds to core deposits including noninterest-bearing deposits. Continuing this trend will strengthen the Company’s franchise value, reduce funding costs, and increase fee income opportunities through deposit service charges.

 

PROVISION FOR LOAN/LEASE LOSSES. The provision is established based on a number of factors, including the Company’s historical loss experience, delinquencies and charge-off trends, the local and national economy and the risk associated with the loans/leases in the portfolio as described in more detail in the “Critical Accounting Policies” section.

 

The Company’s provision totaled $5.9 million for 2013 which was an increase of $1.6 million, or 36%, from 2012. Despite another drop in nonperforming loans (decline of $4.9 million, or 19%) in 2013, the Company had an increased need for specific reserves for certain existing nonperforming loans as the workouts of these loans progressed.

 

Comparing 2012 to 2011, the Company’s provision declined $2.2 million, or 34%, from $6.6 million for 2011 to $4.4 million for 2012. The decline was the result of continued improvement in loan quality as evidenced by a declining trend in the level of classified and criticized loans (see table and further discussion in the Allowance for Estimated Losses on Loans/Leases section). This trend translated over to nonperforming loans/leases, as the Company’s level of nonperforming loans/leases declined $6.6 million, or 21%, from 2011 to 2012.

 

The Company had an allowance of 1.47% of total gross loans/leases at December 31, 2013, compared to 1.55% of total gross loans/leases at December 31, 2012, and compared to 1.56% of total gross loans/leases at December 31, 2011. In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for acquisition accounting, the acquired CNB loans were recorded at fair value; therefore, there was no allowance associated with CNB’s loans at acquisition. Further, the Company’s allowance to total nonperforming loans/leases was 105% at December 31, 2013, which was up from 78% at December 31, 2012, and up from 59% at December 31, 2011.

 

 
34

 

 

NONINTEREST INCOME. The following tables set forth the various categories of noninterest income for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

Years Ended

                 
   

December 31, 2013

   

December 31, 2012

   

$ Change

   

% Change

 
                                 

Trust department fees

  $ 4,941,681     $ 3,632,278     $ 1,309,403       36.0

%

Investment advisory and management fees, gross

    2,580,140       2,361,159       218,981       9.3  

Deposit service fees

    4,267,162       3,485,929       781,233       22.4  

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans

    836,065       1,388,142       (552,077 )     (39.8 )

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans

    2,148,979       1,069,565       1,079,414       100.9  

Earnings on bank-owned life insurance

    1,786,023       1,609,208       176,815       11.0  

Credit card fees, net of processing costs

    174,258       599,164       (424,906 )     (70.9 )

Subtotal

  $ 16,734,308     $ 14,145,445     $ 2,588,863       18.3  

Bargain purchase gain on Community National Acquisition

    1,841,385       -       1,841,385       100.0  

Gains on sales of certain Community National Bank branches

    2,334,216       -       2,334,216       100.0  

Securities gains, net

    432,492       104,600       327,892       313.5  

Losses on other real estate owned, net

    (545,340 )     (1,332,972 )     787,632       (59.1 )

Other

    5,016,767       3,704,222       1,312,545       35.4  

Total noninterest income

  $ 25,813,828     $ 16,621,295     $ 9,192,533       55.3

%

 

   

Years Ended

                 
   

December 31, 2012

   

December 31, 2011

   

$ Change

   

% Change

 
                                 

Trust department fees

  $ 3,632,278     $ 3,368,995     $ 263,283       7.8

%

Investment advisory and management fees, gross

    2,361,159       2,108,918       252,241       12.0  

Deposit service fees

    3,485,929       3,493,001       (7,072 )     (0.2 )

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans

    1,388,142       999,162       388,980       38.9  

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans

    1,069,565       1,565,881       (496,316 )     (31.7 )

Earnings on bank-owned life insurance

    1,609,208       1,445,891       163,317       11.3  

Credit card fees, net of processing costs

    599,164       500,544       98,620       19.7  

Subtotal

  $ 14,145,445     $ 13,482,392     $ 663,053       4.9  

Securities gains, net

    104,600       1,472,528       (1,367,928 )     100.0  

Losses on other real estate owned, net

    (1,332,972 )     (374,910 )     (958,062 )     255.5  

Other

    3,704,222       2,881,868       822,354       28.5  

Total noninterest income

  $ 16,621,295     $ 17,461,878     $ (840,583 )     (4.8

)%

 

Trust department fees continue to be a significant contributor to noninterest income. Income is generated primarily from fees charged based on assets under administration for corporate and personal trusts and for custodial services. The majority of the trust department fees are determined based on the value of the investments within the fully managed trusts. Part of this increase stems from the addition of CNB’s trust department for more than half of the year. As the markets have strengthened with the national economy’s recovery from recession, the Company’s fee income has experienced similar growth. In recent years, the Company has been successful in expanding its customer base which has helped to drive the recent increases in fee income.

 

In recent years, management has placed a stronger emphasis on growing its investment advisory and management services. Part of this initiative has been to restructure the Company’s Wealth Management Division to allow for more efficient delivery of products and services through selective additions of talent as well as leverage of and collaboration among existing resources (including the aforementioned trust department). CNB did not provide investment advisory and management services; however, the Company expects to leverage its existing infrastructure to efficiently offer these services in the communities served by CNB. Similar to trust department fees, these fees are largely determined based on the value of the investments managed. And, similar to the trust department, the Company has had some success in expanding its customer base which has helped to drive the recent increases in fee income.

 

 
35

 

 

As management focuses on growing fee income, expanding market share in trust and investment advisory services will continue to be a primary strategic focus.

 

Deposit service fees expanded 22% in 2013 largely due to the addition of CNB’s deposits for more than half of the year. The Company has placed an emphasis on shifting the mix of deposits from brokered and retail time deposits to non-maturity demand deposits as the latter tends to be lower in interest cost and higher in service fees. A large component of this shift and growth over the past several years has been non-interest bearing correspondent bank deposits. The majority of these deposits include a variety of services (processing of cash letter items, wire transfer services, safekeeping of securities, etc.) and the Company has offered a reduction of fees charged for these services if the correspondent bank carries a certain level of non-interest bearing deposits. With loan demand weak and liquidity strong across the correspondent bank customer portfolio, the correspondent bank customers have carried higher deposits to maximize the reduction of fees. The Company has continually reviewed the fees charged on all deposit-related services and has consistently increased fees across the board to be in line with or to lead the market. In addition, the Company continually evaluates the level of fee reduction and compensating balances for the aforementioned correspondent bank deposits and restructured the program to minimize the reduction of fees beginning in 2013. The Company plans to continue the shift in mix of deposits and to focus on growing deposit service fees.

 

Regarding gains on sales of residential mortgages, the Company experienced fluctuation as refinancing activity was slow in 2011, rebounded in 2012 as the yield curve flattened further driving down longer-term interest rates and allowing opportunities for refinancing, and slowed again in 2013 as the yield curve steepened and longer-term interest rates increased.

 

As one of its core strategies, the Company continues to leverage its small business lending expertise by taking advantage of programs offered by the SBA and the USDA. The Company’s portfolio of government guaranteed loans has grown as a direct result of the Company’s strong expertise in SBA and USDA lending. In some cases, it is more beneficial for the Company to sell the government guaranteed portion on the secondary market for a premium rather than retain the loans in the Company’s portfolio. Sales activity for government guaranteed portions of loans tends to fluctuate depending on the demand for small business loans that fit the criteria for the government guarantee. Further, some of the transactions can be large and, as the gain is determined as a percentage of the guaranteed amount, the resulting gain on sale can be large. Lastly, a strategy for improved pricing is packaging loans together for sale. From time to time, the Company may execute on this strategy, which may delay the gains on sales of some loans to achieve better pricing. Despite the fluctuation, the Company will continue to focus on growing small business lending and selling the government guaranteed portion as it continues to be beneficial.

 

Earnings on BOLI experienced strong growth over the past two years. With the acquisition of CNB, the Company acquired $4.6 million of BOLI. Additionally, the Company purchased additional BOLI in 2011 totaling $7.0 million, and another $2.0 million in 2012. Yields on BOLI (based on a simple average and excluding impact of federal income tax exemption) were 3.65% for 2013, 3.67% for 2012, and 3.83% for 2011. Notably, a small portion of the Company’s BOLI is variable rate whereby the returns are determined by the performance of the equity market. Management intends to continue to review its BOLI investments to be consistent with policy and regulatory limits in conjunction with the rest of its earning assets in an effort to maximize returns while minimizing risk.

 

Credit card fees, net of processing costs, declined 71% in 2013 as a direct result of the sale of QCBT’s credit card issuing operations on January 31, 2013. See Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion of this sale.

 

In accordance with acquisition accounting rules, the Company recognized a bargain purchase gain of $1.8 million in recording the acquisition of Community National. The Company adjusted the acquired assets and assumed liabilities to fair value as determined by an independent valuation specialist. The gain resulted primarily from the recording of a core deposit intangible based on the value of the acquired deposit portfolio, and the recognition of a discount on the trust preferred securities that were previously issued by Community National and were assumed by the Company in the transaction. Net of other more modest valuation adjustments, and the resulting deferred income tax liabilities, the $1.8 million bargain purchase gain was included in noninterest income. See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information regarding the Company’s acquisition of Community National.

 

 
36

 

 

In October 2013, the Company sold certain assets and liabilities of certain branches of CNB for a pre-tax gain on sale of $2.3 million. Specifically, the Company sold certain assets and liabilities of the two Mason City, Iowa branches, including deposits of $55 million and loans of $23 million, for a pre-tax gain on sale of $874 thousand. Additionally, the Company sold certain assets and liabilities of the two Austin, Minnesota branches, including deposits of $36 million and loans of $32 million, for a pre-tax gain on sale of $1.4 million. See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information regarding these branch sales.  

 

During the third quarter of 2013, QCBT sold $31.2 million of a mix of government-sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities, government-sponsored agency securities, and one smaller individual trust preferred security at a pre-tax gain on sale of $417 thousand. In turn, QCBT reinvested the sales proceeds back into a blend of government-sponsored agency securities and residential mortgage-backed securities at a higher yield with modest duration extension. During the third quarter of 2011, as a result of favorable market conditions, QCBT sold $8.6 million of government agency securities for a pre-tax gain totaling $444 thousand. The related sales proceeds were reinvested into residential mortgage-backed securities with higher yields and similar credit risk to the sold securities. Similarly, as a result of favorable market conditions, RB&T sold $8.3 million of government agency securities for a pre-tax gain totaling $149 thousand. The sales proceeds were utilized to diversify RB&T’s securities portfolio and fund loan growth. Separately, during the first quarter of 2011, in an effort to offset the $832 thousand of fees for prepaying $15.0 million of FHLB advances, QCBT sold $37.4 million of government agency securities for a pre-tax gain totaling $880 thousand. See detailed discussion of this restructuring transaction in the Net Interest Income and Margin section earlier in Management’s Discussion and Analysis.    

 

In 2013, the Company wrote down one existing individual OREO property by $463 thousand as a result of a further decline in appraised value. The remaining $82 thousand consisted of small losses on the sales of several properties. In 2012, the Company incurred elevated levels of write-downs of existing OREO as the result of further declines in appraised values of certain properties. Of the total losses on OREO for 2012, the Company wrote down $1.2 million of existing OREO and recognized losses on sales of $173 thousand. Management continues to proactively manage its OREO portfolio in an effort to sell timely at minimal loss.

 

The following table sets forth the various categories of other noninterest income for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

Years Ended

                 
   

December 31, 2013

   

December 31, 2012

   

$ Change

   

% Change

 

Gain on sale of credit card portfolio

  $ 495,405     $ -     $ 495,405       100.0

%

Gain on sale of credit card issuing operations

    355,268       -       355,268       100.0  

Gain on sale of certain nonperforming loans

    575,506       -       575,506       100.0  

Gain on sale of equity interest

    -       580,000       (580,000 )     (100.0 )

Debit card fees

    991,300       951,200       40,100       4.2  

Fees on interest rate swaps on commercial loans

    104,560       616,018       (511,458 )     (83.0 )

Miscellaneous

    2,494,728       1,557,004       937,724       60.2  

Other noninterest income

  $ 5,016,767     $ 3,704,222     $ 1,312,545       35.4

%

 

   

Years Ended

                 
   

December 31, 2012

   

December 31, 2011

   

$ Change

   

% Change

 

Gain on sale of equity interest

  $ 580,000     $ -     $ 580,000       100.0

%

Debit card fees

    951,200       970,800       (19,600 )     (2.0 )

Fees on interest rate swaps on commercial loans

    616,018       39,160       576,858       1,473.1  

Miscellaneous

    1,557,004       1,871,908       (314,904 )     (16.8 )

Other noninterest income

  $ 3,704,222     $ 2,881,868     $ 822,354       28.5

%

 

During the first quarter of 2013, QCBT sold its credit card loan portfolio for a pre-tax gain on sale of $495 thousand. In addition, QCBT sold its credit card issuing operations to the same purchaser for a pre-tax gain on sale of $355 thousand. The latter was the primary reason for the decline in the credit card fees, net of processing costs, during 2013.

 

 
37

 

 

In December 2013, QCBT sold certain related nonperforming loans at a gain of $576 thousand.

 

In recent years, as a result of the sustained historically low interest rate environment, CRBT introduced the execution of interest rate swaps on select commercial loans. The interest rate swaps allow the commercial borrowers to pay a fixed interest rate while CRBT receives a variable interest rate as well as an upfront fee dependent upon the pricing. CRBT executed several interest rate swaps in 2012 which generated strong fee income. Management believes that these swaps help position CRBT more favorably for rising rate environments. Management will continue to review opportunities to execute these swaps at all of its subsidiary banks as the circumstances are appropriate for the borrower and the Company.

 

In 2012, the Company recognized $580 thousand pre-tax gain on the sale of a small equity interest in a company that provided data processing services to the Company’s merchant credit card acquiring business that was previously sold in 2008.

 

 
38

 

 

NONINTEREST EXPENSES. The following tables set forth the various categories of noninterest expenses for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

Years Ended

                 
   

December 31, 2013

   

December 31, 2012

   

$ Change

   

% Change

 
                                 

Salaries and employee benefits

  $ 37,510,318     $ 33,274,509     $ 4,235,809       12.7

%

Occupancy and equipment expense

    6,712,468       5,635,257       1,077,211       19.1  

Professional and data processing fees

    6,424,594       4,317,939       2,106,655       48.8  

FDIC and other insurance

    2,587,041       2,330,611       256,430       11.0  

Loan/lease expense

    1,521,523       1,041,824       479,699       46.0  

Advertising and marketing

    1,726,314       1,445,476       280,838       19.4  

Postage and telephone

    1,069,142       959,708       109,434       11.4  

Stationery and supplies

    562,301       541,122       21,179       3.9  

Bank service charges

    1,144,757       853,895       290,862       34.1  

Subtotal

  $ 59,258,458     $ 50,400,341     $ 8,858,117       17.6  

Acquisition and data conversion costs

    2,353,162       -       2,353,162       100.0  

Other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities

    -       62,400       (62,400 )     (100.0 )

Other

    2,821,038       1,796,206       1,024,832       57.1  

Total noninterest expense

  $ 64,432,658     $ 52,258,947     $ 12,173,711       23.3

%

 

 

   

Years Ended

                 
   

December 31, 2012

   

December 31, 2011

   

$ Change

   

% Change

 
                                 

Salaries and employee benefits

  $ 33,274,509     $ 30,365,020     $ 2,909,489       9.6

%

Occupancy and equipment expense

    5,635,257       5,297,949       337,308       6.4  

Professional and data processing fees

    4,317,939       4,461,187       (143,248 )     (3.2 )

FDIC and other insurance

    2,330,611       2,698,282       (367,671 )     (13.6 )

Loan/lease expense

    1,041,824       2,160,674       (1,118,850 )     (51.8 )

Advertising and marketing

    1,445,476       1,288,797       156,679       12.2  

Postage and telephone

    959,708       937,557       22,151       2.4  

Stationery and supplies

    541,122       516,873       24,249       4.7  

Bank service charges

    853,895       725,717       128,178       17.7  

Subtotal

  $ 50,400,341     $ 48,452,056     $ 1,948,285       4.0  

Prepayment fees on Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    -       832,099       (832,099 )     100.0  

Other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities

    62,400       118,847       (56,447 )     (47.5 )

Other

    1,796,206       1,589,650       206,556       13.0  

Total noninterest expense

  $ 52,258,947     $ 50,992,652     $ 1,266,295       2.5

%

 

Management places strong emphasis on overall cost containment and is committed to improving the Company’s general efficiency. The addition of CNB’s cost structure impacted the Company’s noninterest expenses. Management executed on its integration plan throughout 2013 to help increase efficiency and realize cost savings.  

 

 
39

 

 

Salaries and employee benefits, which is the largest component of noninterest expense, increased 13% and 10% in 2013 and 2012, respectively. For 2013, the increase was largely due to the addition of CNB’s cost structure for more than half of the year. Excluding the impact of CNB, the Company’s increases were largely the result of:

 

 

Customary annual salary and benefits increases for the majority of the Company’s employee base in 2013 and 2012.

 

Continued increases in health insurance-related employee benefits for the majority of the Company’s employee base.

 

Higher accrued incentive compensation based on improved financial performance in 2012 and 2013.

 

Targeted talent additions in late 2011 and early 2012. Specifically, the Company added four business development officers (three in the Wealth Management Division and one in the Correspondent Banking Division) in an effort to continue to grow market share.

 

Occupancy and equipment expense increased in 2013 due to the addition of CNB’s branch network. At acquisition, CNB had eight branches, and the Company sold four in early October and closed one in December. Additionally, over the past two years, the Company incurred increased equipment cost with the purchases of additional technology for enhanced customer service and improved fraud detection and prevention systems. In addition, the largest branch office of RB&T was renovated in 2012 to allow for existing and future expansion.

 

Professional and data processing fees jumped 48% in 2013 compared to 2012. This increase was due to the addition of CNB’s cost structure and increased legal fees for a longstanding legal matter concerning a past nonperforming loan that experienced increased litigation activity in 2013. The Company, the plaintiff in the litigation, was awarded judgment in an amount to be paid by the defendant. The defendant, however, appealed the court’s decision in January 2014. Management will continue to focus on minimizing one-time costs and driving those recurring costs down through contract renegotiation or managed reduction in activity where costs are determined on a usage basis.

 

FDIC and other insurance expense has generally fallen over the past several years since the FDIC modified its assessment calculation to more closely align with bank performance and risk. The increase in 2013 was primarily the result of adding CNB for more than half of the year.

 

Loan/lease expense fluctuated significantly over the past two years with a 46% increase during 2013, and a 52% decline in 2012. Some of the increase in 2013 was the result of adding CNB’s cost structure. In addition, the Company incurred elevated levels of expense at the legacy banks for certain existing nonperforming loans as workouts progressed. Generally, loan/lease expense has a direct relationship with the level of nonperforming loans/leases; however, it may deviate depending upon the individual nonperforming loans/leases. Management expects these historically elevated levels of expense to continue to decline in line with the declining trend in nonperforming loans/leases.

 

The Company incurred additional expenses for advertising and marketing during 2013 and 2012 in an effort to gain market share across all four markets the Company serves. Part of the increase in 2013 was the addition of CNB’s cost structure for more than half of the year.

 

Bank service charges, which include costs incurred to provide services to QCBT’s correspondent banking customer portfolio, increased significantly over the past two years. The increase was due, in large part, to the success QCBT has had in growing its correspondent banking customer portfolio over the past two years.

 

With the acquisition of Community National on May 13, 2013, the Company incurred costs related to the acquisition including professional fees (legal, investment banking, accounting), data conversion costs (including both the de-conversion of the sold branches and the conversion of the remaining branches), and compensation costs for retained and severed employees. In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the Company expensed these costs as incurred.  

 

 
40

 

 

In an effort to utilize some of its excess liquidity and improve net interest margin by eliminating some of its higher cost wholesale funding, QCBT prepaid $15.0 million of FHLB advances during the first quarter of 2011. As a result, QCBT incurred a prepayment fee totaling $832 thousand. To offset these fees, QCBT sold $37.4 million of government sponsored agency securities for a pre-tax gain totaling $880 thousand. See a detailed discussion of this restructuring transaction in the Net Interest Income and Margin section earlier in Management’s Discussion and Analysis.

 

During 2012, the Company’s evaluation of its securities portfolio for other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) determined that two privately held equity securities experienced declines in fair value that were other-than-temporary. As a result, the Company wrote down the value of these securities and recognized losses in the amount of $62 thousand. Similarly, during 2011, the Company’s evaluation determined that two privately held equity securities experienced declines in fair value that were other-than-temporary and the Company wrote down the value of these securities and recognized losses in the amount of $119 thousand. There were no OTTI losses in 2013.

 

INCOME TAX EXPENSE. The provision for income taxes was $4.6 million for 2013, or an effective tax rate of 23.6%, compared to $4.5 million for 2012, or an effective tax rate of 25.7%, and compared to $3.9 million for 2011, or an effective tax rate of 27.6%. The declines in the effective tax rate were primarily the result of the following:

 

 

The continued increases in tax-exempt income for securities and BOLI. For securities, tax-exempt interest income on municipal securities grew 137% in 2012 and 77% in 2013. This growth rate outpaced the growth rate of the Company’s taxable income.

 

The continued application of tax credits that were acquired in the third quarter of 2011.

 

 

FINANCIAL CONDITION

 

OVERVIEW. Following is a table that represents the major categories of the Company’s balance sheet.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 

Cash, federal funds sold, and interest-bearing deposits

  $ 114,431       5 %   $ 110,488       5 %   $ 100,673       5 %

Securities

    697,210       29 %     602,239       29 %     565,229       29 %

Net loans/leases

    1,438,832       60 %     1,267,462       61 %     1,181,956       60 %

Other assets

    144,480       6 %     113,541       5 %     118,752       6 %

Total assets

  $ 2,394,953       100 %   $ 2,093,730       100 %   $ 1,966,610       100 %
                                                 

Total deposits

  $ 1,646,991       69 %   $ 1,374,114       66 %   $ 1,205,458       61 %

Total borrowings

    563,381       24 %     547,758       26 %     590,603       30 %

Other liabilities

    37,004       1 %     31,424       1 %     26,116       1 %

Total stockholders' equity

    147,577       6 %     140,434       7 %     144,433       8 %

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 2,394,953       100 %   $ 2,093,730       100 %   $ 1,966,610       100 %

 

In 2013, total assets grew $301.2 million, or 14%, as a result of the acquisition of CNB and organic growth in the Company’s legacy markets. Specifically, excluding the impact of the branch sales, the Company grew loans/leases $225.8 million, or 18%, during 2013. Additionally, the Company grew its securities portfolio $95.0 million, or 16%, during 2013 with most of this growth in tax-exempt municipal securities. The earning asset growth was funded primarily by deposits which grew $363.9 million, or 26%, excluding the impact of the branch sales. 

 

 
41

 

 

In 2012, total assets grew $127.1 million, or 6%. The Company grew its net loan/lease portfolio $85.5 million, or 7%, and its securities portfolio $37.0 million, or 7%, during 2012. The asset growth was funded by strong and continued growth of the Company’s deposit portfolio (as balances grew $168.7 million, or 14%) partially offset by a reduction in federal funds purchased.

 

INVESTMENT SECURITIES. The composition of the Company’s securities portfolio is managed to meet liquidity needs while prioritizing the impact on asset-liability position and maximizing return. With the strong growth in deposits more than outpacing the loan growth in recent years, the Company has grown and diversified its securities portfolio, including increasing the portfolio of agency sponsored residential mortgage-backed securities as well as more than tripling the portfolio of municipal securities. Of the latter, the large majority are privately placed debt issuances by municipalities located in the Midwest (with some in or near the Company’s existing markets) and require a thorough underwriting process before investment. As the portfolio has grown over the recent years, management has elevated its focus on maximizing return while minimizing credit and interest rate risk. Additionally, management will continue to diversify the portfolio with further growth strictly dictated by the pace of growth in deposits and loans. Ideally, management expects to fund future loan growth partially with cashflow from the securities portfolio (calls and maturities of government sponsored agencies, paydowns on residential mortgage-backed securities, and/or targeted sales of securities that meet certain criteria as defined by management).

 

Following is a breakdown of the Company’s securities portfolio by type as of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 356,473       51 %   $ 338,609       56 %   $ 428,955       76 %

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

    157,429       23 %     163,601       27 %     108,854       19 %

Municipal securities

    180,361       26 %     97,615       17 %     25,689       5 %

Trust preferred securities

    -       0 %     139       0 %     81       0 %

Other securities

    2,947       0 %     2,275       0 %     1,650       0 %
    $ 697,210       100 %   $ 602,239       100 %   $ 565,229       100 %
                                                 

As a % of Total Assets

    29.11 %             28.76 %             28.74 %        

Net Unrealized Gains (Losses) as a % of Amortized Cost

    -4.02 %             1.44 %             1.38 %        

Duration (in years)

    4.7               2.8               1.8          

 

As a result of an increase in longer-term interest rates in 2013, the Company’s fair value of its securities portfolio switched from a net unrealized gain position (approximately 1.4% of amortized cost at the end of 2012 and 2011) to a net unrealized loss position (approximately 4.0% at the end of 2013). Management monitors the level of unrealized gains/losses including performing quarterly reviews of individual securities for evidence of OTTI. Management identified no OTTI in 2013.

 

The duration of the securities portfolio has lengthened over the past two years for two reasons:

 

 

A portion of the government-sponsored agency securities contain call options at the discretion of the issuer whereby the issuer can call the security at par at certain times which vary by individual security. With the sharp increase in longer-term rates in 2013, the duration of these callable agency securities lengthened as the likelihood of a call became remote.

 

The increased investment in tax-exempt municipal securities which tend to be longer term (average maturity is approximately 7 years). Management understands that this extended the duration of its securities portfolio and continually evaluates the combined benefit of increased interest income and reduced effective income tax rate and the impact on interest rate risk.

 

The Company has not invested in commercial mortgage-backed securities or pooled trust preferred securities. Additionally, the Company has not invested in the types of securities subject to the Volcker Rule (a provision of the Dodd-Frank Act).

 

 
42

 

 

See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information regarding the Company’s investment securities. 

 

LOANS/LEASES. The Company’s gross loan/lease portfolio grew $171.4 million, or 13%, during 2013. Excluding the impact of the branch sales, the Company grew loans/leases $225.8 million, or 18%, during 2013. With the addition of CNB’s loan portfolio and organic growth at the Company’s legacy markets, the mix of loans/leases was relatively flat from 2012 to 2013.

 

The Company’s gross loan/lease portfolio grew $86.6 million, or 7%, from $1.20 billion at December 31, 2011, to $1.29 billion at December 31, 2012. The growth was spread out over commercial and industrial loans ($43.5 million, or 12%), owner-occupied commercial real estate loans ($37.1 million, or 22%), residential real estate loans ($17.5 million, or 18%), and direct financing leases ($10.5 million, or 11%). Partially offsetting this growth, commercial construction loans ($15.4 million, or 26%) and other non-owner occupied commercial real estate loans ($4.9 million, or 1%) declined. The shift in mix within the commercial loan portfolio in 2012 was favorable as commercial construction and other non-owner commercial real estate loans are historically riskier than commercial and industrial and owner-occupied commercial real estate loans.

 

The mix of loan/lease types within the Company’s loan/lease portfolio is presented in the following table.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

   

2010

   

2009

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Commercial and industrial loans

  $ 431,688       30 %   $ 394,244       31 %   $ 350,794       29 %   $ 365,625       31 %   $ 441,536       36 %

Commercial real estate loans

    671,753       46 %     593,979       46 %     577,804       48 %     553,717       47 %     556,007       45 %

Direct financing leases

    128,902       9 %     103,686       8 %     93,212       8 %     83,010       7 %     90,059       7 %

Residential real estate loans

    147,356       10 %     115,582       9 %     98,107       8 %     82,197       7 %     70,608       6 %

Installment and other consumer loans

    76,034       5 %     76,720       6 %     78,223       7 %     86,240       8 %     84,271       6 %

Total loans/leases

  $ 1,455,733       100 %   $ 1,284,211       100 %   $ 1,198,140       100 %   $ 1,170,789       100 %   $ 1,242,481       100 %
                                                                                 

Plus deferred loan/lease origination costs, net of fees

    4,547               3,176               2,605               1,750               1,839          

Less allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases

    (21,448 )             (19,925 )             (18,789 )             (20,365 )             (22,505 )        

Net loans/leases

  $ 1,438,832             $ 1,267,462             $ 1,181,956             $ 1,152,174             $ 1,221,815          

 

Historically, the Company structures most residential real estate loans to conform to the underwriting requirements of Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae to allow the subsidiary banks to resell the loans on the secondary market avoiding the interest rate risk associated with longer term fixed rate loans and recognizing noninterest income for the gain on sale. Loans originated for this purpose were classified as held for sale and are included in the residential real estate loans in the table above. Historically, the subsidiary banks structure most loans that will not conform to those underwriting requirements as adjustable rate mortgages that mature or adjust in one to five years, and then retain these loans in their portfolios. During 2011 and 2012, the Company originated and held a limited amount of 15-year fixed rate residential real estate loans that met certain credit guidelines. In 2013, the Company discontinued this specific strategy to originate and hold certain 15-year fixed residential real estate loans. The remaining residential real estate loans originated by the Company were sold on the secondary market to avoid the interest rate risk associated with longer term fixed rate loans. In addition, the Company has not originated any subprime, Alt-A, no documentation, or stated income residential real estate loans throughout its history.  

 

 
43

 

 

The following tables set forth the remaining maturities by loan/lease type as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. Maturities are based on contractual dates.

 

   

As of December 31, 2013

 
                           

Maturities After One Year

 
   

Due in one

year or less

   

Due after one

through 5 years

   

Due after

5 years

   

Predetermined

interest rates

   

Adjustable

interest rates

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Commerical and industrial loans

  $ 159,145     $ 199,936     $ 72,607     $ 172,889     $ 99,654  

Commercial real estate loans

    111,686       407,750       152,317       421,568       138,499  

Direct financing leases

    4,292       117,106       7,504       124,610       -  

Residential real estate loans

    3,213       2,558       141,585       100,492       43,651  

Installment and other consumer loans

    17,935       49,612       8,487       30,999       27,100  
    $ 296,271     $ 776,962     $ 382,500     $ 850,558     $ 308,904  

Percentage of total loans/leases

    20 %     54 %     26 %     73 %     27 %

 

 

   

As of December 31, 2012

 
                           

Maturities After One Year

 
   

Due in one

year or less

   

Due after one through 5 years

   

Due after

5 years

   

Predetermined interest rates

   

Adjustable

interest rates

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Commerical and industrial loans

  $ 183,891     $ 147,051     $ 63,302     $ 117,183     $ 93,170  

Commercial real estate loans

    135,789       328,703       129,487       322,114       136,076  

Direct financing leases

    4,256       95,675       3,755       99,430       -  

Residential real estate loans

    1,717       2,253       111,612       75,573       38,292  

Installment and other consumer loans

    33,132       38,566       5,022       23,322       20,266  
    $ 358,785     $ 612,248     $ 313,178     $ 637,622     $ 287,804  

Percentage of total loans/leases

    28 %     48 %     24 %     69 %     31 %

 

Over the past two years, the Company has seen modest extension of its overall loan/lease portfolio. With the growth in municipal securities and residential real estate loans, both of which are longer duration assets with fixed interest rates, it is important that the Company limits extension of the rest of the loan portfolio in an effort to limit exposure to rising rate scenarios. The strategy, discussed in the Noninterest Income section, for execution of interest rate swaps on commercial loans helps to offset the growth of the longer term fixed rate assets and maintain a favorable interest rate risk profile.

 

Management continues to focus on growing quality loans/leases and carefully monitors maturities and interest rate sensitivity of the current portfolio. 

 

See Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information on the Company’s loan/lease portfolio.  

 

 
44

 

 

ALLOWANCE FOR ESTIMATED LOSSES ON LOANS/LEASES. The allowance totaled $21.4 million at December 31, 2013, which was an increase of $1.5 million, or 8%, from $19.9 million at December 31, 2012. Provision totaled $5.9 million for 2013 and outpaced net charge-offs of $4.4 million (or 31 basis points of average loans/leases outstanding).

 

The allowance totaled $19.9 million at December 31, 2012, which was an increase of $1.1 million, or 6%, from $18.8 million at December 31, 2011. Provision totaled $4.4 million for 2012 and outpaced net charge-offs of $3.2 million, or 27 basis points of average loans/leases outstanding, which was the lowest level since 2008.

 

The following table summarizes the activity in the allowance.

 

   

Years ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

   

2010

   

2009

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Average amount of loans/leases outstanding, before allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases

  $ 1,425,364     $ 1,219,623     $ 1,177,705     $ 1,209,587     $ 1,222,493  

Allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases:

                                       

Balance, beginning of fiscal period

  $ 19,925     $ 18,789     $ 20,365     $ 22,505     $ 17,809  

Charge-offs:

                                       

Commercial and industrial

    (963 )     (683 )     (3,334 )     (2,609 )     (7,510 )

Commercial real estate

    (3,573 )     (2,232 )     (3,682 )     (5,922 )     (2,824 )

Direct financing leases

    (917 )     (740 )     (1,101 )     (999 )     (1,255 )

Residential real estate

    (162 )     (4 )     -       (35 )     (314 )

Installment and other consumer

    (229 )     (717 )     (945 )     (1,135 )     (2,104 )

Subtotal charge-offs

    (5,844 )     (4,376 )     (9,062 )     (10,700 )     (14,007 )

Recoveries:

                                       

Commercial and industrial

    626       663       414       380       344  

Commercial real estate

    574       222       287       381       98  

Direct financing leases

    12       77       3       163       52  

Residential real estate

    17       -       -       -       40  

Installment and other consumer

    208       179       166       172       1,193  

Subtotal recoveries

    1,437       1,141       870       1,096       1,727  

Net charge-offs

    (4,407 )     (3,235 )     (8,192 )     (9,604 )     (12,280 )

Provision charged to expense

    5,930       4,371       6,616       7,464       16,976  

Balance, end of fiscal year

  $ 21,448     $ 19,925     $ 18,789     $ 20,365     $ 22,505  
                                         

Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans/leases outstanding

    0.31 %     0.27 %     0.70 %     0.79 %     1.00 %

 

The adequacy of the allowance was determined by management based on factors that included the overall composition of the loan/lease portfolio, types of loans/leases, historical loss experience, loan/lease delinquencies, potential substandard and doubtful credits, economic conditions, collateral positions, government guarantees and other factors that, in management's judgment, deserved evaluation. To ensure that an adequate allowance was maintained, provisions were made based on the increase/decrease in loans/leases and a detailed analysis of the loan/lease portfolio. The loan/lease portfolio was reviewed and analyzed monthly with specific detailed reviews completed on all credits risk-rated less than “fair quality” and carrying aggregate exposure in excess of $100 thousand. The adequacy of the allowance was monitored by the credit administration staff and reported to management and the board of directors. 

 

 
45

 

 

The Company continued the strengthening of its core loan portfolio as the levels of criticized and classified loans declined in 2013 and 2012, as reported in the following table.

 

    As of December 31,  

Internally Assigned Risk Rating *

 

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
    (dollars in thousands)  

Special Mention (Rating 6)

  $ 24,572     $ 22,056     $ 26,034  

Substandard (Rating 7)

    43,508       48,248       62,712  

Doubtful (Rating 8)

    -       -       -  
    $ 68,080     $ 70,304     $ 88,746  
                         

Criticized Loans **

  $ 68,080     $ 70,304     $ 88,746  

Classified Loans ***

  $ 43,508     $ 48,248     $ 62,712  

 

* Amounts above exclude the government guaranteed portion, if any. The Company assigns internal risk ratings of Pass (Rating 2) for the government guaranteed portion.

** Criticized loans are defined as commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans with internally assigned risk ratings of 6, 7, or 8, regardless of performance.

*** Classified loans are defined as commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans with internally assigned risk ratings of 7 or 8, regardless of performance.

 

The declining trend in criticized and classified loans over the past two years translated to a reduction in nonperforming loans/leases (consisting of nonaccrual loans/leases, accruing loans/leases past due 90 days or more, and accruing troubled debt restructurings) of $4.9 million, or 19%, during 2013 and $6.6 million, or 21%, during 2012. Furthermore, nonperforming loans/leases have declined $27.3 million, or 57%, from their peak at September 30, 2010. See the table in the following section for further detail on nonperforming loans/leases and nonperforming assets. As a direct result, the level of allowance as a percentage of gross loans/leases has declined since 2009. Further, in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for acquisition accounting, the acquired CNB loans were recorded at fair value; therefore, there was no allowance associated with CNB’s loans at acquisition. Additionally, the Company has strengthened its allowance as a percentage of nonperforming loans/leases. The following table summarizes the trend in allowance as a percentage of gross loans/leases and as a percentage of nonperforming loans/leases as of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Allowance / Gross Loans/Leases

    1.47 %     1.55 %     1.56 %

Allowance / Nonperforming Loans/Leases

    104.70 %     78.47 %     58.70 %

 

 
46

 

 

The following table presents the allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases by type and the percentage of loan/lease type to total loans/leases.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

   

2010

   

2009

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Commercial and industrial loans

    5,649       26 %     4,532       31 %     4,878       29 %     7,549       31 %     6,239       36 %

Commercial real estate loans

    10,705       50 %     11,070       46 %     10,597       48 %     9,087       47 %     11,147       45 %

Direct financing leases

    2,517       12 %     1,990       8 %     1,339       8 %     1,531       7 %     1,681       7 %

Residential real estate loans

    1,396       7 %     1,070       9 %     705       8 %     748       7 %     737       6 %

Installment and other consumer loans

    1,181       5 %     1,263       6 %     1,270       7 %     1,450       8 %     2,407       6 %

Unallocated

    -    

NA

      -    

NA

      -    

NA

      -    

NA

      294    

NA

 
    $ 21,448       100 %   $ 19,925       100 %   $ 18,789       100 %   $ 20,365       100 %   $ 22,505       100 %

 

% - Represents the percentage of the certain type of loan/lease to total loans/leases

 

Although management believes that the allowance at December 31, 2013 was at a level adequate to absorb probable losses on existing loans/leases, there can be no assurance that such losses will not exceed the estimated amounts or that the Company will not be required to make additional provisions for loan/lease losses in the future. Unpredictable future events could adversely affect cash flows for both commercial and individual borrowers, which could cause the Company to experience increases in problem assets, delinquencies and losses on loans/leases, and require additional increases in the provision. Asset quality is a priority for the Company and its subsidiaries. The ability to grow profitably is in part dependent upon the ability to maintain that quality. The Company continually focuses efforts at its subsidiary banks and its leasing company with the intention to improve the overall quality of the Company’s loan/lease portfolio.      

 

See Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information on the Company’s allowance.

 

NONPERFORMING ASSETS. The table below presents the amounts of nonperforming assets.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

   

2010

   

2009

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Nonaccrual loans/leases (1) (2)

  $ 17,878     $ 17,932     $ 18,995     $ 37,427     $ 28,742  

Accruing loans/leases past due 90 days or more

    84       159       1,111       320       89  

Troubled debt restructures - accruing

    2,523       7,300       11,904       3,405       1,201  

Nonperforming loans/leases

    20,485       25,391       32,010       41,152       30,032  

Other real estate owned

    9,729       3,955       8,386       8,535       9,286  

Other repossessed assets

    346       212       109       366       1,071  

Nonperforming assets

  $ 30,560     $ 29,558     $ 40,505     $ 50,053     $ 40,389  
                                         

Nonperforming loans/leases to total loans/leases

    1.40 %     1.97 %     2.67 %     3.51 %     2.41 %

Nonperforming assets to total loans/leases plus reposessed property

    2.08 %     2.29 %     3.35 %     4.24 %     3.22 %

Nonperforming assets to total assets

    1.28 %     1.41 %     2.06 %     2.73 %     2.27 %

Texas ratio (3)

    18.43 %     18.68 %     25.58 %     33.57 %     27.47 %

 

 

(1)

Includes government guaranteed portions of loans, if applicable.

 

(2)

Includes troubled debt restructurings of $10.9 million at December 31, 2013, $5.7 million at December 31, 2012, $8.6 million at December 31, 2011, $12.6 million at December 31, 2010 and none at December 31, 2009.

 

(3)

Texas Ratio = Nonperforming Assets (excluding Other Repossessed Assets) / Tangible Equity plus Allowance for Estimated Losses on Loans/Leases. Texas Ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. Management included the ratio as it is considered by many investors and analysts to be a metric with which to analyze and evaluate asset quality. Other companies may calculate this ratio differently.

 

Historically, the large majority of the Company’s nonperforming assets consisted of nonaccrual loans/leases and OREO. For nonaccrual loans/leases, management thoroughly reviewed these loans/leases and provided specific allowances as appropriate. OREO is carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.

 

 
47

 

 

The policy of the Company is to place a loan/lease on nonaccrual status if: (a) payment in full of interest or principal is not expected; or (b) principal or interest has been in default for a period of 90 days or more unless the obligation is both in the process of collection and well secured. A loan/lease is well secured if it is secured by collateral with sufficient market value to repay principal and all accrued interest. A debt is in the process of collection if collection of the debt is proceeding in due course either through legal action, including judgment enforcement procedures, or in appropriate circumstances, through collection efforts not involving legal action which are reasonably expected to result in repayment of the debt or in its restoration to current status. 

 

In 2013, the Company’s nonperforming assets increased $1.0 million, or 3%. Most of this increase was due to the addition of CNB’s nonperforming assets, which totaled $2.1 million at December 31, 2013. Excluding the impact of CNB, the Company’s nonperforming assets at its legacy charters experienced a decline of $1.0 million, or 4%. There was a shift in mix as accruing troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) fell $4.8 million and OREO grew $5.8 million. The decline in accruing TDRs was the result of improved performance on several larger credits. The growth in OREO was the result of foreclosure on the collateral securing two nonperforming loans at the Company’s legacy charters. Management continues to proactively manage its OREO portfolio in an effort to sell timely at minimal loss. In 2012, the Company’s nonperforming assets declined $10.9 million, or 27%, from 2011. A combination of improved performance and charge-offs contributed to this decrease.

 

The Company’s lending/leasing practices remain unchanged and asset quality remains a top priority for management.

 

DEPOSITS. Deposits grew $272.9 million, or 20%, during 2013. Excluding the impact of the branch sales, deposits grew $363.9 million, or 26%, in 2013. For 2012, deposits grew $168.7 million, or 14%. The table below presents the composition of the Company’s deposit portfolio.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Noninterest bearing demand deposits

  $ 542,566       33 %   $ 450,660       33 %   $ 357,184       30 %

Interest bearing demand deposits

    715,643       43 %     588,912       43 %     510,788       42 %

Time deposits

    326,852       20 %     289,222       21 %     292,575       24 %

Brokered time deposits

    61,930       4 %     45,320       3 %     44,911       4 %
    $ 1,646,991       100 %   $ 1,374,114       100 %   $ 1,205,458       100 %

 

The Company has been successful in shifting the deposit mix over the past two years with an increase in noninterest bearing deposits and declines in the percentage of brokered and retail time deposits. Specifically, QCBT continues to have success growing its correspondent banking business as noninterest bearing correspondent deposits have grown $103.3 million, or 69%, over the past two years to reach a total of $252.4 million at December 31, 2013. These increases and the Company’s overall strong liquidity position have allowed the Company to reduce the level and percentage of brokered and other time deposits which drives the reduction in the Company’s average cost of deposits. Management will continue to focus on growing its noninterest bearing deposit portfolio, including its correspondent banking business at QCBT, as well as shifting the mix from brokered and other higher cost deposits to lower cost core deposits. With the significant success achieved by QCBT in growing its correspondent banking business, QCBT has developed procedures to proactively monitor this industry concentration of deposits and loans. See discussion regarding policy limits on bank stock loans in the Lending/Leasing section under Item 1 – Business in Part I of this Form 10-K.  

 

 
48

 

 

SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS. The subsidiary banks offer overnight repurchase agreements to some of their major customers. Also, the subsidiary banks purchase federal funds for short-term funding needs from the Federal Reserve Bank, or from their correspondent banks. The table below presents the composition of the Company’s short-term borrowings.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
                         

Overnight repurchase agreements with customers

  $ 98,823     $ 104,943     $ 110,236  

Federal funds purchased

    50,470       66,140       103,300  
    $ 149,293     $ 171,083     $ 213,536  

 

The decline in overnight repurchase agreements with customers is a function of management directing some of these customer funds to deposit products which do not require collateral helping to free up additional liquidity for the Company. Regarding the Company’s federal funds purchased, this fluctuates based on the short-term funding needs of the Company’s subsidiary banks. See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information on the Company’s short-term borrowings.

 

FHLB ADVANCES AND OTHER BORROWINGS. As a result of their memberships in the FHLB of Des Moines and Chicago, the subsidiary banks have the ability to borrow funds for short-term or long-term purposes under a variety of programs. The subsidiary banks utilize FHLB advances for loan matching as a hedge against the possibility of rising interest rates or when these advances provide a less costly source of funds than customer deposits. For 2013, FHLB advances increased $29.0 million, or 14%, as RB&T and CRBT borrowed overnight and other short-term advances for short-term funding needs because the cost of the FHLB advance was less than federal funds purchased. For 2012, FHLB advances declined slightly.

 

    As of December 31,  
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Amount Due

  $ 231,350     $ 202,350     $ 204,750  

Weighted Average Interest Rate at Year-End

    2.86 %     3.45 %     3.67 %

 

See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information regarding FHLB advances.

 

Other borrowings consist largely of wholesale structured repurchase agreements which the subsidiary banks utilize as an alternative funding source to FHLB advances and customer deposits. The table below presents the composition of the Company’s other borrowings.

 

    As of December 31,  
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Wholesale structured repurchase agreements

  $ 130,000     $ 130,000     $ 130,000  

Term note

    9,800       -       -  

364-day revolving note

    -       5,600       3,600  

Series A subordinated notes

    2,648       2,640       2,632  
    $ 142,448     $ 138,240     $ 136,232  

 

 

 
49

 

 

In order to fund the cash portion of the consideration for the acquisition and pay off the $3.95 million of Community National term debt at acquisition, the Company borrowed $4.4 million on its 364-day revolving note. The outstanding balance on the 364-day revolving note totaled $10.0 million until maturity at June 26, 2013. Upon maturity, the credit facility was restructured whereby the $10.0 million of outstanding debt was restructured into a secured 3-year term note with principal due quarterly and interest due monthly where the interest is calculated at the effective LIBOR rate plus 3.00% per annum (3.17% at December 31, 2013). Additionally, as part of the restructuring, the Company maintained a secured 364-day revolving credit note with availability of $10.0 million where the interest is calculated at the effective LIBOR rate plus 2.50% per annum. At December 31, 2013, the Company had not borrowed on this revolving credit note and had the full amount available.

 

For 2012, the increase in borrowing on the 364-day revolving note of $2.0 million was the result of funding needed to execute on the partial redemption of the Series F Preferred Stock previously issued to the Treasury under the SBLF program. For a detailed discussion of this partial redemption, see below.

 

Additional information regarding other borrowings is described in Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

It is management’s intention to continue to reduce the reliance on wholesale funding, including FHLB advances, structured repos, and brokered time deposits. Replacement of this funding with core deposits helps to reduce interest expense as the wholesale funding tends to be higher funding cost. Management continually evaluates the potential opportunities to prepay or modify (essentially refinance at a net lower interest rate while extending the maturity) these liabilities, as the Company has successfully executed in the past. The table below presents the maturity schedule including weighted average cost for the Company’s combined wholesale funding portfolio.

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

 

Maturity:

 

Amount Due

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate at

Quarter-End

   

Amount Due

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate at

Year-End

 

Year ending December 31:

 

(dollar amounts in thousands)

 

2013

  $ -       0.00%     $ 34,508       1.29 %

2014

    110,521       1.24       39,170       2.88  

2015

    41,000       2.00       66,000       2.59  

2016

    48,642       3.63       85,992       3.72  

2017

    43,075       3.43       46,000       3.70  

2018

    58,042       3.47       51,000       3.66  

Thereafter

    122,000       3.33       55,000       3.67  

Total Wholesale Funding

    423,280       2.72       377,670       3.20  

  

 
50

 

 

STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY. The table below presents the composition of the Company’s stockholders’ equity, including the common and preferred equity components.

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

   

Amount

   

%

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Common stock

  $ 8,006             $ 5,039             $ 4,879          

Additional paid in capital - common

    60,360               25,804               26,381          

Retained earnings

    64,637               53,327               44,586          

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

    (13,644 )             4,707               4,755          

Noncontrolling interests

    -               -               2,052          

Less: Treasury stock

    (1,606 )             (1,606 )             (1,606 )        

Total common stockholders' equity

    117,753       80 %     87,271       62 %     81,047       56 %
                                                 

Preferred stock

    30               55               65          

Additional paid in capital - preferred

    29,794               53,108               63,321          

Total preferred stockholders' equity

    29,824       20 %     53,163       38 %     63,386       44 %

Total stockholders' equity

  $ 147,577       100 %   $ 140,434       100 %   $ 144,433       100 %

Tangible common equity* / total tangible assets

    4.71 %             4.02 %             3.85 %        

 

*Tangible common equity is defined as total common stockholders’ equity excluding equity of noncontrolling interests and excluding goodwill and other intangible assets. This ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. Management included this ratio as it is considered by many investors and analysts to be a metric with which to analyze and evaluate the equity composition. Other companies may calculate this ratio differently.

 

The following table presents the details of the preferred stock issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

 

     

As of December 31, 2013

 
 

Date Issued

 

Aggregate

Purchase Price

   

Stated Dividend

Rate

   

Annual

Dividend

 
                           

Series E Non-Cumulative Convertible Perpetual Preferred Stock

June 2010

  $ -       7.00 %   $ -  

Series F Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

September 2011

    29,867,000       5.00 %     1,493,350  
      $ 29,867,000             $ 1,493,350  

 

     

As of December 31, 2012

 
 

Date Issued

 

Aggregate

Purchase Price

   

Stated Dividend

Rate

   

Annual

Dividend

 
                           

Series E Non-Cumulative Convertible Perpetual Preferred Stock

June 2010

  $ 25,000,000       7.00 %   $ 1,750,000  

Series F Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

September 2011

    29,867,000       5.00 %     1,493,350  
      $ 54,867,000             $ 3,243,350  

 

The Series E Noncumulative Convertible Perpetual Preferred Stock (the “Series E Preferred Stock”) was converted into the Company’s common stock on December 23, 2013. Pursuant to the terms of the Series E Preferred Stock, because the Company’s common stock price exceeded $17.22 for at least 20 trading days in a period of 30 consecutive trading days, the Company’s Board of Directors approved the conversion and the preferred stockholders were notified by mail on November 21, 2013. Each share of Series E Preferred Stock was converted into the number of shares of common stock that resulted from dividing $1,000 (the issuance price per share of the Series E Preferred Stock) by $12.15 (the conversion price per share). As a result of the conversion, the Company issued 2,057,502 shares of common stock.  

 

 
51

 

 

Regarding the Series F Preferred Stock, non-cumulative dividends are payable quarterly, and the dividend rate is based on changes in the level of “Qualified Small Business Lending” or “QSBL” by the Company’s wholly owned bank subsidiaries, QCBT, CRBT and RB&T. Based upon the change in the subsidiary banks’ level of QSBL over the baseline level (as defined by the SBLF, the baseline is the average of QSBL for the last two quarters of 2009 and the first two quarters of 2010), the dividend rate for the first 10 calendar quarters may be adjusted to between 1% and 5%. For the 11th calendar quarter through 4.5 years after issuance, the dividend rate is fixed at between 1% and 5%, based upon the increase in QSBL from the baseline level to the level as of the end of the ninth dividend period (i.e. as of September 30, 2013), or is fixed at 7% if there is no increase or there is a decrease in QSBL during such period. In addition, beginning on April 1, 2014 and ending on April 1, 2016, if there is no increase or there is a decrease in QSBL from the baseline level to the level as of the end of the ninth dividend period (i.e. as of September 30, 2013), because of the Company’s participation in the CPP, the Company will be subject to an additional lending incentive fee of 2% per year, or 9% dividend rate. After 4.5 years from issuance, regardless of QSBL growth over baseline, the dividend rate will increase to 9%. As the Company did not increase the QSBL from the baseline level as of September 30, 2013, the Company’s dividend rate, including the additional 2% lending incentive fee, increased to 9% beginning with the dividend payment due April 1, 2014.

 

For 2011 through 2013, the Company reported a net decline in QSBL from the baseline; therefore, the dividend rate for all of the corresponding calendar quarters was 5%. The declines were primarily the result of the following:

 

 

The Company’s strategic introduction into SBA and USDA lending in 2010. The government guaranteed portion of these loans (typically 50% to 85% of the total amount outstanding) is not eligible as QSBL per SBLF guidelines.

 

Based on the size of the Company and its legal lending limit, the majority of commercial loan growth over the past several years has been to businesses whose revenues exceeded the limits defined as QSBL per SBLF guidelines.

 

The Company has participated in business lending with other community banks whereby another bank is the lead lender and participates portions of the loan to the Company’s subsidiary banks. These participations purchased are not eligible as QSBL per SBLF guidelines.

 

Since the baseline, the Company has grown its small business lending and continues to support the lending needs of small businesses, although some of this support may be ineligible as QSBL per SBLF guidelines. Regardless of eligibility, the Company will continue to focus strongly on small business lending.

 

On June 29, 2012, the Company redeemed 10,223 shares of Series F Preferred Stock from the Treasury for an aggregate redemption amount of $10.2 million plus unpaid dividends to the date of redemption of $125 thousand. The remaining Series F Preferred Stock may be redeemed at any time at the option of the Company, subject to approval of the Company’s primary federal banking regulator. All redemptions must be in amounts equal to the lesser of at least 25% of the number of originally issued shares, or 100% of the then-outstanding shares.

 

See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for detail on the Company’s preferred stock.  

 

 
52

 

 

The following table presents the rollforward of stockholders’ equity for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

   

For the Years Ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 

Beginning balance

  $ 140,434     $ 144,433  

Net income

    14,938       13,106  

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax

    (18,351 )     (48 )

Preferred and common cash dividends declared

    (3,627 )     (3,877 )

Issuance of 834,715 shares of common stock for acquisition of CNB, net

    13,017       -  

Redemption of 10,223 shares of Series F Preferred Stock

    -       (10,223 )

Purchase of noncontrolling interest

    -       (4,782 )

Other *

    1,166       1,825  

Ending balance

  $ 147,577     $ 140,434  

 

*Includes mostly common stock issued for options exercised and the employee stock purchase plans, as well as stock-based compensation.

 

The available for sale portion of the securities portfolio experienced a significant decline in fair value during 2013 as the result of the increase in longer term interest rates. See previous discussion in the “Investment Securities’ section.

 

See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements for discuss on the acquisition of CNB and the issuance of common stock therewith.

 

See Note 22 to the consolidated financial statements for discussion on the acquisition of the noncontrolling interest in m2 which comprises the large majority of the total purchase of $4.8 million described above.  

 

 
53

 

 

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

 

Liquidity measures the ability of the Company to meet maturing obligations and its existing commitments, to withstand fluctuations in deposit levels, to fund its operations, and to provide for customers’ credit needs. The Company monitors liquidity risk through contingency planning stress testing on a regular basis. The Company seeks to avoid over concentration of funding sources and to establish and maintain contingent funding facilities that can be drawn upon if normal funding sources become unavailable. One source of liquidity is cash and short-term assets, such as interest-bearing deposits in other banks and federal funds sold, which averaged $102.8 million during 2013, $98.6 million during 2012, and $128.0 million during 2011. The Company’s on balance sheet liquidity position can fluctuate based on short-term activity in deposits and loans.

 

The subsidiary banks have a variety of sources of short-term liquidity available to them, including federal funds purchased from correspondent banks, FHLB advances, structured repos, brokered time deposits, lines of credit, borrowing at the Federal Reserve Discount Window, sales of securities available for sale, and loan/lease participations or sales. The Company also generates liquidity from the regular principal payments and prepayments made on its loan/lease portfolio, and on the regular monthly payments on its residential mortgage-backed securities portfolio. At December 31, 2013, the subsidiary banks had 33 lines of credit totaling $351.3 million, of which $26.8 million was secured and $324.5 million was unsecured. At December 31, 2013, $315.3 million was available as $36.0 million was utilized for short-term borrowing needs at QCBT. At December 31, 2012, the subsidiary banks had 31 lines of credit totaling $311.7 million, of which $52.7 million was secured and $259.0 million was unsecured. At December 31, 2012, $271.7 million was available as $40.0 million was utilized for short-term borrowing needs at QCBT. The Company has emphasized growing the number and amount of lines of credit in an effort to strengthen this contingent source of liquidity. Additionally, the Company restructured its credit facility during the second quarter of 2013. Previously, the Company had a single $20.0 million secured revolving credit note with variable interest rate and a maturity of June 27, 2013 with $14.4 million available as the note carried an outstanding balance of $5.6 million. To help fund the acquisition of Community National on May 13, 2013, the Company borrowed an additional $4.4 million on the revolving credit note bringing the total borrowed to $10.0 million. At maturity on June 26, 2013, the $10.0 million was converted to a secured three year term note with a variable interest rate and a maturity of June 27, 2016. Additionally, the Company maintained a $10.0 million secured revolving credit note with a variable interest rate and a maturity of June 26, 2014. At December 31, 2013, the Company had not borrowed on this revolving credit note and had the full amount available. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information regarding the lines of credit, term note, and revolving credit note.

 

Investing activities used cash of $164.6 million during 2013 compared to $132.8 million during 2012, and $137.3 million for 2011. Proceeds from calls, maturities, paydowns, and sales of securities were $230.8 million for 2013 compared to $433.5 million for 2012, and $486.3 million for 2011. Purchases of securities used cash of $313.0 million for 2013 compared to $474.5 million for 2012, and $622.2 million for 2011. The net increase in loans/leases used cash of $55.3 million for 2013 compared to $91.3 million for 2012, and $56.1 million for 2011. The Company paid cash of $30.4 million on sales of certain branches of CNB in 2013.

 

Financing activities provided cash of $112.9 million for 2013 compared to $110.5 million for 2012, and $111.8 million for 2011. Net increases in deposits totaled $108.9 million, $168.7 million, and $90.6 million for 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively.

 

Total cash provided by operating activities was $32.0 million for 2013 compared to $30.7 million for 2012, and $36.6 million for 2011.

 

Throughout its history, the Company has secured additional capital through various resources, including the issuance of trust preferred securities and the issuance of preferred stock. See Notes 10 and 11 to the consolidated financial statements for information on the issuance of trust preferred securities and the issuance of preferred stock, respectively.

 

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the subsidiary banks remained “well-capitalized” in accordance with regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking authorities. See Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements for detail of the capital amounts and ratios for the Company and subsidiary banks. 

 

 
54

 

 

In July 2013, the U.S. federal banking authorities approved the implementation of the Basel III regulatory capital reforms and issued rules effecting certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act. The Basel III Rules are applicable to all U.S. banks that are subject to minimum capital requirements, as well as to bank and savings and loan holding companies other than “small bank holding companies” (generally bank holding companies with consolidated assets of less than $500 million).  The Basel III Rules not only increase most of the required minimum regulatory capital ratios, but they introduce a new Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio and the concept of a capital conservation buffer.  The Basel III Rules also expand the definition of capital as in effect currently by establishing criteria that instruments must meet to be considered Additional Tier 1 Capital (Tier 1 Capital in addition to Common Equity) and Tier 2 Capital.  A number of instruments that now qualify as Tier 1 Capital will not qualify, or their qualifications will change.  The Basel III Rules also permit smaller banking organizations to retain, through a one-time election, the existing treatment for accumulated other comprehensive income, which currently does not affect regulatory capital.  The Basel III Rules have maintained the general structure of the current prompt corrective action framework, while incorporating the increased requirements. The prompt corrective action guidelines were also revised to add the Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio.  In order to be a “well-capitalized” depository institution under the new regime, a bank and holding company must maintain a Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio of 6.5% or more; a Tier 1 Capital ratio of 8% or more; a Total Capital ratio of 10% or more; and a leverage ratio of 5% or more.  Generally, financial institutions become subject to the new Basel III Rules on January 1, 2015.  Management is in the process of assessing the effect the Basel III Rules may have on the Company’s and the subsidiary banks’ capital positions and will monitor developments in this area. At present, management believes that its current capital structure and the execution of its existing capital plan will be more than sufficient to meet and exceed the revised regulatory capital ratios as required by the new Basel III Rules.     

 

COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENCIES, CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS, AND OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

 

In the normal course of business, the subsidiary banks make various commitments and incur certain contingent liabilities that are not presented in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. The commitments and contingent liabilities include various guarantees, commitments to extend credit, and standby letters of credit.

 

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The subsidiary banks evaluate each customer's creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the banks upon extension of credit, is based upon management's credit evaluation of the counter-party. Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, marketable securities, inventory, property, plant and equipment, and income-producing commercial properties.

 

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the subsidiary banks to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Those guarantees are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements and, generally, have terms of one year, or less. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The banks hold collateral, as described above, supporting those commitments if deemed necessary. In the event the customer does not perform in accordance with the terms of the agreement with the third party, the banks would be required to fund the commitments. The maximum potential amount of future payments the banks could be required to make is represented by the contractual amount. If the commitment is funded, the banks would be entitled to seek recovery from the customer. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, no amounts had been recorded as liabilities for the banks' potential obligations under these guarantees.

 

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, commitments to extend credit aggregated $432.6 million and $430.1 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, standby letters of credit aggregated $9.7 million and $15.2 million, respectively. Management does not expect that all of these commitments will be funded.

 

Additional information regarding commitments, contingencies, and off-balance sheet arrangements is described in Note 17 to the consolidated financial statements.  

 

 
55

 

 

The Company has various financial obligations, including contractual obligations and commitments, which may require future cash payments. The following table presents, as of December 31, 2013, significant fixed and determinable contractual obligations to third parties by payment date. Further discussion of the nature of each obligation is included in the referenced note to the consolidated financial statements.

 

   

Financial

   

Payments Due by Period

 
   

Statement

           

One Year

                         

Description

 

Note Reference

   

Total

   

or Less

   

2 - 3 Years

   

4 - 5 Years

   

After 5 Years

 
           

(dollars in thousands)

 

Deposits without a stated maturity

 

N/A

    $ 1,258,209     $ 1,258,209     $ -     $ -     $ -  

Certificates of deposit

    6       388,782       300,291       75,458       13,033       -  

Short-term borrowings

    7       149,293       149,293       -       -       -  

FHLB advances

    8       231,350       75,850       63,500       72,000       20,000  

Other borrowings

    9       142,448       3,200       11,600       12,648       115,000  

Junior subordinated debentures

    10       40,290       -       -       -       40,290  

Rental commitments

    5       1,428       358       472       435       163  

Operating contracts

 

N/A

      5,505       4,667       838       -       -  

Total contractual cash obligations

          $ 2,217,305     $ 1,791,868     $ 151,868     $ 98,116     $ 175,453  

  

Purchase obligations represent obligations under agreements to purchase goods or services that are enforceable and legally binding on the Company and that specify all significant terms, including: (1) fixed or minimum quantities to be purchased; (2) fixed, minimum or variable price provisions; and (3) the approximate timing of the transaction. The Company had no purchase obligations at December 31, 2013. The Company's operating contract obligations represent short and long-term lease payments for data processing equipment and services, software, and other equipment and professional services.

 

IMPACT OF INFLATION AND CHANGING PRICES

 

The consolidated financial statements of the Company and the accompanying notes have been prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, which require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollar amounts without considering the changes in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation. The impact of inflation is reflected in the increased cost of the Company’s operations. Unlike industrial companies, nearly all of the assets and liabilities of the Company are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates have a greater impact on the Company’s performance than do the effects of general levels of inflation. Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction or to the same extent as the price of goods and services.

 

IMPACT OF NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

 

In December 2011, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued ASU 2011-11, Balance Sheet (Topic 210) - Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities. ASU 2011-11 requires entities to disclose both gross information and net information about both instruments and transactions eligible for offset in the balance sheet, and instruments and transactions subject to an agreement similar to a master netting arrangement. In January 2013, FASB issued ASU 2013-01, Clarifying the Scope of Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities. Both ASU 2011-11 and ASU 2013-01 were effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013, and interim periods within those annual periods. Adoption did not have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.  

 

 
56

 

 

In February 2013, FASB issued ASU 2013-02, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) – Reporting of Amounts Reclassified out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income. ASU 2013-02 supersedes and replaces the presentation requirements for reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) in ASUs 2011-05 and 2011-12, which were adopted by the Company during 2013. The amendments require an entity to provide information about the amounts reclassified out of AOCI by component. In addition, an entity is required to present, either on the face of the statement where net income is presented or in the notes, significant amounts reclassified out of AOCI by the respective line items of net income if the amount reclassified is required to be reclassified in its entirety in the same reporting period. For other amounts that are not required to be reclassified in their entirety to net income, an entity is required to cross-reference to other disclosures required. Adoption did not have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

In July 2013, FASB issued ASU 2013-11, Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists. ASU 2013-11 is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2013. Management is in the process of evaluating the impact of ASU 2013-11 on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

In January 2014, FASB issued ASU 2014-04, Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure. The objective of ASU 2014-04 is to reduce diversity by clarifying when an in substance repossession or foreclosure occurs, that is, when a creditor should be considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan such that the loan receivable should be derecognized and the real estate property recognized. ASU 2014-04 is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2014. Management is in the process of evaluating the impact of ASU 2014-04 on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

This document (including information incorporated by reference) contains, and future oral and written statements of the Company and its management may contain, forward-looking statements, within the meaning of such term in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, with respect to the financial condition, results of operations, plans, objectives, future performance and business of the Company. Forward-looking statements, which may be based upon beliefs, expectations and assumptions of the Company’s management and on information currently available to management, are generally identifiable by the use of words such as “believe,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “bode,” “predict,” “suggest,” “project,” “appear,” “plan,” “intend,” “estimate,” “may,” “will,” “would,” “could,” “should,” “likely,” or other similar expressions. Additionally, all statements in this document, including forward-looking statements, speak only as of the date they are made, and the Company undertakes no obligation to update any statement in light of new information or future events. 

 

 
57

 

 

The Company’s ability to predict results or the actual effect of future plans or strategies is inherently uncertain. The factors that could have a material adverse effect on the operations and future prospects of the Company and its subsidiaries are detailed in the “Risk Factors” section included under Item 1A. of Part I of this Form 10-K. In addition to the risk factors described in that section, there are other factors that may impact any public company, including ours, which could have a material adverse effect on the operations and future prospects of the Company and its subsidiaries. These additional factors include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

 

The economic impact of past and any future terrorist attacks, acts of war or threats thereof and the response of the United States to any such threats and attacks.

 

The costs, effects and outcomes of existing or future litigation.

 

Changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by state and federal regulatory agencies, the FASB, the Securities and Exchange Commission or the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board.

 

The ability of the Company to manage the risks associated with the foregoing as well as anticipated.

 

These risks and uncertainties should be considered in evaluating forward-looking statements and undue reliance should not be placed on such statements.

 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

 

The Company, like other financial institutions, is subject to direct and indirect market risk. Direct market risk exists from changes in interest rates. The Company’s net income is dependent on its net interest income. Net interest income is susceptible to interest rate risk to the degree that interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice on a different basis than interest-earning assets. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly than interest-earning assets in a given period, a significant increase in market rates of interest could adversely affect net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature or reprice more quickly than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could result in a decrease in net interest income.

 

In an attempt to manage the Company’s exposure to changes in interest rates, management monitors the Company’s interest rate risk. Each subsidiary bank has an asset/liability management committee of the board of directors that meets quarterly to review the bank’s interest rate risk position and profitability, and to make or recommend adjustments for consideration by the full board of each bank. Internal asset/liability management teams consisting of members of the subsidiary banks’ management meet weekly to manage the mix of assets and liabilities to maximize earnings and liquidity and minimize interest rate and other risks. Management also reviews the subsidiary banks’ securities portfolios, formulates investment strategies, and oversees the timing and implementation of transactions to assure attainment of the board's objectives in the most effective manner. Notwithstanding the Company’s interest rate risk management activities, the potential for changing interest rates is an uncertainty that can have an adverse effect on net income.

 

In adjusting the Company’s asset/liability position, the board of directors and management attempt to manage the Company’s interest rate risk while maintaining or enhancing net interest margins. At times, depending on the level of general interest rates, the relationship between long-term and short-term interest rates, market conditions and competitive factors, the board of directors and management may decide to increase the Company’s interest rate risk position somewhat in order to increase its net interest margin. The Company’s results of operations and net portfolio values remain vulnerable to increases in interest rates and to fluctuations in the difference between long-term and short-term interest rates. 

 

 
58

 

 

One method used to quantify interest rate risk is a short-term earnings at risk summary, which is a detailed and dynamic simulation model used to quantify the estimated exposure of net interest income to sustained interest rate changes. This simulation model captures the impact of changing interest rates on the interest income received and interest expense paid on all interest sensitive assets and liabilities reflected on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. This sensitivity analysis demonstrates net interest income exposure annually over a five-year horizon, assuming no balance sheet growth and various interest rate scenarios including no change in rates; 200, 300, 400, and 500 basis point upward shifts; and a 100 basis point downward shift in interest rates, where interest-bearing assets and liabilities reprice at their earliest possible repricing date. The model assumes parallel and pro rata shifts in interest rates over a twelve-month period for the 200 basis point upward shift and 100 basis point downward shift. For the 400 basis point upward shift, the model assumes a parallel and pro rata shift in interest rates over a twenty-four month period. For the 500 basis point upward shift, the model assumes a flattening and pro rata shift in interest rates over a twelve-month period where the short-end of the yield curve shifts upward greater than the long-end of the yield curve. Further, in recent years, the Company added additional interest rate scenarios where interest rates experience a parallel and instantaneous shift upward 100, 200, 300, and 400 basis points and a parallel and instantaneous shift downward 100 basis points. The Company will run additional interest rate scenarios on an as-needed basis. The asset/liability management committees of the subsidiary bank boards of directors have established policy limits of a 10% decline in net interest income for the 200 basis point upward parallel shift and the 100 basis point downward parallel shift. For the 300 basis point upward shock, the established policy limit has been increased to 25% decline in net interest income. The increased policy limit is appropriate as the shock scenario is extreme and unlikely and warrants a higher limit than the more realistic and traditional parallel/pro-rata shift scenarios.

 

Application of the simulation model analysis for select interest rate scenarios at December 31, 2013 demonstrated the following:

 

           

NET INTEREST INCOME EXPOSURE in YEAR 1

 

INTEREST RATE SCENARIO

 

POLICY LIMIT

   

As of December 31, 2013

   

As of December 31, 2012

   

As of December 31, 2011

 

100 basis point downward shift

    -10.0 %     -1.0 %     -1.5 %     -1.5 %

200 basis point upward shift

    -10.0 %     -4.8 %     -0.9 %     -3.1 %

300 basis point upward shock

    -25.0 %     -11.0 %     0.8 %     -4.2 %

 

 

The simulation is within the board-established policy limits for all three scenarios. Additionally, for all of the various interest rate scenarios modeled and measured by management (as described above), the results at December 31, 2013 were within established risk tolerances as established by policy or by best practice (if the interest rate scenario didn’t have a specific policy limit).

 

Interest rate risk is considered to be one of the most significant market risks affecting the Company. For that reason, the Company engages the assistance of a national consulting firm and its risk management system to monitor and control the Company’s interest rate risk exposure. Other types of market risk, such as foreign currency exchange rate risk and commodity price risk, do not arise in the normal course of the Company’s business activities. 

 

 
59

 

 

Item 8. Financial Statements

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc.

 

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

   
   
   

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 
   

Financial Statements

 
   

Consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2013 and 2012

62
   

Consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

63
   

Consolidated statements of comprehensive income (loss) for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

64
   

Consolidated statements of changes in stockholders' equity for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

65
   

Consolidated statements of cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

66
   

Notes to consolidated financial statements

68

 

 
60

 

  

 
61

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets

December 31, 2013 and 2012

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
Assets                

Cash and due from banks

  $ 41,950,790     $ 61,568,446  

Federal funds sold

    39,435,000       26,560,000  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    33,044,917       22,359,490  
                 
                 

Securities held to maturity, at amortized cost

    145,451,895       72,079,385  

Securities available for sale, at fair value

    551,758,458       530,159,986  
      697,210,353       602,239,371  

Loans receivable, held for sale

    1,358,290       4,577,233  

Loans/leases receivable, held for investment

    1,458,921,268       1,282,810,406  
      1,460,279,558       1,287,387,639  

Less allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases

    (21,448,048 )     (19,925,204 )
      1,438,831,510       1,267,462,435  

Premises and equipment, net

    36,755,364       31,262,390  

Goodwill

    3,222,688       3,222,688  

Core deposit intangible

    1,870,433       -  

Bank-owned life insurance

    52,002,041       45,620,489  

Restricted investment securities

    17,027,625       15,747,850  

Other real estate owned, net

    9,729,053       3,954,538  

Other assets

    23,873,150       13,732,795  

Total assets

  $ 2,394,952,924     $ 2,093,730,492  
                 

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

               

Liabilities:

               

Deposits:

               

Noninterest-bearing

  $ 542,566,087     $ 450,659,723  

Interest-bearing

    1,104,425,156       923,454,377  

Total deposits

    1,646,991,243       1,374,114,100  
                 

Short-term borrowings

    149,292,967       171,082,961  

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    231,350,000       202,350,000  

Other borrowings

    142,448,362       138,239,762  

Junior subordinated debentures

    40,289,830       36,085,000  

Other liabilities

    37,003,742       31,424,848  

Total liabilities

    2,247,376,144       1,953,296,671  
                 

Commitments and Contingencies

               
                 

Stockholders' Equity:

               

Preferred stock, $1 par value, shares authorized 250,000

    29,867       54,867  

December 2013 - 29,867 shares issued and outstanding

               

December 2012 - 54,867 shares issued and outstanding

               

Common stock, $1 par value; shares authorized 20,000,000

    8,005,708       5,039,448  

December 2013 - 8,005,708 shares issued and 7,884,462 outstanding

               

December 2012 - 5,039,448 shares issued and 4,918,202 outstanding

               

Additional paid-in capital

    90,154,528       78,912,791  

Retained earnings

    64,637,173       53,326,542  

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

    (13,643,986 )     4,706,683  

Less treasury stock, December 2013 and 2012 - 121,246 common shares, at cost

    (1,606,510 )     (1,606,510 )

Total stockholders' equity

    147,576,780       140,433,821  

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 2,394,952,924     $ 2,093,730,492  

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 

 

 
62

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Income

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Interest and dividend income:

                       

Loans/leases, including fees

  $ 66,810,952     $ 63,363,520     $ 64,807,673  

Securities:

                       

Taxable

    10,061,066       10,781,300       10,877,832  

Nontaxable

    4,147,050       2,339,579       983,040  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    275,352       378,566       404,879  

Restricted investment securities

    558,946       507,281       557,698  

Federal funds sold

    18,592       5,627       92,126  

Total interest and dividend income

    81,871,958       77,375,873       77,723,248  

Interest expense:

                       

Deposits

    4,714,306       6,218,713       8,939,056  

Short-term borrowings

    293,020       248,545       290,450  

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    6,863,216       7,279,599       7,972,025  

Other borrowings

    4,753,260       4,940,970       5,149,022  

Junior subordinated debentures

    1,142,719       1,038,786       1,227,839  

Total interest expense

    17,766,521       19,726,613       23,578,392  

Net interest income

    64,105,437       57,649,260       54,144,856  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    5,930,420       4,370,767       6,616,014  

Net interest income after provision for loan/lease losses

    58,175,017       53,278,493       47,528,842  
                         

Noninterest income:

                       

Trust department fees

    4,941,681       3,632,278       3,368,995  

Investment advisory and management fees

    2,580,140       2,361,159       2,108,918  

Deposit service fees

    4,267,162       3,485,929       3,493,001  

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans, net

    836,065       1,388,142       999,162  

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans, net

    2,148,979       1,069,565       1,565,881  

Securities gains

    432,492       104,600       1,472,528  

Earnings on bank-owned life insurance

    1,786,023       1,609,208       1,445,891  

Bargain purchase gain on Community National Acquisition

    1,841,385       -       -  

Gains on sales of certain Community National Bank branches

    2,334,216       -       -  

Credit card issuing fees, net of processing costs

    174,258       599,164       500,544  

Losses on other real estate owned, net

    (545,340 )     (1,332,972 )     (374,910 )

Other

    5,016,767       3,704,222       2,881,868  

Total noninterest income

    25,813,828       16,621,295       17,461,878  
                         

Noninterest expenses:

                       

Salaries and employee benefits

    37,510,318       33,274,509       30,365,020  

Occupancy and equipment expense

    6,712,468       5,635,257       5,297,949  

Professional and data processing fees

    6,424,594       4,317,939       4,461,187  

FDIC and other insurance

    2,587,041       2,330,611       2,698,282  

Loan/lease expense

    1,521,523       1,041,824       2,160,674  

Advertising and marketing

    1,726,314       1,445,476       1,288,797  

Postage and telephone

    1,069,142       959,708       937,557  

Stationery and supplies

    562,301       541,122       516,873  

Bank service charges

    1,144,757       853,895       725,717  

Acquisition and data conversion costs

    2,353,162       -       -  

Prepayment fees on Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    -       -       832,099  

Other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities

    -       62,400       118,847  

Other

    2,821,038       1,796,206       1,589,650  

Total noninterest expenses

    64,432,658       52,258,947       50,992,652  

Income before income taxes

    19,556,187       17,640,841       13,998,068  

Federal and state income tax expense

    4,617,942       4,534,601       3,868,199  

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 13,106,240     $ 10,129,869  

Less: net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    -       488,473       438,221  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

  $ 14,938,245     $ 12,617,767     $ 9,691,648  

Less: preferred stock dividends and discount accretion

    3,168,302       3,496,085       5,283,885  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

  $ 11,769,943     $ 9,121,682     $ 4,407,763  
                         

Basic earnings per common share

  $ 2.13     $ 1.88     $ 0.93  

Diluted earnings per common share

  $ 2.08     $ 1.85     $ 0.92  
                         

Weighted average common shares outstanding

    5,531,948       4,844,776       4,724,781  

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

    5,646,926       4,919,559       4,789,026  

Cash dividends declared per common share

  $ 0.08     $ 0.08     $ 0.08  

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 

 

 
63

 

 

 

QCR HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 13,106,240     $ 10,129,869  
                         

Other comprehensive income (loss):

                       

Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale:

                       

Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period before tax

    (29,292,079 )     (40,839 )     7,914,236  

Less reclassification adjustment for gains included in net income before tax

    432,492       42,200       1,353,681  
      (29,724,571 )     (83,039 )     6,560,555  

Tax expense (benefit)

    (11,373,902 )     (35,008 )     2,510,006  

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

    (18,350,669 )     (48,031 )     4,050,549  
                         

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

  $ (3,412,424 )   $ 13,058,209     $ 14,180,418  

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 
64

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

                                   

Accumulated

                         
                   

Additional

           

Other

                         
   

Preferred

   

Common

   

Paid-In

   

Retained

   

Comprehensive

   

Noncontrolling

   

Treasury

         
   

Stock

   

Stock

   

Capital

   

Earnings

   

Income (Loss)

   

Interests

   

Stock

   

Total

 

Balance, December 31, 2010

  $ 63,237     $ 4,732,428     $ 86,478,269     $ 40,550,900     $ 704,165     $ 1,648,219     $ (1,606,510 )   $ 132,570,708  

Net income

    -       -       -       9,691,648       -       438,221       -       10,129,869  

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

    -       -       -       -       4,050,549       -       -       4,050,549  

Common cash dividends declared, $0.08 per share

    -       -       -       (372,761 )     -       -       -       (372,761 )

Preferred cash dividends declared and accrued

    -       -       -       (3,694,441 )     -       -       -       (3,694,441 )

Discount accretion on cumulative preferred stock *

    -       -       1,589,444       (1,589,444 )     -       -       -       -  

Proceeds from issuance of 40,090 shares of Series F Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    40,090       -       39,956,832       -       -       -       -       39,996,922  

Redemption of 38,237 shares of Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    (38,237 )     -       (38,198,763 )     -       -       -       -       (38,237,000 )

Redemption of 521,888 shares of common stock warrants issued in conjunction with Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    -       -       (1,100,000 )     -       -       -       -       (1,100,000 )

Proceeds from issuance of 36,174 shares of common stock as a result of stock purchased under the Employee Stock Purchase Plan

    -       36,174       207,592       -       -       -       -       243,766  

Proceeds from issuance of 36,459 shares of common stock as a result of stock options exercised

    -       36,459       216,765       -       -       -       -       253,224  

Exchange of 2,550 shares of common stock in connection with stock options exercised

    -       (2,550 )     (17,101 )     -       -       -       -       (19,651 )

Stock-based compensation expense

    -       -       646,419       -       -       -       -       646,419  

Restricted stock awards

    -       76,924       (76,924 )     -       -       -       -       -  

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

    -       -       -       -       -       (34,902 )     -       (34,902 )

Balance, December 31, 2011

  $ 65,090     $ 4,879,435     $ 89,702,533     $ 44,585,902     $ 4,754,714     $ 2,051,538     $ (1,606,510 )   $ 144,432,702  

Net income

    -       -       -       12,617,767       -       488,473       -       13,106,240  

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax

    -       -       -       -       (48,031 )     -       -       (48,031 )

Common cash dividends declared, $0.08 per share

    -       -       -       (381,042 )     -       -       -       (381,042 )

Preferred cash dividends declared and accrued

    -       -       -       (3,496,085 )     -       -       -       (3,496,085 )

Redemption of 10,223 shares of Series F Noncumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    (10,223 )     -       (10,212,777 )     -       -       -       -       (10,223,000 )

Proceeds from issuance of 31,554 shares of common stock as a result of stock purchased under the Employee Stock Purchase Plan

    -       31,554       249,316       -       -       -       -       280,870  

Proceeds from issuance of 17,876 shares of common stock as a result of stock options exercised

    -       17,876       155,428       -       -       -       -       173,304  

Exchange of 611 shares of common stock in connection with stock options exercised

    -       (611 )     (7,125 )     -       -       -       -       (7,736 )

Exchange of 576 shares of common stock in connection with payroll taxes for restricted stock

    -       (576 )     (2,103 )     -       -       -       -       (2,679 )

Proceeds from exercise of warrants to purchase 54,000 shares of common stock issued in conjunction with the Series A Subordinated Notes

    -       54,000       486,000       -       -       -       -       540,000  

Stock-based compensation expense

    -       -       849,760       -       -       -       -       849,760  

Restricted stock awards

    -       57,770       (57,770 )     -       -       -       -       -  

Purchase of noncontrolling interest

    -       -       (2,250,471 )     -       -       (2,531,748 )     -       (4,782,219 )

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

    -       -       -       -       -       (8,263 )     -       (8,263 )

Balance, December 31, 2012

  $ 54,867     $ 5,039,448     $ 78,912,791     $ 53,326,542     $ 4,706,683     $ -     $ (1,606,510 )   $ 140,433,821  

Net income

    -       -       -       14,938,245       -       -       -       14,938,245  

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax

    -       -       -       -       (18,350,669 )     -       -       (18,350,669 )

Common cash dividends declared, $0.08 per share

    -       -       -       (459,312 )     -       -       -       (459,312 )

Preferred cash dividends declared and accrued

    -       -       -       (3,168,302 )     -       -       -       (3,168,302 )

Issuance of 834,715 shares of common stock as a result of the acquisition of Community National Bancorporation, net

    -       834,715       12,181,894       -       -       -       -       13,016,609  

Conversion of 25,000 shares of Series E Non-cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock to 2,057,502 shares of common stock

    (25,000 )     2,057,502       (2,032,502 )     -       -       -       -       -  

Proceeds from issuance of 27,110 shares of common stock as a result of stock purchased under the Employee Stock Purchase Plan

    -       27,110       304,396       -       -       -       -       331,506  

Proceeds from issuance of 41,258 shares of common stock as a result of stock options exercised

    -       41,258       373,519       -       -       -       -       414,777  

Exchange of 7,679 shares of common stock in connection with stock options exercised

    -       (7,679 )     (120,955 )     -       -       -       -       (128,634 )

Stock-based compensation expense

    -       -       792,279       -       -       -       -       792,279  

Tax benefit of nonqualified stock options exercised

    -       -       62,371       -       -       -       -       62,371  

Restricted stock awards

    -       30,152       (30,152 )     -       -       -       -       -  

Exchange of 16,798 shares of common stock in connection with restricted stock vested

    -       (16,798 )     (289,113 )     -       -       -       -       (305,911 )

Balance, December 31, 2013

  $ 29,867     $ 8,005,708     $ 90,154,528     $ 64,637,173     $ (13,643,986 )   $ -     $ (1,606,510 )   $ 147,576,780  

 

* Includes $1,252,895 of accelerated discount accretion as a result of redeeming Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock.

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

 
65

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities:

                       

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 13,106,240     $ 10,129,869  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities

                       

Depreciation

    2,695,578       2,350,303       2,442,896  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    5,930,420       4,370,767       6,616,014  

Deferred income taxes

    (1,021,991 )     2,684,367       3,673,064  

Stock-based compensation expense

    792,279       849,760       696,407  

Deferred compensation expense accrued

    822,335       844,844       604,583  

Losses on other real estate owned, net

    545,340       1,332,972       374,910  

Amortization of premiums on securities, net

    3,574,097       3,946,551       3,487,361  

Securities gains, net

    (432,492 )     (104,600 )     (1,472,528 )

Other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities

    -       62,400       118,847  

Loans originated for sale

    (80,027,780 )     (120,430,173 )     (100,789,010 )

Proceeds on sales of loans

    86,231,767       122,143,407       113,606,152  

Gains on sales of residential real estate loans, net

    (836,065 )     (1,388,142 )     (999,162 )

Gains on sales of government guaranteed portions of loans, net

    (2,148,979 )     (1,069,565 )     (1,565,881 )

Gain on sale of credit card loan receivables

    (495,405 )     -       -  

Gain on sale of credit card issuing operations

    (355,268 )     -       -  

Bargain purchase gain on Community National acquisition

    (1,841,385 )     -       -  

Amortization of core deposit intangible

    178,881       -       -  

Accretion of acquisition fair value adjustments, net

    (1,060,708 )     -       -  

Gains on sales of certain branches of Community National Bank

    (2,334,216 )     -       -  

Prepayment fees on Federal Home Loan Bank advances

    -       -       832,099  

Increase in cash value of bank-owned life insurance

    (1,786,023 )     (1,609,208 )     (1,445,891 )

Decrease (increase) in other assets

    7,650,490       771,424       (1,588,258 )

Increase in other liabilities

    1,017,133       2,793,570       1,918,804  

Net cash provided by operating activities

    32,036,253       30,654,917       36,640,276  
                         

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:

                       

Net (increase) decrease in federal funds sold

    (540,000 )     (5,775,000 )     41,175,000  

Net (increase) decrease in interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    (8,660,888 )     4,391,112       12,995,009  

Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned

    1,345,479       5,241,265       9,220,631  

Activity in securities portfolio:

                       

Purchases

    (312,970,498 )     (474,461,164 )     (622,245,920 )

Calls, maturities and redemptions

    147,264,900       374,292,050       422,870,000  

Paydowns

    46,098,773       39,956,569       9,094,080  

Sales

    37,393,047       19,215,075       54,326,191  

Activity in restricted investment securities:

                       

Purchases

    (7,264,600 )     (4,584,300 )     (292,800 )

Redemptions

    7,244,200       4,090,050       1,707,900  

Purchases of bank-owned life insurance

    -       (2,000,000 )     (7,000,000 )

Net increase in loans/leases originated and held for investment

    (55,311,462 )     (91,275,511 )     (56,096,989 )

Purchase of premises and equipment

    (2,430,353 )     (1,871,942 )     (3,064,903 )

Proceeds from sale of credit card loan receivables

    10,674,723       -       -  

Net cash received from Community National Acquisition

    3,025,073       -       -  

Net cash paid on sales of certain branches of Community National Bank

    (30,425,618 )     -       -  

Net cash used in investing activities

    (164,557,224 )     (132,781,796 )     (137,311,801 )
                         

Cash Flows from Financing Activities:

                       

Net increase in deposits

    108,923,293       168,656,312       90,641,931  

Net (decrease) increase in short-term borrowings

    (21,789,994 )     (42,453,489 )     72,381,951  

Activity in Federal Home Loan Bank advances:

                       

Advances

    77,000,000       13,000,000       5,000,000  

Calls and maturities

    (48,000,000 )     (15,400,000     (24,000,000 )

Prepayments

    -       -       (15,832,099 )

Net (decrease) increase in other borrowings

    (200,000 )     8,099       (14,939,122 )

Proceeds from other borrowings term note

    10,000,000       -       -  

Advance (payment) on 364-day revolving note

    (5,600,000 )     2,000,000       1,100,000  

Repayment of Community National's other borrowings at acquisition

    (3,950,000 )     -       -  

Payment of cash dividends on common and preferred stock

    (4,062,726 )     (4,088,949 )     (3,712,493 )

Redemption of 10,223 share of Series F Noncumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, net

    -       (10,223,000 )     -  

Proceeds from issuance of 40,090 shares of Series F Noncumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, net

    -       -       39,996,922  

Redemption of Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, net

    -       -       (38,237,000 )

Repurchase of 521,888 shares of common stock warrants issued in conjunction with Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    -       -       (1,100,000 )

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

    582,742       994,174       477,339  

Purchase of noncontrolling interests

    -       (1,934,532 )     -  

Net cash provided by financing activities

    112,903,315       110,558,615       111,777,429  

Net (decrease) increase in cash and due from banks

    (19,617,656 )     8,431,736       11,105,904  

Cash and due from banks, beginning

    61,568,446       53,136,710       42,030,806  

Cash and due from banks, ending

  $ 41,950,790     $ 61,568,446     $ 53,136,710  

 

Continued

 

 
66

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows - Continued

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Supplemental Disclosures of Cash Flow Information, cash payments for:

                       

Interest

  $ 17,953,357     $ 19,962,937     $ 24,194,198  

Income and franchise taxes

    3,011,244       1,345,000       1,246,489  
                         

Supplemental Schedule of Noncash Investing Activities:

                       

Change in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), unrealized gains (losses) on on securities available for sale, net

    (18,350,669 )     (48,031 )     4,050,549  

Exchange of shares of common stock in connection with payroll taxes for restricted stock and options exercised

    (434,545 )     (10,415 )     (19,651 )

Transfers of loans to other real estate owned

    7,115,008       2,143,017       9,446,588  

Liability established for purchase of noncontrolling interest

    -       2,847,687       -  
                         

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information for Community National Acquisition:

                       

Fair value of assets acquired:

                       

Cash and due from banks *

  $ 9,286,757     $ -     $ -  

Federal funds sold

    12,335,000       -       -  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    2,024,539       -       -  

Securities available for sale

    45,853,826       -       -  

Loans/leases receivable held for investment, net

    195,658,486       -       -  

Premises and equipment, net

    8,132,021       -       -  

Core deposit intangible

    3,440,076       -       -  

Bank-owned life insurance

    4,595,529       -       -  

Restricted investment securities

    1,259,375       -       -  

Other real estate owned

    550,326       -       -  

Other assets

    5,178,583       -       -  

Total assets acquired

  $ 288,314,518     $ -     $ -  

Fair value of liabilities assumed:

                       

Deposits

  $ 255,045,071     $ -     $ -  

Other borrowings

    3,950,000       -       -  

Junior subordinated debentures

    4,125,175       -       -  

Other liabilities

    3,911,053       -       -  

Total liabilities assumed

  $ 267,031,299     $ -     $ -  
                         

Net assets acquired

  $ 21,283,219     $ -     $ -  

Consideration paid:

                       

Cash paid *

  $ 6,261,684     $ -     $ -  

Issuance of 834,715 shares of common stock

    13,180,150       -       -  

Total consideration paid

  $ 19,441,834     $ -     $ -  
                         

Bargain purchase gain

  $ 1,841,385     $ -     $ -  

 

* Net cash received at closing totaled $3,025,073

 

Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information for sales of certain Community National Bank branches:

                       

Assets sold:

                       

Cash **

  $ 30,425,618     $ -     $ -  

Loans receivable

    54,458,870       -       -  

Premises and equipment, net

    2,373,822       -       -  

Core deposit intangible

    1,390,762       -       -  

Other assets

    138,899       -       -  

Total assets sold

  $ 88,787,971     $ -     $ -  

Liabilities sold:

                       

Deposits

  $ 91,022,098     $ -     $ -  

Other liabilities

    100,089       -       -  

Total liabilities sold

  $ 91,122,187     $ -     $ -  

Gains on sales of certain branches of Community National Bank

  $ 2,334,216     $ -     $ -  

** Net cash paid at closing totaled $30,425,618

 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

 
67

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies

 

Nature of business:

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) is a bank holding company providing bank and bank related services through its banking subsidiaries, Quad City Bank and Trust Company (“QCBT”), Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company (“CRBT”), and Rockford Bank and Trust Company (“RB&T”). On May 13, 2013, the Company acquired Community National Bancorporation (“Community National”) and its banking subsidiary Community National Bank (“CNB”). In October 2013, the Company sold certain assets and liabilities of certain branches of CNB in two separate transactions. The Company operated CNB as a separate banking charter since the acquisition until October 26, 2013, when CNB’s charter was merged with and into CRBT. CNB’s merged branch offices operate as a division of CRBT under the name of “Community Bank & Trust.” See Note 2 for additional information on the acquisition, sales of certain branches, and subsequent merger into CRBT. The Company also engages in direct financing lease contracts through its wholly-owned equity investment by QCBT in m2 Lease Funds, LLC (“m2”). The remaining subsidiaries of the Company consist of six non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities. The Company assumed two of these subsidiaries in the acquisition of Community National on May 13, 2013. See Note 10 for a listing of these subsidiaries and additional information. QCBT is a commercial bank that serves the Iowa and Illinois Quad Cities and adjacent communities. CRBT is a commercial bank that serves Cedar Rapids, Iowa, and adjacent communities including Cedar Falls and Waterloo, Iowa, under the name “Community Bank & Trust.” RB&T is a commercial bank that serves Rockford, Illinois, and adjacent communities.

 

QCBT and CRBT are chartered and regulated by the state of Iowa, and RB&T is chartered and regulated by the state of Illinois. All three subsidiary banks are insured and subject to regulation by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”), and are members of and regulated by the Federal Reserve System. m2, based in the Milwaukee, Wisconsin area, is engaged in the business of direct financing lease contracts. QCBT previously owned 80% of m2. In August 2012, QCBT purchased the remaining 20% noncontrolling interest. See Note 22 for further discussion of the acquisition. Velie Plantation Holding Company, LLC (“VPHC”), previously owned 91% by the Company, was engaged in holding the real estate property known as the Velie Plantation in Moline, Illinois. The Velie Plantation is the location of the Company’s headquarters. In October 2012, the Company acquired the remaining 9% noncontrolling interest, and effective December 31, 2012, VPHC was dissolved.

 

Significant accounting policies:

 

Accounting estimates: The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the determination of the allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases, other-than-temporary impairment of securities, and the fair value of financial instruments.

 

Principles of consolidation: The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries, except those six subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities which do not meet the criteria for consolidation. See Note 10 for a detailed listing of these subsidiaries. All material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

 
68

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Presentation of cash flows: For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and due from banks include cash on hand and noninterest bearing amounts due from banks. Cash flows from federal funds sold, interest bearing deposits at financial institutions, loans/leases, deposits, and short-term and other borrowings are treated as net increases or decreases.

 

Cash and due from banks: The subsidiary banks are required by federal banking regulations to maintain certain cash and due from bank reserves. The reserve requirement was approximately $22,435,000 and $15,512,000 and as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

Investment securities: Investment securities held to maturity are those debt securities that the Company has the ability and intent to hold until maturity regardless of changes in market conditions, liquidity needs, or changes in general economic conditions. Such securities are carried at cost adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts. If the ability or intent to hold to maturity is not present for certain specified securities, such securities are considered available for sale as the Company intends to hold them for an indefinite period of time but not necessarily to maturity. Any decision to sell a security classified as available for sale would be based on various factors, including movements in interest rates, changes in the maturity mix of the Company's assets and liabilities, liquidity needs, regulatory capital considerations, and other factors. Securities available for sale are carried at fair value. Unrealized gains or losses, net of taxes, are reported as increases or decreases in accumulated other comprehensive income. Realized gains or losses, determined on the basis of the cost of specific securities sold, are included in earnings.

 

All securities are evaluated to determine whether declines in fair value below their amortized cost are other-than-temporary.

 

In estimating other-than-temporary impairment losses on available for sale debt securities, management considers a number of factors including, but not limited to, (1) the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, (3) the current market conditions, and (4) the intent of the Company to not sell the security prior to recovery and whether it is not more-likely-than-not that it will be required to sell the security prior to recovery. If the Company does not intend to sell the security, and it is not more-likely-than-not the entity will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, the Company will recognize the credit component of an other-than-temporary impairment of a debt security in earnings and the remaining portion in other comprehensive income. For held to maturity debt securities, the amount of an other-than-temporary impairment recorded in other comprehensive income for the noncredit portion would be amortized prospectively over the remaining life of the security on the basis of the timing of future estimated cash flows of the security.

 

In estimating other-than-temporary impairment losses on available for sale equity securities management considers factors (1), (2) and (3) above as well as whether the Company has the intent and the ability to hold the security until its recovery. If the Company (a) intends to sell an impaired equity security and does not expect the fair value of the security to fully recover before the expected time of sale, or (b) does not have the ability to hold the security until its recovery, the security is deemed other-than-temporarily impaired and the impairment is charged to earnings. The Company recognizes an impairment loss through earnings if based upon other factors the loss is deemed to be other-than-temporary even if the decision to sell has not been made.

 

Loans receivable, held for sale: Residential real estate loans which are originated and intended for resale in the secondary market in the foreseeable future are classified as held for sale. These loans are carried at the lower of cost or estimated market value in the aggregate. As assets specifically acquired for resale, the origination of, disposition of, and gain/loss on these loans are classified as operating activities in the statement of cash flows.

 

 
69

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Loans receivable, held for investment: Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future, or until pay-off or maturity occurs, are classified as held for investment. These loans are stated at the amount of unpaid principal adjusted for charge-offs, the allowance for estimated losses on loans, and any deferred fees and/or costs on originated loans. Interest is credited to earnings as earned based on the principal amount outstanding. Deferred direct loan origination fees and/or costs are amortized as an adjustment of the related loan’s yield. As assets held for and used in the production of services, the origination and collection of these loans are classified as investing activities in the statement of cash flows.

 

The Company discloses allowance for credit losses (also known as “allowance for estimated loss on loans/leases” or “allowance”) and fair value by portfolio segment, and credit quality information, impaired financing receivables, nonaccrual status, and troubled debt restructurings by class of financing receivable.  A portfolio segment is the level at which the Company develops and documents a systematic methodology to determine its allowance for credit losses. A class of financing receivable is a further disaggregation of a portfolio segment based on risk characteristics and the Company’s method for monitoring and assessing credit risk. See this information following and in Note 4.

 

The Company’s portfolio segments are as follows:

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

Commercial real estate

 

Residential real estate

 

Installment and other consumer

 

Direct financing leases would be considered a segment within the overall loan/lease portfolio. The accounting policies for direct financing leases are disclosed below.

 

The Company’s classes of loans receivable are as follows:

 

 

Commercial and industrial

 

Owner-occupied commercial real estate

 

Commercial construction, land development, and other land loans that are not owner-occupied commercial real estate

 

Other non-owner-occupied commercial real estate

 

Residential real estate

 

Installment and other consumer

 

Direct financing leases would be considered a class of financing receivable within the overall loan/lease portfolio. The accounting policies for direct financing leases are disclosed below.

 

Generally, for all classes of loans receivable, loans are considered past due when contractual payments are delinquent for 31 days or greater.

 

 
70

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

For all classes of loans receivable, loans will generally be placed on nonaccrual status when the loan has become 90 days past due (unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection); or if any of the following conditions exist:

 

 

It becomes evident that the borrower will not make payments, or will not or cannot meet the terms for renewal of a matured loan;

 

When full repayment of principal and interest is not expected;

 

When the loan is graded “doubtful”;

 

When the borrower files bankruptcy and an approved plan of reorganization or liquidation is not anticipated in the near future; or

 

When foreclosure action is initiated.

 

When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, income recognition is ceased. Previously recorded but uncollected amounts of interest on nonaccrual loans are reversed at the time the loan is placed on nonaccrual status. Generally, cash collected on nonaccrual loans is applied to principal. Should full collection of principal be expected, cash collected on nonaccrual loans can be recognized as interest income.

 

For all classes of loans receivable, nonaccrual loans may be restored to accrual status provided the following criteria are met:

 

 

The loan is current, and all principal and interest amounts contractually due have been made;

 

All principal and interest amounts contractually due, including past due payments, are reasonably assured of repayment within a reasonable period; and

 

There is a period of minimum repayment performance, as follows, by the borrower in accordance with contractual terms:

 

o

Six months of repayment performance for contractual monthly payments, or

 

o

One year of repayment performance for contractual quarterly or semi-annual payments.

 

Direct finance leases receivable, held for investment: The Company leases machinery and equipment to customers under leases that qualify as direct financing leases for financial reporting and as operating leases for income tax purposes. Under the direct financing method of accounting, the minimum lease payments to be received under the lease contract, together with the estimated unguaranteed residual values (approximately 3% to 15% of the cost of the related equipment), are recorded as lease receivables when the lease is signed and the lease property delivered to the customer. The excess of the minimum lease payments and residual values over the cost of the equipment is recorded as unearned lease income. Unearned lease income is recognized over the term of the lease on a basis that results in an approximate level rate of return on the unrecovered lease investment. Lease income is recognized on the interest method. Residual value is the estimated fair market value of the equipment on lease at lease termination. In estimating the equipment’s fair value at lease termination, the Company relies on historical experience by equipment type and manufacturer and, where available, valuations by independent appraisers, adjusted for known trends. The Company’s estimates are reviewed continuously to ensure reasonableness; however, the amounts the Company will ultimately realize could differ from the estimated amounts. If the review results in a lower estimate than had been previously established, a determination is made as to whether the decline in estimated residual value is other-than-temporary. If the decline in estimated unguaranteed residual value is judged to be other-than-temporary, the accounting for the transaction is revised using the changed estimate. The resulting reduction in the investment is recognized as a loss in the period in which the estimate is changed. An upward adjustment of the estimated residual value is not recorded.

 

The policies for delinquency and nonaccrual for direct financing leases are materially consistent with those described above for all classes of loan receivables.

 

 
71

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

The Company defers and amortizes fees and certain incremental direct costs over the contractual term of the lease as an adjustment to the yield. These initial direct leasing costs generally approximate 4% of the leased asset’s cost. The unamortized direct costs are recorded as a reduction of unearned lease income.

 

Troubled debt restructurings: Troubled debt restructuring exists when the Company, for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower’s/lessee’s financial difficulties, grants a concession (either imposed by court order, law, or agreement between the borrower/lessee and the Company) to the borrower/lessee that it would not otherwise consider. The Company is attempting to maximize its recovery of the balances of the loans/leases through these various concessionary restructurings.

 

The following criteria, related to granting a concession, together or separately, create a troubled debt restructuring:

 

 

A modification of terms of a debt such as one or a combination of:

 

 

o

The reduction of the stated interest rate.

 

o

The extension of the maturity date or dates at a stated interest rate lower than the current market rate for the new debt with similar risk.

 

o

The reduction of the face amount or maturity amount of the debt as stated in the instrument or other agreement.

 

o

The reduction of accrued interest.

 

 

A transfer from the borrower/lessee to the Company of receivables from third parties, real estate, other assets, or an equity position in the borrower to fully or partially satisfy a loan.

 

 

The issuance or other granting of an equity position to the Company to fully or partially satisfy a debt unless the equity position is granted pursuant to existing terms for converting the debt into an equity position.

 

Allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases: For all portfolio segments, the allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases is established as losses are estimated to have occurred through a provision for loan/lease losses charged to earnings. Loan/lease losses, for all portfolio segments, are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectability of a loan/lease balance is confirmed. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance.

 

For all portfolio segments, the allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases is evaluated on a regular basis by management and is based upon management’s periodic review of the collectability of the loans/leases in light of historical experience, the nature and volume of the loan/lease portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s/lessee’s ability to repay, estimated value of any underlying collateral and prevailing economic conditions. This evaluation is inherently subjective as it requires estimates that are susceptible to significant revision as more information becomes available.

 

A discussion of the risk characteristics and the allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases by each portfolio segment follows:

 

 
72

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

For commercial and industrial loans, the Company focuses on small and mid-sized businesses with primary operations as wholesalers, manufacturers, building contractors, business services companies, other banks, and retailers. The Company provides a wide range of commercial and industrial loans, including lines of credit for working capital and operational purposes, and term loans for the acquisition of facilities, equipment and other purposes. Approval is generally based on the following factors:

 

 

Ability and stability of current management of the borrower;

 

Stable earnings with positive financial trends;

 

Sufficient cash flow to support debt repayment;

 

Earnings projections based on reasonable assumptions;

 

Financial strength of the industry and business; and

 

Value and marketability of collateral.

 

Collateral for commercial and industrial loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate. The lending policy specifies approved collateral types and corresponding maximum advance percentages. The value of collateral pledged on loans must exceed the loan amount by a margin sufficient to absorb potential erosion of its value in the event of foreclosure and cover the loan amount plus costs incurred to convert it to cash.

 

The lending policy specifies maximum term limits for commercial and industrial loans. For term loans, the maximum term is generally 7 years. Generally, term loans range from 3 to 5 years. For lines of credit, the maximum term is typically 365 days.

 

In addition, the Company often takes personal guarantees or cosignors to help assure repayment. Loans may be made on an unsecured basis if warranted by the overall financial condition of the borrower.

 

Commercial real estate loans are subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial and industrial loans, in addition to those standards and processes specific to real estate loans. Collateral for commercial real estate loans generally includes the underlying real estate and improvements, and may include additional assets of the borrower. The lending policy specifies maximum loan-to-value limits based on the category of commercial real estate (commercial real estate loans on improved property, raw land, land development, and commercial construction). These limits are the same limits established by regulatory authorities.

 

The lending policy also includes guidelines for real estate appraisals, including minimum appraisal standards based on certain transactions. In addition, the Company often takes personal guarantees to help assure repayment.

 

In addition, management tracks the level of owner-occupied commercial real estate loans versus non-owner occupied loans. Owner-occupied loans are generally considered to have less risk. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, approximately 39% and 35%, respectively, of the commercial real estate loan portfolio was owner-occupied.

 

The Company’s lending policy limits non-owner occupied commercial real estate lending to 300% of total risk-based capital, and limits construction, land development, and other land loans to 100% of total risk-based capital. Exceeding these limits warrants the use of heightened risk management practices in accordance with regulatory guidelines. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, all three subsidiary banks were in compliance with these limits.

 

In some instances for all loans/leases, it may be appropriate to originate or purchase loans/leases that are exceptions to the guidelines and limits established within the lending policy described above and below. In general, exceptions to the lending policy do not significantly deviate from the guidelines and limits established within the lending policy and, if there are exceptions, they are clearly noted as such and specifically identified in loan/lease approval documents.

 

 
73

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

For commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans, the allowance for estimated losses on loans consists of specific and general components.

 

The specific component relates to loans that are classified as impaired, as defined below. For those loans that are classified as impaired, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral value or observable market price) of the impaired loan are lower than the carrying value of that loan.

 

For commercial and industrial loans and all classes of commercial real estate loans, a loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value, and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due. Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired. Management determines the significance of payment delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record, and the amount of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed. Impairment is measured on a case-by-case basis by either the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, the loan’s obtainable market price, or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.

 

The general component consists of quantitative and qualitative factors and covers non-impaired loans. The quantitative factors are based on historical charge-off experience and expected loss given default derived from the Company’s internal risk rating process. See below for a detailed description of the Company’s internal risk rating scale. The qualitative factors are determined based on an assessment of internal and/or external influences on credit quality that are not fully reflected in the historical loss or risk rating data.

 

For commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans, the Company utilizes the following internal risk rating scale:

 

1. Highest Quality – loans of the highest quality with no credit risk, including those fully secured by subsidiary bank certificates of deposit and U.S. government securities.

 

2. Superior Quality – loans with very strong credit quality. Borrowers have exceptionally strong earnings, liquidity, capital, cash flow coverage, and management ability. Includes loans secured by high quality, marketable securities, certificates of deposit from other institutions, and cash value of life insurance. Also includes loans supported by U.S. government, state, or municipal guarantees.

 

3. Satisfactory Quality loans with satisfactory credit quality. Established borrowers with satisfactory financial condition, including credit quality, earnings, liquidity, capital and cash flow coverage. Management is capable and experienced. Collateral coverage and guarantor support, if applicable, are more than adequate. Includes loans secured by personal assets and business assets, including equipment, accounts receivable, inventory, and real estate.

 

4. Fair Quality loans with moderate but still acceptable credit quality. The primary repayment source remains adequate; however, management’s ability to maintain consistent profitability is unproven or uncertain. Borrowers exhibit acceptable leverage and liquidity. May include new businesses with inexperienced management or unproven performance records in relation to peer, or borrowers operating in highly cyclical or deteriorating industries.

 

 
74

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

5. Early Warning loans where the borrowers have generally performed as agreed, however unfavorable financial trends exist or are anticipated. Earnings may be erratic, with marginal cash flow or declining sales. Borrowers reflect leveraged financial condition and/or marginal liquidity. Management may be new and a track record of performance has yet to be developed. Financial information may be incomplete, and reliance on secondary repayment sources may be increasing.

 

6. Special Mention – loans where the borrowers exhibit credit weaknesses or unfavorable financial trends requiring close monitoring. Weaknesses and adverse trends are more pronounced than Early Warning loans, and if left uncorrected, may jeopardize repayment according to the contractual terms. Currently, no loss of principal or interest is expected. Borrowers in this category have deteriorated to the point that it would be difficult to refinance with another lender. Special Mention should be assigned to borrowers in turnaround situations. This rating is intended as a transitional rating, therefore, it is generally not assigned to a borrower for a period of more than one year.

 

7. Substandard loans which are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if applicable. These loans have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses which jeopardize repayment according to the contractual terms. There is distinct loss potential if the weaknesses are not corrected. Includes loans with insufficient cash flow coverage which are collateral dependent, other real estate owned, and repossessed assets.

 

8. Doubtful loans which have all the weaknesses inherent in a Substandard loan, with the added characteristic that existing weaknesses make full principal collection, on the basis of current facts, conditions and values, highly doubtful. The possibility of loss is extremely high, but because of pending factors, recognition of a loss is deferred until a more exact status can be determined. All doubtful loans will be placed on non-accrual, with all payments, including principal and interest, applied to principal reduction.

 

For term commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans or credit relationships with aggregate exposure greater than $1,000,000, a loan review is required within 15 months of the most recent credit review. The review is completed in enough detail to, at a minimum, validate the risk rating. Additionally, the review shall include an analysis of debt service requirements, covenant compliance, if applicable, and collateral adequacy. The frequency of the review is generally accelerated for loans with poor risk ratings.

 

The Company’s Loan Quality area will perform a documentation review of a sampling of commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans, the primary purpose of which is to ensure the credit is properly documented and closed in accordance with approval authorities and conditions. A review will also be performed by the Company’s Internal Audit Department of a sampling of commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans, according to an approved schedule. Validation of the risk rating is part of Internal Audit’s review. Additionally, over the past several years, the Company has contracted an independent outside third party to review a sampling of commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans. Validation of the risk rating is part of this review as well.

 

The Company leases machinery and equipment to commercial and industrial customers under direct financing leases. All lease requests are subject to the credit requirements and criteria as set forth in the lending/leasing policy. In all cases, a formal independent credit analysis of the lessee is performed.

 

For direct financing leases, the allowance for estimated lease losses consists of specific and general components.

 

The specific component relates to leases that are classified as impaired, as defined for commercial loans above. For those leases that are classified as impaired, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral value or observable market price) of the impaired lease is lower than the carrying value of that lease.

 

 
75

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

The general component consists of quantitative and qualitative factors and covers nonimpaired leases. The quantitative factors are based on historical charge-off experience for the entire lease portfolio. The qualitative factors are determined based on an assessment of internal and/or external influences on credit quality that are not fully reflected in the historical loss data.

 

Generally, the Company’s residential real estate loans conform to the underwriting requirements of Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae to allow the subsidiary banks to resell loans in the secondary market. The subsidiary banks structure most loans that will not conform to those underwriting requirements as adjustable rate mortgages that mature or adjust in one to five years or fixed rate mortgages that mature in 15 years, and then retain these loans in their portfolios. Servicing rights are not presently retained on the loans sold in the secondary market. The lending policy establishes minimum appraisal and other credit guidelines.

 

The Company provides many types of installment and other consumer loans including motor vehicle, home improvement, home equity, signature loans and small personal credit lines. The lending policy addresses specific credit guidelines by consumer loan type.

 

For residential real estate loans, and installment and other consumer loans, these large groups of smaller balance homogenous loans are collectively evaluated for impairment. The Company applies a quantitative factor based on historical charge-off experience in total for each of these segments. Accordingly, the Company generally does not separately identify individual residential real estate loans, and/or installment or other consumer loans for impairment disclosures, unless such loans are the subject of a restructuring agreement due to financial difficulties of the borrower.

 

Troubled debt restructurings are considered impaired loans/leases and are subject to the same allowance methodology as described above for impaired loans/leases by portfolio segment.

 

Credit related financial instruments: In the ordinary course of business, the Company has entered into commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. Such financial instruments are recorded when they are funded.

 

 
76

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Transfers of financial assets: Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales only when control over the assets has been surrendered. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when: (1) the assets have been isolated from the Company, (2) the transferee obtains the right to pledge or exchange the assets it received, and no condition both constrains the transferee from taking advantage of its right to pledge or exchange and provides more than a modest benefit to the transferor, and (3) the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity or the ability to unilaterally cause the holder to return specific assets. In addition, for transfers of a portion of financial assets (for example, participations of loan receivables), the transfer must meet the definition of a “participating interest” in order to account for the transfer as a sale. Following are the characteristics of a “participating interest”:

 

 

Pro-rata ownership in an entire financial asset.

 

From the date of the transfer, all cash flows received from entire financial assets are divided proportionately among the participating interest holders in an amount equal to their share of ownership.

 

The rights of each participating interest holder have the same priority, and no participating interest holder’s interest is subordinated to the interest of another participating interest holder. That is, no participating interest holder is entitled to receive cash before any other participating interest holder under its contractual rights as a participating interest holder.

 

No party has the right to pledge or exchange the entire financial asset unless all participating interest holders agree to pledge or exchange the entire financial asset.

 

Premises and equipment: Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed primarily by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets.

 

Goodwill: The Company has recorded goodwill from QCBT’s purchase of 80% of m2 in August 2005. The goodwill is not being amortized, but is evaluated at least annually for impairment. An impairment charge is recognized when the calculated fair value of the reporting unit, including goodwill, is less than its carrying amount. Based on the annual analysis completed as of September 30, 2013, the Company determined that the goodwill was not impaired.

 

Core deposit intangible: The Company recorded core deposit intangible from the acquisition of Community National. The core deposit intangible was the portion of the acquisition purchase price which represented the value assigned to the existing deposit base at acquisition. The core deposit intangible has a finite life and is amortized by the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of the deposits (10 years).

 

Bank-owned life insurance: Bank-owned life insurance is carried at cash surrender value with increases/decreases reflected as income/expense in the statement of income.

 

Restricted investment securities: Restricted investment securities represent Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) and Federal Reserve Bank common stock. The stock is carried at cost. These equity securities are “restricted” in that they can only be sold back to the respective institution or another member institution at par. Therefore, they are less liquid than other tradable equity securities. The Company views its investment in restricted stock as a long-term investment. Accordingly, when evaluating for impairment, the value is determined based on the ultimate recovery of the par value, rather than recognizing temporary declines in value. There have been no other-than-temporary write-downs recorded on these securities.

 

Other real estate owned: Real estate acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosures, is held for sale and initially recorded at fair value less costs to sell, establishing a new cost basis. Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are periodically performed by management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell. Subsequent write-downs to fair value are charged to earnings.

 

 
77

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Treasury stock: Treasury stock is accounted for by the cost method, whereby shares of common stock reacquired are recorded at their purchase price. When treasury stock is reissued, any difference between the sales proceeds, or fair value when issued for business combinations, and the cost is recognized as a charge or credit to additional paid-in capital.

 

Stock-based compensation plans: At December 31, 2013, the Company had three stock-based employee compensation plans, which are described more fully in Note 14.

 

The Company accounts for stock-based compensation with measurement of compensation cost for all stock-based awards at fair value on the grant date and recognition of compensation over the requisite service period for awards expected to vest.

 

As discussed in Note 14, during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, the Company recognized stock-based compensation expense related to stock options, stock purchase plans, and stock appreciation rights of $792,279, $849,760, and $696,407, respectively. As required, management made an estimate of expected forfeitures and is recognizing compensation costs only for those equity awards expected to vest.

 

The Company uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock option grants with the following assumptions for the indicated periods:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Dividend yield

  .44%  to .53%       .86%     .88%  to 1.00%  

Expected volatility

  29.50%  to 30.56%       29.36%     29.64%  to 30.30%  

Risk-free interest rate

  1.71%  to 2.90%       1.98%     1.90%  to 3.58%  

Expected life of option grants (years)

    6         6       6    
Weighted-average grant date fair value     $5.14         $2.79       $2.74    

 

The Company also uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock purchase grants with the following assumptions for the indicated periods:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Dividend yield

  .53%  to .61%     .61% to .88%     .88% to 1.12%  

Expected volatility

  23.05%  to 24.25%     27.20% to 31.11%     51.62% to 53.58%  

Risk-free interest rate

  .10%  to .18%     .03% to .18%     .08% to .23%  

Expected life of purchase grants (months)

  3  to 6     to 6     3 to 6  
Weighted-average grant date fair value     $2.10         $1.71         $1.68    

 

The fair value is amortized on a straight-line basis over the vesting periods of the grants and will be adjusted for subsequent changes in estimated forfeitures. The expected dividend yield assumption is based on the Company's current expectations about its anticipated dividend policy. Expected volatility is based on historical volatility of the Company's common stock price. The risk-free interest rate for periods within the contractual life of the option or purchase is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of the grant. The expected life of the option and purchase grants is derived using the “simplified” method and represents the period of time that options and purchases are expected to be outstanding. Historical data is used to estimate forfeitures used in the model. Two separate groups of employees (employees subject to broad based grants, and executive employees and directors) are used.

 

As of December 31, 2013, there was $636,217 of unrecognized compensation cost related to share based payments, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.5 years.

 

 
78

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

The aggregate intrinsic value is calculated as the difference between the exercise price of the underlying awards and the quoted price of the Company's common stock for the 524,081 options that were in-the-money at December 31, 2013. The aggregate intrinsic value at December 31, 2013 was $2,467,057 on options outstanding and $1,149,534 on options exercisable. During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, the aggregate intrinsic value of options exercised under the Company's stock option plans was $268,920, $56,371, and $47,026, respectively, and determined as of the date of the option exercise.

 

Income taxes: The Company files its tax return on a consolidated basis with its subsidiaries. The entities follow the direct reimbursement method of accounting for income taxes under which income taxes or credits which result from the inclusion of the subsidiaries in the consolidated tax return are paid to or received from the parent company.

 

Deferred income taxes are provided under the liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences and net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards and deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences. Temporary differences are the differences between the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax basis. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax laws and rates on the date of enactment.

 

When tax returns are filed, it is highly certain that some positions taken would be sustained upon examination by the taxing authorities, while others are subject to uncertainty about the merits of the position taken or the amount of the position that would be ultimately sustained. The benefit of a tax position is recognized in the financial statements in the period during which, based on all available evidence, management believes it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination, including the resolution of appeals or litigation processes, if any. Tax positions taken are not offset or aggregated with other positions. Tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold are measured as the largest amount of tax benefit that is more than 50 percent likely of being realized upon settlement with the applicable taxing authority. The portion of the benefits associated with tax positions taken that exceeds the amount measured as described above is reflected as a liability for unrecognized tax benefits in the accompanying balance sheet along with any associated interest and penalties that would be payable to the taxing authorities upon examination.

 

Interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits are classified as additional income taxes in the statements of income.

 

Trust assets: Trust assets held by the subsidiary banks in a fiduciary, agency, or custodial capacity for their customers, other than cash on deposit at the subsidiary banks, are not included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements since such items are not assets of the subsidiary banks.

 

Earnings per common share: See Note 16 for a complete description and calculation of basic and diluted earnings per common share.

 

Reclassifications: Certain amounts in the prior year financial statements have been reclassified, with no effect on net income, comprehensive income, or stockholders’ equity, to conform with the current period presentation.

 

New accounting pronouncements: In December 2011, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued ASU 2011-11, Balance Sheet (Topic 210) - Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities. ASU 2011-11 requires entities to disclose both gross information and net information about both instruments and transactions eligible for offset in the balance sheet, and instruments and transactions subject to an agreement similar to a master netting arrangement. In January 2013, FASB issued ASU 2013-01, Clarifying the Scope of Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities. Both ASU 2011-11 and ASU 2013-01 were effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013, and interim periods within those annual periods. Adoption did not have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

 
79

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 1.     Nature of Business and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

In February 2013, FASB issued ASU 2013-02, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) – Reporting of Amounts Reclassified out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income. ASU 2013-02 supersedes and replaces the presentation requirements for reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) in ASUs 2011-05 and 2011-12, which were adopted by the Company during the current year. The amendments require an entity to provide information about the amounts reclassified out of AOCI by component. In addition, an entity is required to present, either on the face of the statement where net income is presented or in the notes, significant amounts reclassified out of AOCI by the respective line items of net income if the amount reclassified is required to be reclassified in its entirety in the same reporting period. For other amounts that are not required to be reclassified in their entirety to net income, an entity is required to cross-reference to other disclosures required. Adoption did not have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

In July 2013, FASB issued ASU 2013-11, Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists. ASU 2013-11 is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2013. Management is in the process of evaluating the impact of ASU 2013-11 on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

In January 2014, FASB issued ASU 2014-04, Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure. The objective of ASU 2014-04 is to reduce diversity by clarifying when an in substance repossession or foreclosure occurs, that is, when a creditor should be considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan such that the loan receivable should be derecognized and the real estate property recognized. ASU 2014-04 is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2014. Management is in the process of evaluating the impact of ASU 2014-04 on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

 

Note 2.     Community National Bancorporation and Community National Bank

 

On May 13, 2013, the Company acquired 100% of Community National’s outstanding common stock for aggregate consideration totaling $19,441,834, which consisted of 834,715 shares of the Company’s common stock valued at $13,180,150 and cash of $6,261,684. Community National was the bank holding company providing bank and bank related services through its wholly-owned bank subsidiary, CNB. CNB was a commercial bank headquartered in Waterloo, Iowa serving Waterloo and Cedar Falls, Iowa. As a de novo bank, CNB commenced its operations in 1997. Previously, CNB also served Mason City, Iowa and Austin, Minnesota. On October 4, 2013, the Company sold certain assets and liabilities of the two Mason City branches of CNB. And, on October 11, 2013, the Company sold certain assets and liabilities of the two Austin branches of CNB. The Company operated CNB as a separate banking charter from the date of acquisition until October 26, 2013, when CNB’s charter was merged with and into CRBT. CNB’s merged branch offices now operate as a division of CRBT under the name “Community Bank & Trust.”

 

 
80

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


 

Note 2.     Community National Bancorporation and Community National Bank (continued)

 

The Company accounted for the business combination under the acquisition method of accounting in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 805, “Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”). The Company recognized the full fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date, net of applicable income tax effects. The excess of fair value of net assets over the carrying value is recorded as bargain purchase gain which is included in noninterest income on the statement of income. The market value adjustments are accreted or amortized on a level yield basis over the expected term. Additionally, the Company recorded a core deposit intangible totaling $3,440,076 which was the portion of the acquisition purchase price which represented the value assigned to the existing deposit base at acquisition. The core deposit intangible has a finite life and is amortized by the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of the deposits (10 years). Following is a rollforward of the core deposit intangible for the year ended December 31, 2013:

 

   

2013

 
         

Balance, beginning

  $ -  

Core deposit intangible from Community National Acquistion

    3,440,076  

Amortization expense

    (178,881 )

Core deposit intangible sold in branch sales

    (1,390,762 )

Balance, ending

  $ 1,870,433  

 

The Company expects annual amortization expense of $199,512 for each of the five succeeding years and $872,873 combined in years thereafter.

 

The following table presents the gross carrying amount, accumulated amortization, and net carrying amount of the core deposit intangible as of December 31, 2013.

 

   

2013

 
         

Gross carrying amount

  $ 1,995,127  

Accumulated amortization

    (124,694 )

Net carrying amount

  $ 1,870,433  

 

The Company’s acquired loans were recorded at fair value at the acquisition date and no separate valuation allowance was established. The initial fair value was determined with the assistance of a valuation specialist that discounted expected cash flows at appropriate rates. The discount rates were based on market rates for new originations of comparable loans and did not include a factor for credit losses as that was included in the estimated cash flows. ASC Topic 310-30, “Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality”, applies to loans acquired in a transfer with evidence of deterioration of credit quality for which it is probable, at acquisition, that the investor will be unable to collect all contractually required payments receivable. If both conditions exist, the Company determines whether to account for each loan individually or whether such loans will be assembled into pools based on common risk characteristics such as credit score, loan type, and origination date. Based on this evaluation, the Company determined that the loans acquired from the Community National acquisition subject to ASC Topic 310-30 would be accounted for individually. At the acquisition date, the historical cost and fair value of these loans totaled $3,033,022 and $2,207,891, respectively.

 

 
81

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 2.     Community National Bancorporation and Community National Bank (continued)

 

The Company considered expected prepayments and estimated the total expected cash flows, which includes undiscounted expected principal and interest. The excess of that amount over the fair value of the loan is referred to as accretable yield. Accretable yield is recognized as interest income on a constant yield basis over the expected life of the loan. The excess of the contractual cash flows over expected cash flows is referred to as nonaccretable difference and is not accreted into income. Over the life of the loan, the Company continues to estimate expected cash flows. Subsequent decreases in expected cash flows are recognized as impairments in the current period through a provision for loan losses. Subsequent increases in cash flows to be collected are first used to reverse any existing valuation allowance and any remaining increase is recognized prospectively through an adjustment of the loan’s yield over its remaining life. At the acquisition date, accretable yield totaled $4,128,315 and nonaccretable yield totaled $397,894. At December 31, 2013, accretable yield totaled $2,068,332 and nonaccretable yield totaled $233,933. The decline in accretable yield was primarily the result of accelerated accretion of the accretable yield for the acquired performing loans sold in the branch sales as well as early payoffs of acquired performing loans.

 

The Company assumed junior subordinated debentures with principal outstanding of $6,702,000 and fair value of $4,125,175 after a discount of $2,576,825. The initial fair value was determined with the assistance of a valuation specialist that discounted expected cash flows at appropriate rates. The discount is accreted as interest expense on a level yield basis over the expected remaining term of the junior subordinated debentures.

 

Results of the operations of the acquired business are included in the income statement from the effective date of the acquisition.

 

 
82

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 2.     Community National Bancorporation and Community National Bank (continued)

 

The fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, including the consideration paid and resulting bargain purchase gain, is as follows:

 

   

As of

May 13, 2013

 

ASSETS

       

Cash and due from banks

  $ 9,286,757  

Federal funds sold

    12,335,000  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    2,024,539  

Securities available for sale

    45,853,826  

Loans/leases receivable, net

    195,658,486  

Premises and equipment

    8,132,021  

Core deposit intangible

    3,440,076  

Bank-owned life insurance

    4,595,529  

Restricted investment securities

    1,259,375  

Other real estate owned

    550,326  

Other assets

    5,178,583  

Total assets acquired

  $ 288,314,518  

LIABILITIES

       

Deposits

  $ 255,045,071  

Other borrowings

    3,950,000  

Junior subordinated debentures

    4,125,175  

Other liabilities

    3,911,053  

Total liabilties assumed

  $ 267,031,299  

Net assets acquired

  $ 21,283,219  

CONSIDERATION PAID:

       

Cash

  $ 6,261,684  

Issuance of 834,715 shares of common stock

    13,180,150  

Total consideration paid

  $ 19,441,834  

Bargain purchase gain

  $ 1,841,385  

 

In order to fund the cash portion of the consideration and pay off the $3,950,000 of Community National borrowings at acquisition, the Company borrowed $4,400,000 on its 364-day revolving credit note. The outstanding balance on the 364-day revolving credit note totaled $10,000,000 until maturity at June 26, 2013. Upon maturity, the credit facility was restructured whereby the $10,000,000 of outstanding debt was restructured into a secured 3-year term note with principal due quarterly and interest due monthly where the interest is calculated at the effective LIBOR rate plus 3.00% per annum (3.17% at December 31, 2013). Additionally, as part of the restructuring, the Company maintained a secured 364-day revolving credit note with availability of $10,000,000 where the interest is calculated at the effective LIBOR rate plus 2.50% per annum. At December 31, 2013, the Company had not borrowed on this revolving credit note and had the full amount available.

 

The current note agreement contains certain covenants that place restrictions on additional debt and stipulate minimum capital and various asset quality and operating ratios. 

 

 
83

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 2.     Community National Bancorporation and Community National Bank (continued)

 

The Company recorded a bargain purchase gain on the acquisition totaling $1,841,385 as the market value of the net assets acquired from Community National exceeded the total consideration paid. The consideration paid approximated a slight premium to the book value of Community National’s net assets at acquisition. The net impact of the market value adjustments resulted in a net increase to Community National’s net assets. The more significant market value adjustments were the core deposit intangible ($3,440,076) and the discount on the trust preferred securities ($2,576,825), as previously discussed.

 

The Company incurred costs related to the acquisition of Community National totaling $2,353,162. These costs consisted of professional fees (legal, investment banking, and accounting) for the acquisition of Community National and the subsequent branch sales, as well as data conversion costs (including both the de-conversion of the sold branches and the conversion of the remaining branches), and compensation costs for severed and retained employees.

 

Unaudited pro forma combined operating results for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, giving effect to the Community National acquisition as if it had occurred as of January 1, 2012, are as follows:

 

   

Years ended

December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Interest income

  $ 83,008,255     $ 87,514,410  

Noninterest income

  $ 22,042,194     $ 19,792,383  

Net income

  $ 11,320,890     $ 14,077,018  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

  $ 8,152,588     $ 10,092,460  
                 

Earnings per common share attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

               

Basic

  $ 1.47     $ 1.82  

Diluted

  $ 1.44     $ 1.79  

 

The pro forma results exclude the impact of the bargain purchase gain of $1,841,385 and the impact of the gains on sales of certain CNB branches of $2,334,216. Additionally, the pro forma results do not purport to be indicative of the results of operations that actually would have resulted had the acquisition occurred on January 1, 2012 or of future results of operations of the consolidated entities.

 

 
84

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 2.     Community National Bancorporation and Community National Bank (continued)

 

On October 4, 2013, the Company finalized the sale of certain assets and liabilities of the two Mason City, Iowa branches of CNB. The detail of the assets and liabilities sold, and resulting gain on sale, is as follows:

 

 

 

As of

October 4, 2013

 
ASSETS        

Cash

  $ 29,905,991  

Loans receivable

    22,709,735  

Premises and equipment

    776,782  

Core deposit intangible

    910,415  

Other assets

    68,456  

Total assets sold

  $ 54,371,379  
         

LIABILITIES

       

Deposits

  $ 55,191,930  

Other liabilities

    53,421  

Total liabilties sold

  $ 55,245,351  
         

Gain on sale, pre-tax

  $ 873,972  

 

On October 11, 2013, the Company finalized the sale of certain assets and liabilities of the two Austin, Minnesota branches of CNB. The detail of the assets and liabilities sold, and resulting gain on sale, is as follows:

 

   

As of

October 11, 2013

 
ASSETS        

Cash

  $ 519,627  

Loans receivable

    31,749,135  

Premises and equipment

    1,597,040  

Core deposit intangible

    480,347  

Other assets

    70,443  

Total assets sold

  $ 34,416,592  
         

LIABILITIES

       

Deposits

  $ 35,830,168  

Other liabilities

    46,668  

Total liabilties sold

  $ 35,876,836  
         

Gain on sale, pre-tax

  $ 1,460,244  


 
85

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 3.     Investment Securities

 

The amortized cost and fair value of investment securities as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 are summarized as follows:

 

   

Amortized

Cost

   

Gross

Unrealized

Gains

   

Gross

Unrealized

(Losses)

   

Fair

Value

 

December 31, 2013:

                               

Securities held to maturity:

                               

Municipal securities

  $ 144,401,895     $ 299,789     $ (7,111,579 )   $ 137,590,105  

Other securities

    1,050,000       -       -       1,050,000  
    $ 145,451,895     $ 299,789     $ (7,111,579 )   $ 138,640,105  
                                 

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 376,574,132     $ 41,696     $ (20,142,841 )   $ 356,472,987  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

    160,110,199       1,153,409       (3,834,157 )     157,429,451  

Municipal securities

    35,813,866       923,315       (778,324 )     35,958,857  

Other securities

    1,372,365       524,798       -       1,897,163  
    $ 573,870,562     $ 2,643,218     $ (24,755,322 )   $ 551,758,458  
                                 

December 31, 2012:

                               

Securities held to maturity:

                               

Municipal securities

  $ 71,429,385     $ 997,969     $ (71,648 )   $ 72,355,706  

Other securities

    650,000       -       -       650,000  
    $ 72,079,385     $ 997,969     $ (71,648 )   $ 73,005,706  
                                 

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 336,570,995     $ 2,198,655     $ (160,279 )   $ 338,609,371  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

    160,035,196       3,736,821       (170,914 )     163,601,103  

Municipal securities

    24,508,015       1,696,555       (18,834 )     26,185,736  

Trust preferred securities

    86,200       53,200       -       139,400  

Other securities

    1,347,113       300,732       (23,469 )     1,624,376  
    $ 522,547,519     $ 7,985,963     $ (373,496 )   $ 530,159,986  

 

The Company’s held-to-maturity municipal securities consist largely of private issues of municipal debt. The municipalities are located within the Midwest with a large portion located in or adjacent to the communities of QCBT and CRBT. The municipal debt investments are underwritten using specific guidelines with ongoing monitoring.

 

The Company’s residential mortgage-backed and related securities portfolio consists entirely of government sponsored or government guaranteed securities. The Company has not invested in commercial mortgage-backed securities or pooled trust preferred securities.

 

 
86

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 3.     Investment Securities (continued)

 

Gross unrealized losses and fair value, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, are summarized as follows:

 

   

Less than 12 Months

   

12 Months or More

   

Total

 
   

Fair

Value

   

Gross

Unrealized

Losses

   

Fair

Value

   

Gross

Unrealized

Losses

   

Fair

Value

   

Gross

Unrealized

Losses

 

December 31, 2013:

                                               

Securities held to maturity:

                                               

Municipal securities

  $ 101,983,602     $ (6,711,240 )   $ 2,697,375     $ (400,339 )   $ 104,680,977     $ (7,111,579 )
                                                 

Securities available for sale:

                                               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 333,194,820     $ (19,141,077 )   $ 10,978,390     $ (1,001,764 )   $ 344,173,210     $ (20,142,841 )

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

    94,723,092       (2,947,770 )     14,117,719       (886,387 )     108,840,811       (3,834,157 )

Municipal securities

    13,890,692       (724,939 )     985,687       (53,385 )     14,876,379       (778,324 )
    $ 441,808,604     $ (22,813,786 )   $ 26,081,796     $ (1,941,536 )   $ 467,890,400     $ (24,755,322 )
                                                 

December 31, 2012:

                                               

Securities held to maturity:

                                               

Municipal securities

  $ 4,282,352     $ (71,648 )   $ -     $ -     $ 4,282,352     $ (71,648 )
                                                 

Securities available for sale:

                                               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 55,621,718     $ (160,279 )   $ -     $ -     $ 55,621,718     $ (160,279 )

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

    29,324,928       (170,914 )     -       -       29,324,928       (170,914 )

Municipal securities

    1,039,625       (18,834 )     -       -       1,039,625       (18,834 )

Other securities

    -       -       217,500       (23,469 )     217,500       (23,469 )
    $ 85,986,271     $ (350,027 )   $ 217,500     $ (23,469 )   $ 86,203,771     $ (373,496 )

 

At December 31, 2013, the investment portfolio included 544 securities. Of this number, 354 securities had unrealized losses with aggregate depreciation of 5% from the total amortized cost basis. Of these 354, 16 had an unrealized loss for 12 months or more. All of the debt securities in unrealized loss positions are considered acceptable credit risks. Based upon an evaluation of the available evidence, including the recent changes in market rates, credit rating information and information obtained from regulatory filings, management believes the declines in fair value for these debt securities are temporary. In addition, the Company does not intend to sell these securities and/or it is not more-likely-than-not that the Company will be required to sell these debt securities before their anticipated recovery. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, the Company’s equity securities represent less than 1% of the total portfolio.

 

For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, the Company did not recognize other-than-temporary impairment on any debt securities.

 

The Company did not recognize other-than-temporary impairment on any equity securities for the year ended December 31, 2013.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company’s evaluation determined that one privately held equity security experienced a decline in fair value that was other-than-temporary. As a result, the Company wrote down the value of this security and recognized a loss in the amount of $62,400.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2011, the Company’s evaluation determined that two privately held equity securities experienced declines in fair value that were other-than-temporary. As a result, the Company wrote down the value of these securities and recognized losses in the amount of $118,847.

 

 
87

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 3.     Investment Securities (continued)

 

All sales of securities, as applicable, for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively, were from securities identified as available for sale. Information on proceeds received, as well as the gains and losses from the sale of those securities is as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Proceeds from sales of securities

  $ 37,393,047     $ 19,215,075     $ 54,326,191  

Gross gains from sales of securities

    523,071       104,600       1,472,528  

Gross losses from sales of securities

    (90,579 )     -       -  

 

The amortized cost and fair value of securities as of December 31, 2013, by contractual maturity are shown below. Expected maturities of mortgage-backed and related securities may differ from contractual maturities because the mortgages underlying the securities may be called or prepaid without any penalties. Therefore, these securities are not included in the maturity categories in the following summary. “Other securities” available for sale are excluded from the maturity categories as there is no fixed maturity date for those securities.

 

   

Amortized Cost

   

Fair Value

 

Securities held to maturity:

               

Due in one year or less

  $ 2,250,529     $ 2,250,467  

Due after one year through five years

    9,340,352       9,309,433  

Due after five years

    133,861,014       127,080,205  
    $ 145,451,895     $ 138,640,105  
                 

Securities available for sale:

               

Due in one year or less

  $ 6,416,406     $ 6,426,654  

Due after one year through five years

    46,861,212       46,420,946  

Due after five years

    359,110,380       339,584,244  
    $ 412,387,998     $ 392,431,844  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities

    160,110,199       157,429,451  

Other securities

    1,372,365       1,897,163  
    $ 573,870,562     $ 551,758,458  

  

Portions of the U.S. government sponsored agencies and municipal securities contain call options, at the discretion of the issuer, to terminate the security at predetermined dates prior to the stated maturity, summarized as follows:

 

   

Amortized Cost

   

Fair Value

 

Securities held to maturity:

               

Municipal securities

  $ 108,408,593     $ 102,628,515  
                 

Securities available for sale:

               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

    335,565,915       317,138,253  

Municipal securities

    22,760,530       22,574,232  
    $ 358,326,445     $ 339,712,485  

 

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, investment securities with a carrying value of $497,286,275 and $384,194,020, respectively, were pledged on Federal Home Loan Bank advances, customer and wholesale repurchase agreements, and for other purposes as required or permitted by law.

 

 
88

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable

 

The composition of the loan/lease portfolio as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is presented as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Commercial and industrial loans

  $ 431,688,129     $ 394,244,252  

Commercial real estate loans

               

Owner-occupied commercial real estate

    261,215,912       204,911,308  

Commercial construction, land development, and other land

    57,844,902       44,962,381  

Other non owner-occupied commercial real estate

    352,692,115       344,105,550  
      671,752,929       593,979,239  
                 

Direct financing leases *

    128,901,442       103,685,656  

Residential real estate loans **

    147,356,323       115,581,573  

Installment and other consumer loans

    76,033,810       76,720,514  
      1,455,732,633       1,284,211,234  

Plus deferred loan/lease orgination costs, net of fees

    4,546,925       3,176,405  
      1,460,279,558       1,287,387,639  

Less allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases

    (21,448,048 )     (19,925,204 )
    $ 1,438,831,510     $ 1,267,462,435  
                 
                 

* Direct financing leases:

               

Net minimum lease payments to be received

  $ 145,662,254     $ 117,719,380  

Estimated unguaranteed residual values of leased assets

    1,694,499       1,095,848  

Unearned lease/residual income

    (18,455,311 )     (15,129,572 )
      128,901,442       103,685,656  

Plus deferred lease origination costs, net of fees

    4,814,183       3,907,140  
      133,715,625       107,592,796  

Less allowance for estimated losses on leases

    (2,517,217 )     (1,990,395 )
    $ 131,198,408     $ 105,602,401  

 

Management performs an evaluation of the estimated unguaranteed residual values of leased assets on an annual basis, at a minimum. The evaluation consists of discussions with reputable and current vendors and management’s expertise and understanding of the current states of particular industries to determine informal valuations of the equipment. As necessary and where available, management will utilize valuations by independent appraisers. The large majority of leases with residual values contain a lease options rider which requires the lessee to pay the residual value directly, finance the payment of the residual value, or extend the lease term to pay the residual value. In these cases, the residual value is protected and the risk of loss is minimal.

 

There were no losses related to residual values during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011. At December 31, 2013, the Company had 33 leases remaining with residual values totaling $1,694,499 that were not protected with a lease end options rider. At December 31, 2012, the Company had 34 leases remaining with residual values totaling $1,095,848 that were not protected with a lease end options rider. Management has performed specific evaluations of these residual values and determined that the valuations are appropriate.

 

**Includes residential real estate loans held for sale totaling $1,358,290 and $4,577,233 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

 
89

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

The aging of the loan/lease portfolio by classes of loans/leases as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is presented as follows:

 

   

2013

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Current

   

30-59 Days

Past Due

   

60-89 Days

Past Due

   

Accruing Past

Due 90 Days or More

   

Nonaccrual Loans/Leases

   

Total

 
                                                 

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 429,557,699     $ 199,949     $ 185,500     $ -     $ 1,744,981     $ 431,688,129  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    258,557,660       465,418       993,163       60,286       1,139,385       261,215,912  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    56,301,186       358,626       -       -       1,185,090       57,844,902  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    341,743,730       476,877       151,017       -       10,320,491       352,692,115  

Direct Financing Leases

    126,878,515       714,464       414,005       -       894,458       128,901,442  

Residential Real Estate

    142,353,936       3,088,516       275,262       20,126       1,618,483       147,356,323  

Installment and Other Consumer

    74,811,489       127,082       116,468       3,762       975,009       76,033,810  
    $ 1,430,204,215     $ 5,430,932     $ 2,135,415     $ 84,174     $ 17,877,897     $ 1,455,732,633  
                                                 

As a percentage of total loan/lease portfolio

    98.25 %     0.37 %     0.15 %     0.01 %     1.23 %     100.00 %

 

   

2012

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Current

   

30-59 Days

Past Due

   

60-89 Days

Past Due

   

Accruing Past

Due 90 Days or More

   

Nonaccrual Loans/Leases

   

Total

 
                                                 

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 388,825,307     $ 3,724,506     $ 9,940     $ 120,000     $ 1,564,499     $ 394,244,252  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    204,141,070       142,993       -       -       627,245       204,911,308  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    42,180,819       -       -       -       2,781,562       44,962,381  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    332,644,532       86,986       1,111,856       -       10,262,176       344,105,550  

Direct Financing Leases

    101,635,084       877,210       174,560       -       998,802       103,685,656  

Residential Real Estate

    111,993,859       2,254,730       283,466       -       1,049,518       115,581,573  

Installment and Other Consumer

    75,711,203       301,025       20,112       39,481       648,693       76,720,514  
    $ 1,257,131,874     $ 7,387,450     $ 1,599,934     $ 159,481     $ 17,932,495     $ 1,284,211,234  
                                                 

As a percentage of total loan/lease portfolio

    97.89 %     0.58 %     0.12 %     0.01 %     1.40 %     100.00 %

 

 
90

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

Nonperforming loans/leases by classes of loans/leases as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is presented as follows:

 

   

2013

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Accruing Past

Due 90 Days or

More

   

Nonaccrual Loans/Leases *

   

Troubled Debt Restructurings - Accruing

   

Total

Nonperforming Loans/Leases

   

Percentage of

Total

Nonperforming Loans/Leases

 
                                         

Commercial and Industrial

  $ -     $ 1,744,981     $ 878,381     $ 2,623,362       12.81 %

Commercial Real Estate

                                       

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    60,286       1,139,385       -       1,199,671       5.86 %

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    -       1,185,090       -       1,185,090       5.79 %

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    -       10,320,491       905,205       11,225,696       54.80 %

Direct Financing Leases

    -       894,458       -       894,458       4.37 %

Residential Real Estate

    20,126       1,618,483       371,995       2,010,604       9.82 %

Installment and Other Consumer

    3,762       975,009       367,000       1,345,771       6.57 %
    $ 84,174     $ 17,877,897     $ 2,522,581     $ 20,484,652       100.00 %

 

*At December 31, 2013, nonaccrual loans/leases included $10,890,785 of troubled debt restructurings, including $77,072 in commercial and industrial loans, $10,077,501 in commercial real estate loans, $446,996 in residential real estate loans, and $289,216 in installment loans.

 

   

2012

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Accruing Past

Due 90 Days or

More

   

Nonaccrual Loans/Leases *

   

Troubled Debt Restructurings - Accruing

   

Total

Nonperforming Loans/Leases

   

Percentage of

Total

Nonperforming Loans/Leases

 
                                         

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 120,000     $ 1,564,499     $ 184,084     $ 1,868,583       7.36 %

Commercial Real Estate

                                       

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    -       627,245       -       627,245       2.47 %

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    -       2,781,562       1,016,023       3,797,585       14.96 %

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    -       10,262,176       5,820,765       16,082,941       63.34 %

Direct Financing Leases

    -       998,802       -       998,802       3.93 %

Residential Real Estate

    -       1,049,518       167,739       1,217,257       4.79 %

Installment and Other Consumer

    39,481       648,693       110,982       799,156       3.15 %
    $ 159,481     $ 17,932,495     $ 7,299,593     $ 25,391,569       100.00 %

 

**At December 31, 2012, nonaccrual loans/leases included $5,658,781 of troubled debt restructurings, including $99,804 in commercial and industrial loans, $5,173,589 in commercial real estate loans, $64,722 in residential real estate loans, and $320,666 in installment loans.

 

 
91

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

Changes in the allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 are presented as follows:

 

   

Year Ended December 31, 2013

 
                                                 
   

Commercial and Industrial

   

Commercial Real Estate

   

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                                 

Balance, beginning

  $ 4,531,545     $ 11,069,502     $ 1,990,395     $ 1,070,328     $ 1,263,434     $ 19,925,204  

Provisions charged to expense

    1,453,455       2,635,327       1,431,246       471,060       (60,668 )     5,930,420  

Loans/leases charged off

    (962,607 )     (3,573,006 )     (916,836 )     (162,010 )     (229,447 )     (5,843,906 )

Recoveries on loans/leases previously charged off

    626,381       573,611       12,412       16,471       207,455       1,436,330  

Balance, ending

  $ 5,648,774     $ 10,705,434     $ 2,517,217     $ 1,395,849     $ 1,180,774     $ 21,448,048  

 

   

Year Ended December 31, 2012

 
                                                 
   

Commercial and Industrial

   

Commercial Real Estate

   

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                                 

Balance, beginning

  $ 4,878,006     $ 10,596,958     $ 1,339,496     $ 704,946     $ 1,269,856     $ 18,789,262  

Provisions charged to expense

    (327,045 )     2,482,327       1,313,767       370,140       531,578       4,370,767  

Loans/leases charged off

    (682,877 )     (2,232,004 )     (739,755 )     (4,758 )     (717,035 )     (4,376,429 )

Recoveries on loans/leases previously charged off

    663,461       222,221       76,887       -       179,035       1,141,604  

Balance, ending

  $ 4,531,545     $ 11,069,502     $ 1,990,395     $ 1,070,328     $ 1,263,434     $ 19,925,204  

 

   

Year Ended December 31, 2011

 
                                                 
   

Commercial and Industrial

   

Commercial Real Estate

   

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                                 

Balance, beginning

  $ 7,548,922     $ 9,087,315     $ 1,530,572     $ 748,028     $ 1,449,819     $ 20,364,656  

Provisions charged to expense

    256,945       4,759,003       907,014       (4,147 )     697,199       6,616,014  

Loans/leases charged off

    (3,262,742 )     (3,590,868 )     (1,100,886 )     (38,935 )     (1,068,320 )     (9,061,751 )

Recoveries on loans/leases previously charged off

    334,881       341,508       2,796       -       191,158       870,343  

Balance, ending

  $ 4,878,006     $ 10,596,958     $ 1,339,496     $ 704,946     $ 1,269,856     $ 18,789,262  

 

 
92

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

The allowance for estimated losses on loans/leases by impairment evaluation and by portfolio segment as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is presented as follows:

 

   

2013

 
   

Commercial and Industrial

   

Commercial Real Estate

   

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                                 

Allowance for loans/leases individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 927,453     $ 3,174,704     $ 192,847     $ 246,266     $ 467,552     $ 5,008,822  

Allowance for loans/leases collectively evaluated for impairment

    4,721,321       7,530,730       2,324,370       1,149,583       713,222       16,439,226  
    $ 5,648,774     $ 10,705,434     $ 2,517,217     $ 1,395,849     $ 1,180,774     $ 21,448,048  
                                                 
                                                 

Loans/leases individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 1,761,850     $ 12,956,915     $ 894,458     $ 2,116,747     $ 1,350,450     $ 19,080,420  

Loans/leases collectively evaluated for impairment

    429,926,279       658,796,014       128,006,984       145,239,576       74,683,360       1,436,652,213  
    $ 431,688,129     $ 671,752,929     $ 128,901,442     $ 147,356,323     $ 76,033,810     $ 1,455,732,633  
                                                 
                                                 

Allowance as a percentage of loans/leases individually evaluated for impairment

    52.64 %     24.50 %     21.56 %     11.63 %     34.62 %     26.25 %

Allowance as a percentage of loans/leases collectively evaluated for impairment

    1.10 %     1.14 %     1.82 %     0.79 %     0.95 %     1.14 %

Total allowance as a percentage of total loans/leaess

    1.31 %     1.59 %     1.95 %     0.95 %     1.55 %     1.47 %

 

 

   

2012

 
   

Commercial and Industrial

   

Commercial Real Estate

   

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                                 

Allowance for loans/leases individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 280,170     $ 4,005,042     $ 125,000     $ 105,565     $ 71,992     $ 4,587,769  

Allowance for loans/leases collectively evaluated for impairment

    4,251,375       7,064,460       1,865,395       964,763       1,191,442       15,337,435  
    $ 4,531,545     $ 11,069,502     $ 1,990,395     $ 1,070,328     $ 1,263,434     $ 19,925,204  
                                                 
                                                 

Loans/leases individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 1,006,952     $ 20,383,846     $ 998,802     $ 1,217,256     $ 687,355     $ 24,294,211  

Loans/leases collectively evaluated for impairment

    393,237,300       573,595,393       102,686,854       114,364,317       76,033,159       1,259,917,023  
    $ 394,244,252     $ 593,979,239     $ 103,685,656     $ 115,581,573     $ 76,720,514     $ 1,284,211,234  
                                                 
                                                 

Allowance as a percentage of loans/leases individually evaluated for impairment

    27.82 %     19.65 %     12.51 %     8.67 %     10.47 %     18.88 %

Allowance as a percentage of loans/leases collectively evaluated for impairment

    1.08 %     1.23 %     1.82 %     0.84 %     1.57 %     1.22 %

Total allowance as a percentage of total loans/leaess

    1.15 %     1.86 %     1.92 %     0.93 %     1.65 %     1.55 %

 

 
93

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

Information for impaired loans/leases is presented in the tables below. The recorded investment represents customer balances net of any partial charge-offs recognized on the loan/lease. The unpaid principal balance represents the recorded balance outstanding on the loan/lease prior to any partial charge-offs.

 

Loans/leases, by classes of financing receivable, considered to be impaired as of and for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 is presented as follows:

 

   

2013

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Recorded Investment

   

Unpaid

Principal

Balance

   

Related

Allowance

   

Average

Recorded Investment

   

Interest Income Recognized

   

Interest Income Recognized for Cash Payments Received

 
                                                 

Impaired Loans/Leases with No Specific Allowance Recorded:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 492,622     $ 568,951     $ -     $ 747,134     $ 7,749     $ 7,749  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    392,542       392,542       -       1,881,823       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    1,943,168       2,054,368       -       2,666,039       -       -  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    1,790,279       1,902,279       -       3,869,493       58,534       58,534  

Direct Financing Leases

    557,469       557,469       -       802,825       -       -  

Residential Real Estate

    1,071,927       1,071,927       -       1,010,027       4,235       4,235  

Installment and Other Consumer

    509,667       509,667       -       606,282       4,464       4,464  
    $ 6,757,674     $ 7,057,203     $ -     $ 11,583,623     $ 74,982     $ 74,982  
                                                 

Impaired Loans/Leases with Specific Allowance Recorded:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 1,269,228     $ 1,956,755     $ 927,453     $ 1,222,449     $ 33,703     $ 33,703  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    159,247       159,247       67,498       87,035       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    888,547       1,011,747       503,825       1,137,489       10,862       10,862  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    7,783,132       8,488,414       2,603,381       7,426,299       45,926       45,926  

Direct Financing Leases

    336,989       336,989       192,847       97,846       -       -  

Residential Real Estate

    1,044,820       1,044,820       246,266       641,217       1,883       1,883  

Installment and Other Consumer

    840,783       840,783       467,552       640,557       -       -  
    $ 12,322,746     $ 13,838,755     $ 5,008,822     $ 11,252,892     $ 92,374     $ 92,374  
                                                 

Total Impaired Loans/Leases:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 1,761,850     $ 2,525,706     $ 927,453     $ 1,969,583     $ 41,452     $ 41,452  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    551,789       551,789       67,498       1,968,858       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    2,831,715       3,066,115       503,825       3,803,528       10,862       10,862  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    9,573,411       10,390,693       2,603,381       11,295,792       104,460       104,460  

Direct Financing Leases

    894,458       894,458       192,847       900,671       -       -  

Residential Real Estate

    2,116,747       2,116,747       246,266       1,651,244       6,118       6,118  

Installment and Other Consumer

    1,350,450       1,350,450       467,552       1,246,839       4,464       4,464  
    $ 19,080,420     $ 20,895,958     $ 5,008,822     $ 22,836,515     $ 167,356     $ 167,356  

 

Impaired loans/leases for which no allowance has been provided have adequate collateral, based on management’s current estimates.

 

 
94

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

   

2012

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Recorded Investment

   

Unpaid

Principal

Balance

   

Related

Allowance

   

Average

Recorded Investment

   

Interest Income Recognized

   

Interest Income Recognized for Cash Payments Received

 
                                                 

Impaired Loans/Leases with No Specific Allowance Recorded:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 438,355     $ 1,203,710     $ -     $ 757,286     $ 7,910     $ 7,910  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    503,321       503,321       -       624,766       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    678,523       678,523       -       3,359,435       3,549       3,549  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    495,702       495,702       -       5,288,820       2,017       2,017  

Direct Financing Leases

    777,645       777,645       -       871,076       -       -  

Residential Real Estate

    944,211       1,127,242       -       1,050,160       6,728       6,728  

Installment and Other Consumer

    534,368       534,368       -       815,720       629       629  
    $ 4,372,125     $ 5,320,511     $ -     $ 12,767,263     $ 20,833     $ 20,833  
                                                 

Impaired Loans/Leases with Specific Allowance Recorded:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 568,597     $ 590,849     $ 280,170     $ 499,036     $ -     $ -  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    -       -       -       -       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    3,967,583       3,967,583       1,105,795       2,311,845       5,749       5,749  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    14,738,717       14,991,676       2,899,247       10,949,295       308,339       308,339  

Direct Financing Leases

    221,157       221,157       125,000       90,610       -       -  

Residential Real Estate

    273,045       273,045       105,565       258,677       -       -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    152,987       152,987       71,992       101,075       -       -  
    $ 19,922,086     $ 20,197,297     $ 4,587,769     $ 14,210,538     $ 314,088     $ 314,088  
                                                 

Total Impaired Loans/Leases:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 1,006,952     $ 1,794,559     $ 280,170     $ 1,256,322     $ 7,910     $ 7,910  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    503,321       503,321       -       624,766       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    4,646,106       4,646,106       1,105,795       5,671,280       9,298       9,298  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    15,234,419       15,487,378       2,899,247       16,238,115       310,356       310,356  

Direct Financing Leases

    998,802       998,802       125,000       961,686       -       -  

Residential Real Estate

    1,217,256       1,400,287       105,565       1,308,837       6,728       6,728  

Installment and Other Consumer

    687,355       687,355       71,992       916,795       629       629  
    $ 24,294,211     $ 25,517,808     $ 4,587,769     $ 26,977,801     $ 334,921     $ 334,921  

 

Impaired loans/leases for which no allowance has been provided have adequate collateral, based on management’s current estimates.

 

 
95

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

   

2011

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Recorded Investment

   

Unpaid Principal Balance

   

Related Allowance

   

Average Recorded Investment

   

Interest Income Recognized

   

Interest Income Recognized for Cash Payments Received

 
                                                 

Impaired Loans/Leases with No Specific Allowance Recorded:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 360,947     $ 979,901     $ -     $ 3,873,371     $ -     $ -  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    736,610       736,610       -       1,909,754       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    -       -       -       2,979,950       -       -  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    3,936,826       3,986,820       -       5,568,776       -       -  

Direct Financing Leases

    1,094,178       1,094,178       -       1,487,570       81,921       81,921  

Residential Real Estate

    788,685       862,298       -       892,480       -       -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    593,987       593,987       -       821,889       -       -  
    $ 7,511,233     $ 8,253,794     $ -     $ 17,533,790     $ 81,921     $ 81,921  
                                                 

Impaired Loans/Leases with Specific Allowance Recorded:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 1,791,908     $ 1,791,908     $ 903,187     $ 1,175,105     $ 36,984     $ 36,984  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    217,059       217,059       47,911       121,201       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    9,051,455       9,051,455       3,002,450       4,334,241       16,249       16,249  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    10,339,415       10,839,415       1,247,377       5,595,044       11,623       11,623  

Direct Financing Leases

    212,485       212,485       66,675       138,127       5,244       5,244  

Residential Real Estate

    344,789       344,789       55,884       282,020       -       -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    390,819       390,819       22,819       51,871       -       -  
    $ 22,347,930     $ 22,847,930     $ 5,346,303     $ 11,697,609     $ 70,100     $ 70,100  
                                                 

Total Impaired Loans/Leases:

                                               

Commercial and Industrial

  $ 2,152,855     $ 2,771,809     $ 903,187     $ 5,048,476     $ 36,984     $ 36,984  

Commercial Real Estate

                                               

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    953,669       953,669       47,911       2,030,955       -       -  

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    9,051,455       9,051,455       3,002,450       7,314,191       16,249       16,249  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    14,276,241       14,826,235       1,247,377       11,163,820       11,623       11,623  

Direct Financing Leases

    1,306,663       1,306,663       66,675       1,625,697       87,165       87,165  

Residential Real Estate

    1,133,474       1,207,087       55,884       1,174,500       -       -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    984,806       984,806       22,819       873,760       -       -  
    $ 29,859,163     $ 31,101,724     $ 5,346,303     $ 29,231,399     $ 152,021     $ 152,021  

 

Impaired loans/leases for which no allowance has been provided have adequate collateral, based on management’s current estimates.

 

 
96

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

For commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans, the Company’s credit quality indicator is internally assigned risk ratings. Each commercial loan is assigned a risk rating upon origination. The risk rating is reviewed every 15 months, at a minimum, and on as needed basis depending on the specific circumstances of the loan. See Note 1 for further discussion on the Company’s risk ratings.

 

For direct financing leases, residential real estate loans, and installment and other consumer loans, the Company’s credit quality indicator is performance determined by delinquency status. Delinquency status is updated daily by the Company’s loan system.

 

For each class of financing receivable, the following presents the recorded investment by credit quality indicator as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

 
           

Commercial Real Estate

         
                   

Non Owner-Occupied

         

Internally Assigned Risk Rating

 

Commercial and Industrial

   

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

   

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

   

Other Commercial Real Estate

   

Total

 
                                         

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

  $ 407,294,743     $ 250,028,731     $ 51,868,919     $ 326,168,882     $ 1,035,361,275  

Special Mention (Rating 6)

    11,355,713       8,318,232       1,588,086       3,310,017       24,572,048  

Substandard (Rating 7)

    13,037,673       2,868,949       4,387,897       23,213,216       43,507,735  

Doubtful (Rating 8)

    -       -       -       -       -  
    $ 431,688,129     $ 261,215,912     $ 57,844,902     $ 352,692,115     $ 1,103,441,058  

 

           

2013

 

Delinquency Status *

         

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                         

Performing

          $ 128,006,984     $ 145,345,719     $ 74,688,039     $ 348,040,742  

Nonperforming

            894,458       2,010,604       1,345,771       4,250,833  
            $ 128,901,442     $ 147,356,323     $ 76,033,810     $ 352,291,575  

 

   

2012

 
           

Commercial Real Estate

         
                   

Non Owner-Occupied

         

Internally Assigned Risk Rating

 

Commercial and Industrial

   

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

   

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

   

Other Commercial Real Estate

   

Total

 
                                         

Pass (Ratings 1 through 5)

  $ 371,856,380     $ 195,567,523     $ 38,125,793     $ 312,370,393     $ 917,920,089  

Special Mention (Rating 6)

    8,008,866       5,488,602       1,238,152       7,319,902       22,055,522  

Substandard (Rating 7)

    14,379,006       3,855,183       5,598,436       24,415,255       48,247,880  

Doubtful (Rating 8)

    -       -       -       -       -  
    $ 394,244,252     $ 204,911,308     $ 44,962,381     $ 344,105,550     $ 988,223,491  

 

           

2012

 

Delinquency Status *

         

Direct Financing Leases

   

Residential Real Estate

   

Installment and Other Consumer

   

Total

 
                                         

Performing

          $ 102,686,854     $ 114,364,316     $ 75,921,358     $ 292,972,528  

Nonperforming

            998,802       1,217,257       799,156       3,015,215  
            $ 103,685,656     $ 115,581,573     $ 76,720,514     $ 295,987,743  

 

*Performing = loans/leases accruing and less than 90 days past due. Nonperforming = loans/leases on nonaccrual, accruing loans/leases that are greater than or equal to 90 days past due, and accruing troubled debt restructurings.

 

 
97

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, troubled debt restructurings totaled $13,413,366 and $12,958,374, respectively.

 

For each class of financing receivable, the following presents the number and recorded investment of troubled debt restructurings, by type of concession, that were restructured during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012. The difference between the pre-modification recorded investment and the post-modification recorded investment would be any partial charge-offs at the time of restructuring. The specific allowance is as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The following excludes any troubled debt restructurings that were restructured and paid off in the same year.

 

   

2013

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Number of Loans/Leases

   

Pre-Modification Recorded Investment

   

Post-Modification Recorded Investment

   

Specific Allowance

 
                                 

CONCESSION - Extension of maturity

                               

Commercial and Industrial

    3     $ 809,494     $ 809,494     $ 182,498  

Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    1       61,517       61,517       10,260  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate *

    8       6,637,835       6,637,835       1,535,154  
      12     $ 7,508,846     $ 7,508,846     $ 1,727,912  
                                 

CONCESSION - Significant payment delay

                               

Residential Real Estate

    1     $ 91,581     $ 91,581     $ -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    1       370,000       370,000       300  
      2     $ 461,581     $ 461,581     $ 300  
                                 

CONCESSION - Interest rate adjusted below market

                               

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    1     $ 337,500     $ 337,500     $ -  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate **

    1       -       -       4,837  

Residential Real Estate

    3       394,838       394,838       108,121  
      5     $ 732,338     $ 732,338     $ 112,958  
                                 

TOTAL

    19     $ 8,702,765     $ 8,702,765     $ 1,841,170  

 

*Includes one troubled debt restructuring that is a $136,000 line of credit that had nothing outstanding at the time of modification. The total amount outstanding as of December 31, 2013 was $135,477 with specific allowance of $67,745.

**Includes one troubled debt restructuring that is a $25,000 line of credit that had nothing outstanding at the time of modification. The total amount outstanding as of December 31, 2013 was $4,837 with specific allowance of $4,837.

 

Of the troubled debt restructurings reported above, 13 with post-modification recorded investments totaling $6,579,346 were on nonaccrual as of December 31, 2013.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company had one troubled debt restructuring that redefaulted within 12 months subsequent to restructure where default is defined as delinquency of 90 days or more and/or placement on nonaccrual status. The one troubled debt restructuring had a pre-modification and post-modification recorded investment of $61,517 with no specific allowance.

 

 
98

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

   

2012

 

Classes of Loans/Leases

 

Number of Loans/Leases

   

Pre-Modification Recorded Investment

   

Post-Modification Recorded Investment

   

Specific Allowance

 
                                 

CONCESSION - Extension of maturity

                               

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    1     $ 733,442     $ 733,442     $ 176,526  
                                 

CONCESSION - Significant payment delay

                               

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    8     $ 1,274,172     $ 1,274,172     $ 190,997  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    2       264,173       264,173       36,724  

Residential Real Estate

    1       64,722       64,722       -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    2       35,318       35,318       5,332  
      13     $ 1,638,385     $ 1,638,385     $ 233,053  
                                 

CONCESSION - Interest rate adjusted below market

                               

Commercial Construction, Land Development, and Other Land

    1     $ 337,500     $ 337,500     $ 55,295  

Other Non Owner-Occupied Commercial Real Estate

    2       1,542,784       1,289,825       262,704  

Residential Real Estate

    1       167,739       167,739       -  

Installment and Other Consumer

    1       16,043       16,043       -  
      5     $ 2,064,066     $ 1,811,107     $ 317,999  
                                 

TOTAL

    19     $ 4,435,893     $ 4,182,934     $ 727,578  

 

Of the troubled debt restructurings reported above, 9 with post-modification recorded investments totaling $1,779,126 were on nonaccrual as of December 31, 2012.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2012, none of the Company’s troubled debt restructurings had redefaulted within 12 months subsequent to restructure where default is defined as delinquency of 90 days or more and/or placement on nonaccrual status.

 

 
99

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 4.     Loans/Leases Receivable (continued)

 

Loans are made in the normal course of business to directors, executive officers, and their related interests. The terms of these loans, including interest rates and collateral, are similar to those prevailing for comparable transactions with other persons. An analysis of the changes in the aggregate committed amount of loans greater than or equal to $60,000 during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, was as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Balance, beginning

  $ 20,502,058     $ 19,155,542     $ 20,796,427  

Net increase (decrease) due to change in related parties

    17,124,702       2,784,143       (235,000 )

Advances

    6,213,381       6,754,970       10,674,567  

Repayments

    (4,647,175 )     (8,192,597 )     (12,080,452 )

Balance, ending

  $ 39,192,966     $ 20,502,058     $ 19,155,542  

 

The Company’s loan portfolio includes a geographic concentration in the Midwest. Additionally, the loan portfolio includes a concentration of loans in certain industries as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 

Industry Name

 

Balance

   

Percentage of Total Loans/Leases

   

Balance

   

Percentage of Total Loans/Leases

 
                                 

Lessors of Non-Residential Buildings

  $ 237,049,149       16 %   $ 178,060,120       14 %

Lessors of Residential Buildings

    69,087,354       5 %     61,459,574       5 %

Bank Holding Companies

    56,716,875       4 %     47,662,055       4 %

 

 
100

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 5.     Premises and Equipment

 

The following summarizes the components of premises and equipment as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Land

  $ 7,287,656     $ 5,583,180  

Buildings (useful lives 15 to 50 years)

    31,290,618       28,368,503  

Furniture and equipment (useful lives 3 to 10 years)

    21,882,303       20,069,281  
      60,460,577       54,020,964  

Less accumulated depreciation

    23,705,213       22,758,574  
    $ 36,755,364     $ 31,262,390  

 

Certain facilities are leased under operating leases. Rental expense was $795,816, $372,631, and $290,101 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively.

 

Future minimum rental commitments under noncancelable leases are as follows as of December 31, 2013:

 

 

Year ending December 31:

       
 

2014

  $ 358,362  
 

2015

    233,188  
 

2016

    239,241  
 

2017

    241,116  
 

2018

    194,016  
 

Thereafter

    162,792  
      $ 1,428,715  

 

 
101

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 6.     Deposits

 

The aggregate amount of certificates of deposit, each with a minimum denomination of $100,000, was $305,326,265 and $249,664,219 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

As of December 31, 2013, the scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit were as follows:

 

 

Year ending December 31:

       
 

2014

  $ 300,290,809  
 

2015

    59,280,188  
 

2016

    16,177,554  
 

2017

    6,607,701  
 

2018

    6,425,639  
  Thereafter     2,000,000  
      $ 390,781,891  

 

Note 7.     Short-Term Borrowings

 

Short-term borrowings as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 are summarized as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Overnight repurchase agreements with customers

  $ 98,822,967     $ 104,942,961  

Federal funds purchased

    50,470,000       66,140,000  
    $ 149,292,967     $ 171,082,961  

 

Information concerning overnight repurchase agreements with customers is summarized as follows as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Average daily balance during the period

  $ 123,543,416     $ 111,782,307  

Average daily interest rate during the period

    0.12 %     0.13 %

Maximum month-end balance during the period

  $ 146,075,177     $ 141,890,506  

Weighted average rate as of end of period

    0.13 %     0.11 %
                 

Securities underlying the agreements as of end of period:

               

Carrying value

  $ 143,262,002     $ 160,950,808  

Fair value

    143,262,002       160,950,808  

 

The securities underlying the agreements as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 were under the Company's control in safekeeping at third-party financial institutions.

 

 
102

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 7.     Short-Term Borrowings (continued)

 

Information concerning federal funds purchased is summarized as follows as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Average daily balance during the period

  $ 41,156,729     $ 52,379,823  

Average daily interest rate during the period

    0.40 %     0.27 %

Maximum month-end balance during the period

  $ 95,380,000     $ 80,150,000  

Weighted average rate as of end of period

    0.28 %     0.26 %

 

Note 8.     Federal Home Loan Bank Advances

 

The subsidiary banks are members of the FHLB of Des Moines or Chicago. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the subsidiary banks held $12,343,500 and $11,986,400, respectively, of FHLB stock, which is included in restricted investment securities on the consolidated balance sheets.

 

During the first quarter of 2011, QCBT prepaid $15,000,000 of FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 4.87% and a weighted average maturity of May 2012. The fees for prepayment totaled $832,099 and are included in noninterest expenses in the Statement of Income. In addition, QCBT modified $20,350,000 of fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 4.33% and a weighted average maturity of October 2013 into new fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 3.35% and a weighted average maturity of February 2014.

 

During the fourth quarter of 2011, RB&T modified $13,000,000 of fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average rate of 3.37% and a weighted average maturity of March 2013 into new fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 2.29% and a weighted average maturity of February 2016.

 

During the second quarter of 2013, CRBT modified $20,000,000 of fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average rate of 4.82% and a weighted average maturity of October 2016 into new fixed rate FHLB advances with a weighted average interest rate of 4.12% and a weighted average maturity of June 2019.

 

There were no prepayments during 2013 or 2012.

 

 
103

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 8.     Federal Home Loan Bank Advances (continued)

 

Maturity and interest rate information on advances from FHLB as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is as follows:

 

   

December 31, 2013

 
   

Amount Due

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate

at Year-End

   

Amount Due

with

Putable Option *

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate

at Year-End

 

Maturity:

                                   

Year ending December 31:

                                   

2014

  $ 75,850,000       1.32 %     $ -       - %  

2015

    21,000,000       2.26         -       -    

2016

    42,500,000       3.96         32,500,000       4.56    

2017

    31,000,000       3.75         15,000,000       4.42    

2018

    41,000,000       3.58         5,000,000       2.84    

Thereafter

    20,000,000       4.12         -       -    

Total FHLB advances

  $ 231,350,000       2.86       $ 52,500,000       4.36    

 

   

December 31, 2012

 
   

Amount Due

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate

at Year-End

   

Amount Due

with

Putable Option *

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate

at Year-End

 

Maturity:

                                   

Year ending December 31:

                                   

2013

  $ 24,000,000       1.50 %     $ -       - %  

2014

    27,850,000       3.16         -       -    

2015

    16,000,000       2.84         -       -    

2016

    57,500,000       4.19         47,500,000       4.64    

2017

    36,000,000       3.89         20,000,000       4.51    

Thereafter

    41,000,000       3.58         33,000,000       3.64    

Total FHLB advances

  $ 202,350,000       3.45       $ 100,500,000       4.29    

 

*Of the advances outstanding, a large portion have putable options which allow the FHLB, at its discretion, to terminate the advances and require the subsidiary banks to repay at predetermined dates prior to the stated maturity date of the advances.

 

Advances are collateralized by securities with a carrying value of $87,061,601 and $18,959,669 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and by loans pledged of $543,076,034 and $423,179,584, respectively, in aggregate. On pledged loans, the FHLB applies varying collateral maintenance levels from 125% to 333% based on the loan type.

 

 
104

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


 

Note 9.     Other Borrowings and Unused Lines of Credit

 

Other borrowings as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 are summarized as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Wholesale repurchase agreements

  $ 130,000,000     $ 130,000,000  

Term note

    9,800,000       -  

364-day revolving note

    -       5,600,000  

Series A subordinated notes

    2,648,362       2,639,762  
    $ 142,448,362     $ 138,239,762  

 

Maturity and interest rate information concerning wholesale structured repurchase agreements is summarized as follows:

 

   

December 31, 2013

   

December 31, 2012

 
   

Amount Due

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate

at Year-End

   

Amount Due

   

Weighted

Average

Interest Rate

at Year-End

 

Maturity:

                                   

Year ending December 31:

                                   

2015

  $ 5,000,000       2.77 %     $ 35,000,000       3.00 %  

2016

    -       0.00         20,000,000       3.46    

2017

    10,000,000       3.00         10,000,000       3.00    

Thereafter

    115,000,000       3.25         65,000,000       3.71    

Total Wholesale Structured Repurchase Agreements

  $ 130,000,000       3.21       $ 130,000,000       3.43    

 

Each wholesale structured repurchase agreement has a one-time put option, at the discretion of the counterparty, to terminate the agreement and require the subsidiary bank to repay at predetermined dates prior to the stated maturity date of the agreement.

 

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, embedded within $30,000,000 and $50,000,000, respectively, of the wholesale structured repurchase agreements were interest rate cap options with varying terms. Of the $30,000,000 as of December 31, 2013, all of it matures in 2019 with the caps expiring in 2014 in conjunction with the one-time put option. Of the $50,000,000 as of December 31, 2012, $20,000,000 matures in 2016 with the caps expiring in 2013 in conjunction with the one-time put option, and $30,000,000 matures in 2019 with the caps expiring in 2014 in conjunction with the one-time put option. The interest rate cap options are effected when the 3-month LIBOR rate increases to certain levels. If that situation occurs, the rate paid will be decreased by the difference between the 3-month LIBOR rate and the particular cap level. In no case will the rate paid fall below 0.00%.

 

 
105

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 9.     Other Borrowings and Unused Lines of Credit (continued)

 

During 2013, the Company modified $50,000,000 of fixed rate wholesale structured repurchase agreements with a weighted average interest rate of 3.21% and a weighted average maturity of February 2016 into new fixed rate wholesale structured repurchase agreements with a weighted average interest rate of 2.65% and a weighted average maturity of May 2020. During 2012, the Company modified $25,000,000 of fixed rate wholesale structured repurchase agreements with a weighted average interest rate of 3.77% and a weighted average maturity of December 2015 into new fixed rate wholesale structured repurchase agreements with a weighted average interest rate of 3.21% and a weighted average maturity of April 2019. Of this $25,000,000, $15,000,000 had interest rate cap options embedded that were set to expire in 2013 in conjunction with the one-time put option. Upon modification, the interest rate cap options were cancelled.

 

The wholesale structured repurchase agreements are collateralized by securities with a carrying value of $151,592,944 and $160,772,093 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

At December 31, 2012, the Company had a single $20,000,000 secured revolving credit note which matures every 364 days. At December 31, 2012, the note carried a balance outstanding of $5,600,000. Interest was payable monthly at the effective LIBOR rate plus 2.50% per annum, as defined by the credit agreement. As of December 31, 2012, the interest rate on the note was 2.71%. In order to fund the cash portion of the consideration and pay off the $3,950,000 of Community National borrowings at acquisition, the Company borrowed $4,400,000 on its 364-day revolving credit note. The outstanding balance on the 364-day revolving credit note totaled $10,000,000 until maturity at June 26, 2013. Upon maturity, the credit facility was restructured whereby the $10,000,000 of outstanding debt was restructured into a secured 3-year term note with principal due quarterly and interest due monthly where the interest is calculated at the effective LIBOR rate plus 3.00% per annum (3.17% at December 31, 2013). Additionally, as part of the restructuring, the Company maintained a secured 364-day revolving credit note with availability of $10,000,000 where the interest is calculated at the effective LIBOR rate plus 2.50% per annum. At December 31, 2013, the Company had not borrowed on this revolving credit note and had the full amount available.

 

The current revolving note agreement contains certain covenants that place restrictions on additional debt and stipulate minimum capital and various operating ratios.

 

On March 19, 2010, the Company closed a private placement offering resulting in the issuance of 2,700 units (each, a “Unit”) to accredited investors for an aggregate purchase price of $2,700,000, or $1,000 per Unit. Each Unit consists of a 6.00% Series A Subordinated Note, due September 1, 2018 (collectively, the “Subordinated Notes”), $1,000 principal amount, and a detachable warrant (collectively, the “Warrants”) to acquire 20 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $1.00 per share (the “Common Stock”), at a per share exercise price equal to $10.00 per share, subject to normal adjustments, as set forth in the Warrants. During the year ended December 31, 2012, all 54,000 Warrants were exercised by the holders for total proceeds in the amount of $540,000.

 

The Subordinated Notes have a maturity date of September 1, 2018. The Subordinated Notes bear interest payable semi-annually, in arrears, on June 30 and December 30 of each year, at a fixed interest rate of 6.00% per year. The Company may, at its option, subject to regulatory approvals, redeem some or all of the Subordinated Notes at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the redeemed notes, plus any accrued but unpaid interest.

 

 
106

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 9.     Other Borrowings and Unused Lines of Credit (continued)

 

The Subordinated Notes are intended to qualify as Tier 2 capital of the Company for regulatory purposes. The Company used the net proceeds from the sale of the Units to further strengthen the capital positions of the Company and specifically RB&T.

 

Unused lines of credit of the subsidiary banks as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 are summarized as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Secured

  $ 26,791,107     $ 52,703,791  

Unsecured

    324,500,000       259,000,000  
    $ 351,291,107     $ 311,703,791  

 

The Company pledges the eligible portion of its municipal securities portfolio and select commercial and industrial and commercial real estate loans to the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago for borrowing at the Discount Window.

 

 
107

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 10.              Junior Subordinated Debentures

 

As part of the acquisition of Community National, the Company assumed two junior subordinated debentures detailed as follows:

 

The first debenture assumed was issued in September 2004 in the amount of $3,093,000, and provides that interest is payable quarterly with the interest rate adjusted to equal three-month LIBOR plus 2.17%. Principal is due September 20, 2034, but is callable at any time. The second debenture assumed was issued in March 2007 in the amount of $3,609,000, and provides that interest is payable quarterly with the interest rate adjusted to equal three-month LIBOR plus 1.75%. Principal is due March 15, 2037, but is callable at any time.

 

Junior subordinated debentures are summarized as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust II

  $ 12,372,000     $ 12,372,000  

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust III

    8,248,000       8,248,000  

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust IV

    5,155,000       5,155,000  

Note Payable to QCR Holdings Capital Trust V

    10,310,000       10,310,000  

Note Payable to Community National Trust II

    3,093,000       -  

Note Payable to Community National Trust III

    3,609,000       -  

Market Value Discount per ASC 805 (see Note 2)

    (2,497,170 )     -  
    $ 40,289,830     $ 36,085,000  

 

A schedule of the Company’s non-consolidated subsidiaries formed for the issuance of trust preferred securities including the amounts outstanding as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, is as follows:

 

Name

Date Issued

 

Amount Issued

 

Interest Rate

 

Interest Rate as of 12/31/2013

   

Interest Rate as of 12/31/2012

 
                                 

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust II

February 2004

  $ 12,372,000  

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

    3.10 %       3.21 %  

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust III

February 2004

    8,248,000  

2.85% over 3-month LIBOR

    3.10 %       3.21 %  

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust IV

May 2005

    5,155,000  

1.80% over 3-month LIBOR

    2.04 %       2.14 %  

QCR Holdings Statutory Trust V

February 2006

    10,310,000  

1.55% over 3-month LIBOR

    1.79 %       1.89 %  

Community National Statutory Trust II

September 2004

    3,093,000  

2.17% over 3-month LIBOR

    2.42 %       N/A    

Community National Statutory Trust III

March 2007

    3,609,000  

1.75% over 3-month LIBOR

    1.99 %       N/A    
      $ 42,787,000  

Weighted Average Rate

    2.51 %       2.68 %  

 

Securities issued by all of the trusts listed above mature 30 years from the date of issuance, but all are currently callable at par at anytime.

 

 
108

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 11.     Preferred Stock

 

Preferred stock is summarized as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Series E Non-Cumulative Convertible Perpetual Preferred Stock

  $ -     $ 25,000  

Series F Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    29,867       29,867  
    $ 29,867     $ 54,867  

 

Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock and Common Stock Warrant: On February 13, 2009, the Company issued 38,237 shares of Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (the “Series D Preferred Stock”) to the U.S. Department of the Treasury (the “Treasury”) for an aggregate purchase price of $38,237,000. The sale of Series D Preferred Stock was a result of the Company’s participation in the Treasury’s voluntary Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”). The Series D Preferred Stock qualified as Tier 1 capital and paid cumulative dividends at a rate of 5% per annum for the first five years, and 9% per annum thereafter. This sale also included the issuance of a warrant (“CPP Warrant”) that allowed Treasury to purchase up to 521,888 shares of the Company’s common stock at an exercise price of $10.99. The CPP Warrant had a ten-year term and was immediately exercisable upon its issuance, with an exercise price, subject to anti-dilution adjustments, equal to $10.99 per share of the Company’s common stock.

 

The proceeds received from the Treasury were allocated to the Series D Preferred Stock and the CPP Warrant based on relative fair value. The fair value of the Series D Preferred Stock was determined through a discounted future cash flows model using a discount rate of 12%. The fair value of the CPP Warrant was calculated using the Black-Scholes option pricing model, which includes assumptions regarding the Company’s dividend yield, stock price volatility, and the risk-free interest rate. The relative fair value of the Series D Preferred Stock and the CPP Warrant on February 13, 2009, the date of issuance, was $35.8 million and $2.4 million, respectively.

 

The Company calculated a discount on the Series D Preferred Stock in the amount of $2.4 million, which was being amortized over a 5 year period. The effective cost on the Series D Preferred Stock, including the accretion of the discount, was approximately 6.23%. In determining net income (loss) attributable to the Company’s common stockholders, the periodic accretion and the cash dividend on the preferred stock were subtracted from net income (loss) attributable to the Company.

 

 
109

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 11.     Preferred Stock (continued)

 

On September 15, 2011, the Company redeemed the 38,237 shares of Series D Preferred Stock simultaneously upon the issuance of the Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series F (the “Series F Preferred Stock”). See below for a detailed discussion of the issuance of Series F Preferred Stock. Upon redemption, accretion of the remaining discount, or $1,252,023, was recognized.

 

Separately, on November 16, 2011, the Company repurchased the CPP Warrant from the Treasury for an aggregate price of $1,100,000. Simultaneous with the repurchase, the Company cancelled the CPP Warrant.

 

Series E Non-Cumulative Convertible Perpetual Preferred Stock: On June 30, 2010, the Company closed a private placement offering resulting in the issuance of 25,000 shares of Series E Preferred Stock for an aggregate purchase price of $25,000,000, or $1,000 per share (the liquidation amount). The private placement was fully subscribed and involved the exchange of $20.9 million (gross amount before related issuance costs) of the Company’s previously outstanding Series B Preferred Stock and Series C Preferred Stock and $4.1 million (gross amount before related issuance costs) of new capital from cash investors. The Company’s previously outstanding Series B Preferred Stock and Series C Preferred Stock carried stated dividend rates of 8.00% and 9.50%, respectively. All of the outstanding shares of Series B and Series C Preferred Stock were exchanged for the newly issued shares of Series E Preferred Stock.

 

The Series E Preferred Stock carried a stated dividend rate of 7.00% and was perpetually convertible by the holder into shares of common stock at a per share conversion price of $12.15, subject to anti-dilution adjustments upon the occurrence of certain events. In addition, the Company could exercise a conversion option on or after the third anniversary of the issue date (June 30, 2013), at the same $12.15 conversion price if the Company’s common stock price equals or exceeds $17.22 for at least 20 trading days in a period of 30 consecutive trading days. The Series E Preferred Stock was not registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Act”), and was issued pursuant to an exemption from registration under Regulation D of the rules promulgated under the Act. The Series E Preferred Stock was intended to qualify as Tier 1 capital of the Company for regulatory purposes. The Company used the net proceeds from the issuance to further strengthen its capital and liquidity positions.

 

Pursuant to the terms of the Series E Preferred Stock, because the Company’s common stock price exceeded $17.22 for at least 20 trading days in a period of 30 consecutive trading days, the Company’s Board of Directors approved the conversion and the preferred shareholders were notified by mail on November 21, 2013. The conversion was effective December 23, 2013. Each share of the Series E Preferred Stock was converted into the number of shares of common stock that resulted from dividing $1,000 (the issuance price per share of the Series E Preferred Stock) by $12.15 (the conversion price per share). No fractional shares were issued as a result of the conversion of the Series E Preferred Stock. Instead, holders received cash totaling $1,915 which equaled the amount of fractional shares multiplied by $17.24 (the closing price of the Company’s common stock on December 20, 2013). As a result of the conversion, the Company issued 2,057,502 shares of common stock.

 

 
110

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 11.     Preferred Stock (continued)

 

Series F Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock: On September 15, 2011, the Company issued 40,090 shares of Series F Preferred Stock to the Treasury for an aggregate purchase price of $40,090,000. The sale of Series F Preferred Stock is the result of an investment by the Treasury from the Small Business Lending Fund (“SBLF”), a $30 billion fund established under the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010 that encourages lending to small businesses by providing capital to qualified community banks with assets of less than $10 billion. As a requirement of the SBLF, simultaneously, the Company redeemed the 38,327 shares of Series D Preferred Stock, at an aggregate price of $38,237,000, plus accrued and unpaid dividends to the date of redemption of $159,321.

 

The Series F Preferred Stock qualifies as Tier 1 capital of the Company. Non-cumulative dividends are payable quarterly on the Series F Preferred Stock, and the dividend rate is based on changes in the level of “Qualified Small Business Lending” or “QSBL” by the Company’s wholly owned bank subsidiaries, QCBT, CRBT and RB&T. Based upon the change in the banks’ level of QSBL over the baseline level (as defined by SBLF, the baseline is the average of QSBL for the last two quarters of 2009 and the first two quarters of 2010), the dividend rate for the initial dividend period, which was from the date of issuance through September 30, 2011, was set at 5%, and the dividend rate for the fourth quarter of 2011 has also been set at 5%. For the 2nd through 10th calendar quarters, the annual dividend rate may be adjusted to between 1% and 5%, to reflect the amount of change in the banks’ level of QSBL. For the 11th calendar quarter through 4.5 years after issuance, the dividend rate is fixed at between 1% and 5%, based upon the increase in QSBL from the baseline level to the level as of the end of the ninth dividend period (i.e., as of September 30, 2013), or will be fixed at 7% if there is no increase or there is a decrease in QSBL during such period. In addition, beginning on April 1, 2014 and ending on April 1, 2016, if there is no increase or there is a decrease in QSBL from the baseline level to the level as of the end of the ninth dividend period (i.e., as of September 30, 2013), because of the Company’s participation in the CPP, the Company will be subject to an additional lending incentive fee of 2% per year. After 4.5 years from issuance, the dividend rate will increase to 9%. As the Company did not increase the QSBL from the baseline level as of September 30, 2013, the Company’s dividend rate, including the additional 2% lending incentive fee, increased to 9% beginning with the dividend payment due on April 1, 2014.

 

In accordance with SBLF, the Company may pay dividends on all stock assuming Tier 1 capital levels remain at least 90% of the level existing upon the date of issuance, or September 15, 2011. This threshold is subject to reduction depending on increases in the Company’s QSBL.

 

The Series F Preferred Stock is nonvoting, other than for consent rights granted to the Treasury with respect to: (i) any authorization or issuance of shares ranking senior to the Series F Preferred Stock; (ii) any amendment to the rights of the Series F Preferred Stock; (iii) any merger, exchange, dissolution, or similar transaction that would affect the rights of the Series F Preferred Stock; and (iv) any sale of all, or any material portion of, the Company’s assets if in conjunction with such sale, the Series F Preferred Stock will not be redeemed in full.

 

If the Company misses five dividend payments, whether or not consecutive, the holder of the Series F Preferred Stock will have the right, but not the obligation, to appoint a representative as an observer on the Company’s Board of Directors. If the Company misses six dividend payments, whether or not consecutive, and if the then outstanding aggregate liquidation amount of the Series F Preferred Stock is at least $25,000,000, then the holder of the Series F Preferred Stock will have the right to designate two directors to the Board of Directors of the Company. The Company has not missed a dividend payment.

 

The Series F Preferred Stock was issued in a private placement exempt from registration pursuant to Section 4(2) of the Act.

 

On June 29, 2012, the Company redeemed 10,223 shares of Series F Preferred Stock from the Treasury for an aggregate redemption amount of $10,223,000 plus unpaid dividends to the date of redemption of $124,948. The remaining Series F Preferred Stock may be redeemed at any time at the option of the Company, subject to the approval of the Company’s primary federal banking regulator. All redemptions must be in amounts equal to at least the lesser of 25% of the number of originally issued shares, or 100% of the then-outstanding shares.

 

 
111

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 12.     Federal and State Income Taxes

 

Federal and state income tax expense was comprised of the following components for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Current

  $ 5,639,933     $ 2,232,183     $ 195,135  

Deferred

    (1,021,991 )     2,302,418       3,673,064  
    $ 4,617,942     $ 4,534,601     $ 3,868,199  

 

A reconciliation of the expected federal income tax expense to the income tax expense included in the consolidated statements of income was as follows for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

Years Ended December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

Amount

   

% of

Pretax

Income

   

Amount

   

% of

Pretax

Income

   

Amount

   

% of

Pretax

Income

 
                                                 

Computed "expected" tax expense

  $ 6,844,665       35.0   $ 6,174,295       35.0   $ 4,899,324       35.0

Effect of graduated tax rates interest

    (123,868 )     (0.6 )     (20,775 )     (0.1 )     (139,981 )     (1.0 )

Tax exempt income, net

    (1,790,049 )     (9.2 )     (1,243,660 )     (7.0 )     (692,742 )     (4.9 )

Bank-owned life insurance

    (624,847 )     (3.2 )     (544,292 )     (3.1 )     (490,491 )     (3.5 )

State income taxes, net of federal benefit, current year

    758,695       3.9       730,865       4.1       533,250       3.8  

Change in unrecognized tax benefits

    37,180       0.2       (149,183 )     (0.8 )     2,074       -  

Acquisition costs

    248,952       1.3       -       -       -       -  

Noncontrolling interests

    -       -       (166,081 )     (0.9 )     (148,995 )     (1.1 )

Other

    (732,786 )     (3.8 )     (246,568 )     (1.5 )     (94,240 )     (0.7 )
    $ 4,617,942       23.6   $ 4,534,601       25.7   $ 3,868,199       27.6

 

Changes in the unrecognized tax benefits included in other liabilities are as follows for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
                 

Balance, beginning

  $ 994,078     $ 1,148,549  

Impact of tax positions taken during current year

    288,016       202,341  

Gross increase related to tax positions of prior years

    16,939       21,781  

Reduction as a result of a lapse of the applicable statute of limitations

    (241,014 )     (378,593 )

Balance, ending

  $ 1,058,019     $ 994,078  

 

Included in the unrecognized tax benefits liability at December 31, 2013 are potential benefits of approximately $742,000 that, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate.

 

The liability for unrecognized tax benefits includes accrued interest for tax positions, which either do not meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold or where the tax benefit is measured at an amount less than the tax benefit claimed or expected to be claimed on an income tax return. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, accrued interest on uncertain tax positions was approximately $316,000 and $302,000, respectively. Estimated interest related to the underpayment of income taxes is classified as a component of “income taxes” in the statements of income.

 

 
112

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 12.     Federal and State Income Taxes (continued)

 

The Company’s federal income tax returns are open and subject to examination from the 2010 tax return year and forward. Various state franchise and income tax returns are generally open from the 2009 and later tax return years based on individual state statute of limitations.

 

The net deferred tax assets (liabilities) included with other assets on the consolidated balance sheets consisted of the following as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

   

2013

   

2012

 

Deferred tax assets:

               

Alternative minimum tax credits

  $ 3,936,226     $ 2,717,333  

New markets tax credits

    1,500,000       1,000,000  

Net unrealized losses on securities available for sale

    8,468,118       -  

Compensation

    7,056,579       5,748,551  

Loan/lease losses

    6,890,532       6,041,379  

Net operating loss carryforwards, federal and state

    2,914,140       897,910  

Deferred loan origination fees, net

    143,949       299,670  

Other

    410,640       469,673  
      31,320,184       17,174,516  

Deferred tax liabilities:

               

Net unrealized gains on securities available for sale

    -       2,905,784  

Premises and equipment

    1,575,582       1,601,682  

Equipment financing leases

    23,191,514       20,013,576  

Acquisition fair value adjustments

    1,319,981       -  

Investment accretion

    45,463       45,363  

Other

    551,080       367,440  
      26,683,620       24,933,845  

Net deferred tax asset (liability)

  $ 4,636,564     $ (7,759,329 )

 

At December 31, 2013, the Company had $6,949,939 of federal net operating loss carryforwards, of which $4,289,818 expires in 2029, $1,188,424 expires in 2030, $471,018 expires in 2031, $226,883 expires in 2032, and $773,797 expires in 2033. At December 31, 2013, the Company had $9,590,393 of state net operating loss carryforwards which are set to expire in varying amounts annually beginning in 2017 and ending in 2029.

 

The change in deferred income taxes was reflected in the consolidated financial statements as follows for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Provision for income taxes

  $ (1,021,991 )   $ 2,302,418     $ 3,673,064  

Statement of stockholders' equity- accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale, net

    (11,373,902 )     (35,008 )     2,510,006  
    $ (12,395,893 )   $ 2,267,410     $ 6,183,070  

 

 
113

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 13.     Employee Benefit Plans

 

The Company has a profit sharing plan which includes a provision designed to qualify under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, to allow for participant contributions. All employees are eligible to participate in the plan. The Company matches 100% of the first 3% of employee contributions, and 50% of the next 3% of employee contributions, up to a maximum amount of 4.5% of an employee's compensation. Additionally, at its discretion, the Company may make additional contributions to the plan which are allocated to the accounts of participants in the plan based on relative compensation. Company contributions for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 were as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Matching contribution

  $ 1,046,526     $ 1,014,418     $ 929,869  

Discretionary contribution

    186,000       188,700       150,000  
    $ 1,232,526     $ 1,203,118     $ 1,079,869  

 

The Company has entered into nonqualified supplemental executive retirement plans (“SERPs”) with certain executive officers. The SERPs allow certain executives to accumulate retirement benefits beyond those provided by the qualified plans. During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, the Company expensed $264,672, $289,437, and $190,105, respectively, related to these plans. As part of the acquisition of Community National, the Company assumed the liability related to a SERP for one CNB executive. The assumed SERP liability was $317,418 at acquisition. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the liability related to the SERPs, included in other liabilities, was $3,267,587 and $2,802,497, respectively. Payments in the amount of $117,000 were made in both 2013 and 2012.

 

The Company has entered into deferred compensation agreements with certain executive officers. Under the provisions of the agreements, the officers may defer compensation and the Company matches the deferral up to certain maximums. The Company’s matching contribution varies by officer and is a maximum of between $10,000 and $20,000 annually. Interest on the deferred amounts is earned at The Wall Street Journal’s prime rate subject to a minimum of 6% and a maximum of 12% with such limits differing by officer. The Company has also entered into deferred compensation agreements with certain management officers. Under the provisions of the agreements the officers may defer compensation and the Company matches the deferral up to certain maximums. The Company’s matching contribution differs by officer and is a maximum between 4% and 10% of officer’s compensation. Interest on the deferred amounts is earned at The Wall Street Journal’s prime rate plus one percentage point, and has a minimum of 4% and shall not exceed 8%. Upon retirement, the officer will receive the deferral balance in 180 equal monthly installments. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the liability related to the agreements totaled $6,224,368 and $5,151,630, respectively.

 

Changes in the deferred compensation agreements, included in other liabilities, are as follows for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Balance, beginning

  $ 5,151,630     $ 4,202,733     $ 3,469,525  

Company expense

    557,663       555,407       414,478  

Employee deferrals

    525,469       405,788       381,616  

Cash payments made

    (10,394 )     (12,298 )     (62,886 )

Balance, ending

  $ 6,224,368     $ 5,151,630     $ 4,202,733  

 

 
114

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 14.     Stock-Based Compensation

 

Stock-based compensation expense was reflected in the consolidated financial statements as follows for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Stock option and incentive plans

  $ 734,827     $ 798,929     $ 587,900  

Stock purchase plan

    57,452       50,831       58,519  

Stock appreciation rights

    -       -       49,988  
    $ 792,279     $ 849,760     $ 696,407  

 

Stock option and incentive plans:

 

The Company’s Board of Directors adopted in January 2008, and the stockholders approved in May 2008, the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2008 Equity Incentive Plan (“2008 Equity Incentive Plan”). Up to 250,000 shares of common stock may be issued to employees and directors of the Company and its subsidiaries pursuant to the exercise of nonqualified stock options and restricted stock granted under the 2008 Equity Incentive Plan. The Company’s Board of Directors adopted in February 2010, and the stockholders approved in May 2010, the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2010 Equity Incentive Plan (“2010 Equity Incentive Plan”). Up to 350,000 shares of common stock may be issued to employees and directors of the Company and its subsidiaries pursuant to the exercise of the nonqualified stock options and restricted stock granted under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan. The Company’s Board of Directors adopted in February 2013, and the stockholders approved in May 2013, the QCR Holdings, Inc. 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (“2013 Equity Incentive Plan”). Up to 350,000 shares of common stock may be issued to employees and directors of the Company and its subsidiaries pursuant to the exercise of nonqualified stock options and restricted stock granted under the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan. The 2008 Equity Incentive Plan, the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan, and the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (collectively, “the stock option plans”) are administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors (the “Committee”). As of December 31, 2013, there were 294,831 remaining options available for grant under the stock option plans.

 

The number and exercise price of options granted under the stock option plans is determined by the Committee at the time the option is granted. In no event can the exercise price be less than the value of the common stock at the date of the grant for incentive stock options. All options have a 10-year life and will vest and become exercisable from 1-to-5 years after the date of the grant. Only nonqualified stock options have been issued to date.

 

In the case of nonqualified stock options, the stock option plans provide for the granting of "Tax Benefit Rights" to certain participants at the same time as these participants are awarded nonqualified options. Each Tax Benefit Right entitles a participant to a cash payment, which is expensed by the Company, equal to the excess of the fair market value of a share of common stock on the exercise date over the exercise price of the related option multiplied by the difference between the rate of tax on ordinary income over the rate of tax on capital gains (federal and state).

 

 
115

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 14.     Stock-Based Compensation (continued)

 

A summary of the stock option plans as of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 and changes during the years then ended is presented below:

 

   

December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

Shares

   

Weighted

Average

Exercise

Price

   

Shares

   

Weighted

Average

Exercise

Price

   

Shares

   

Weighted

Average

Exercise

Price

 
                                                 

Outstanding, beginning

    608,852     $ 13.27       535,130     $ 13.85       510,612     $ 14.04  

Granted

    96,232       15.68       102,722       9.30       73,250       8.23  

Exercised

    (41,258 )     10.06       (17,876 )     9.68       (36,459 )     8.30  

Forfeited

    (1,320 )     10.53       (11,124 )     10.57       (12,273 )     8.28  

Outstanding, ending

    662,506       13.82       608,852       13.27       535,130       13.85  
                                                 

Exercisable, ending

    419,735               391,378               355,398          
                                                 

Weighted average fair value per option of options granted during the period

  $ 5.14             $ 2.79             $ 2.74          

 

A further summary of options outstanding as of December 31, 2013 is presented below:

 

       

Options Outstanding

                 
               

Weighted

           

Options Exercisable

 

Range of

Exercise Prices

 

Number

Outstanding

   

Average

Remaining

Contractual

Life

   

Weighted

Average

Exercise

Price

   

Number

Exercisable

   

Weighted

Average

Exercise

Price

 
                                             
$7.72

to

$8.93     58,510       6.91     $ 8.12       22,520     $ 8.21  
$9.00

to

$11.64     212,004       6.82       9.21       101,355       9.19  
$13.25

to

$16.85     243,567       5.90       15.85       149,435       15.99  
$17.00

to

$18.60     51,840       2.05       18.05       49,840       18.06  
$18.67

to

$20.90     67,885       1.16       19.48       67,885       19.48  
$21.00

to

$22.00     28,700       1.16       21.28       28,700       21.28  
          662,506                       419,735          

 

 
116

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 14.     Stock-Based Compensation (continued)

 

Stock purchase plan:

 

The Company’s Board of Directors and its stockholders adopted in October 2002 the QCR Holdings, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “Purchase Plan”). On May 2, 2012, the Company’s stockholders approved a complete amendment and restatement of the Purchase Plan. As of January 1, 2013, there were 254,851 shares of common stock available for issuance under the Purchase Plan. For each six-month offering period, the Board of Directors will determine how many of the total number of available shares will be offered. The purchase price is the lesser of 90% of the fair market value at the date of the grant or the investment date. The investment date, as established by the Board of Directors, is the date common stock is purchased after the end of each calendar quarter during an offering period. The maximum dollar amount any one participant can elect to contribute in an offering period is $7,500. Additionally, the maximum percentage that any one participant can elect to contribute is 8% of his or her compensation for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011. Information for the stock purchase plan for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 is presented below:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Shares granted

    27,415       29,671       34,860  

Shares purchased

    27,110       31,554       36,174  

Weighted average fair value per share granted

  $ 2.10     $ 1.71     $ 1.68  

 

Stock appreciation rights:

 

The 1997 Stock Incentive Plan and 2004 Stock Incentive Plan allowed the granting of stock appreciation rights (“SARs”). SARs are rights entitling the grantee to receive cash equal to the fair market value of the appreciation in the market value of a stated number of shares from the date of grant. Like options, the number and exercise price of SARs granted is determined by the Committee. The SARs vested 20% per year, and the term of the SARs was not to exceed 10 years from the date of the grant. As of December 31, 2011, all SARs have expired or been paid out; therefore, there was no further liability related to the SARs as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. The final payments totaled $67,326 and were made during the year ended December 31, 2011.  

 

 
117

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 15.     Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends

 

The Company (on a consolidated basis) and the subsidiary banks are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company and subsidiary banks’ financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company and the subsidiary banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of their assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors. Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the subsidiary banks to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of total and Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets and of Tier 1 capital to average assets, each as defined by regulation. Management believes, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, that the Company and the subsidiary banks met all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

 

Under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, to be categorized as “well capitalized,” an institution must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based and Tier 1 leverage ratios as set forth in the following tables. The Company and the subsidiary banks’ actual capital amounts and ratios as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 are also presented in the following table (dollars in thousands). As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the subsidiary banks met the requirements to be “well capitalized”.

 

   

Actual

   

For Capital

Adequacy Purposes

   

To Be Well

Capitalized Under

Prompt Corrective

Action Provisions

 
   

Amount

   

Ratio

   

Amount

    Ratio    

Amount

    Ratio  

As of December 31, 2013:

                                               

Company:

                                               

Total risk-based capital

  $ 217,011       12.87 %   $ 134,935     > 8.0 %     N/A       N/A  

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    193,044       11.45 %     67,468     > 4.0 %     N/A       N/A  

Tier 1 leverage

    193,044       7.96 %     97,029     > 4.0 %     N/A       N/A  

Quad City Bank & Trust:

                                               

Total risk-based capital

  $ 101,168       12.25 %   $ 66,049     > 8.0 %   $ 82,562     > 10.00 %

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    91,820       11.12 %     33,025     > 4.0       49,537     > 6.00 %

Tier 1 leverage

    91,820       7.13 %     51,527     > 4.0       64,408     > 5.00 %

Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust:

                                        >    

Total risk-based capital

  $ 74,912       12.54 %   $ 47,808     > 8.0 %   $ 59,760     > 10.00 %

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    67,432       11.28 %     23,904     > 4.0       35,856     > 6.00 %

Tier 1 leverage

    67,432       8.78 %     30,736     > 4.0       38,420     > 5.00 %

Rockford Bank & Trust:

                                          >    

Total risk-based capital

  $ 38,778       14.59 %   $ 21,263     > 8.0 %   $ 26,579     > 10.00 %

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    35,449       13.34 %     10,631     > 4.0       15,947     > 6.00 %

Tier 1 leverage

    35,449       10.54 %     13,459     > 4.0       16,824     > 5.00 %

 

 
118

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 15.     Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends (continued)

 

   

Actual

   

For Capital

Adequacy Purposes

   

To Be Well

Capitalized Under

Prompt Corrective

Action Provisions

 
   

Amount

   

Ratio

   

Amount

    Ratio    

Amount

    Ratio  

As of December 31, 2012:

                                               

Company:

                                               

Total risk-based capital

  $ 188,841       12.71 %   $ 118,878     > 8.0 %     N/A       N/A  

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    167,475       11.27 %     59,439     > 4.0 %     N/A       N/A  

Tier 1 leverage

    167,475       8.13 %     82,357     > 4.0 %     N/A       N/A  

Quad City Bank & Trust:

                                               

Total risk-based capital

  $ 98,789       12.12 %   $ 65,218     > 8.0 %   $ 81,522     > 10.00 %

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    90,533       11.11 %     32,609     > 4.0       48,913     > 6.00 %

Tier 1 leverage

    90,533       7.74 %     46,784     > 4.0       58,480     > 5.00 %

Cedar Rapids Bank & Trust:

                                               

Total risk-based capital

  $ 55,736       12.87 %   $ 34,652     > 8.0 %   $ 43,315     > 10.00 %

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    50,297       11.61 %     17,326     > 4.0       25,989     > 6.00 %

Tier 1 leverage

    50,297       8.49 %     23,685     > 4.0       29,606     > 5.00 %

Rockford Bank & Trust:

                                               

Total risk-based capital

  $ 36,894       15.33 %   $ 19,255     > 8.0 %   $ 24,609     > 10.00 %

Tier 1 risk-based capital

    33,870       14.07 %     9,628     > 4.0       14,441     > 6.00 %

Tier 1 leverage

    33,870       11.13 %     12,177     > 4.0       15,221     > 5.00 %

 

The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its stockholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies.

 

The payment of dividends by any financial institution or its holding company is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and a financial institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized. Notwithstanding the availability of funds for dividends, however, the Federal Reserve may prohibit the payment of any dividends by the subsidiary banks if the Federal Reserve determines such payment would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice.

 

The Company also has certain contractual restrictions on its ability to pay dividends. The Company has issued junior subordinated debentures in four private placements and assumed two issues of junior subordinated debentures in connection with the Community National acquisition (see Note 2). Under the terms of the debentures, the Company may be prohibited, under certain circumstances, from paying dividends on shares of its common stock. Additionally, the Company has issued shares of non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock and under the terms of this preferred stock, the Company may be prohibited, under certain circumstances, from paying dividends on shares of its common stock. None of these circumstances existed at December 31, 2013 or 2012.

 

 
119

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 15.     Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Dividends (continued)

 

In July 2013, the U.S. federal banking authorities approved the implementation of the Basel III regulatory capital reforms and issued rules effecting certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act (the “Basel III Rules”).  The Basel III Rules are applicable to all U.S. banks that are subject to minimum capital requirements, as well as to bank and savings and loan holding companies other than “small bank holding companies” (generally bank holding companies with consolidated assets of less than $500 million).  The Basel III Rules not only increase most of the required minimum regulatory capital ratios, but they introduce a new Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio and the concept of a capital conservation buffer.  The Basel III Rules also expand the definition of capital as in effect currently by establishing criteria that instruments must meet to be considered Additional Tier 1 Capital (Tier 1 Capital in addition to Common Equity) and Tier 2 Capital.  A number of instruments that now qualify as Tier 1 Capital will not qualify, or their qualifications will change.  The Basel III Rules also permit smaller banking organizations to retain, through a one-time election, the existing treatment for accumulated other comprehensive income, which currently does not affect regulatory capital.  The Basel III Rules have maintained the general structure of the current prompt corrective action framework, while incorporating the increased requirements. The prompt corrective action guidelines were also revised to add the Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio.  In order to be a “well-capitalized” depository institution under the new regime, a bank and holding company must maintain a Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio of 6.5% or more; a Tier 1 Capital ratio of 8% or more; a Total Capital ratio of 10% or more; and a leverage ratio of 5% or more.  Generally, financial institutions become subject to the new Basel III Rules on January 1, 2015.  Management is in the process of assessing the effect the Basel III Rules may have on the Company’s and the subsidiary banks’ capital positions and will monitor developments in this area. At present, management believes that its current capital structure and the execution of its existing capital plan will be more than sufficient to meet and exceed the revised regulatory capital ratios as required by the new Basel III Rules.

 

Note 16.     Earnings Per Common Share

 

The following information was used in the computation of basic and diluted earnings per common share for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 13,106,240     $ 10,129,869  

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    -       488,473       438,221  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

  $ 14,938,245     $ 12,617,767     $ 9,691,648  
                         

Less: Preferred stock dividends and discount accretion

    3,168,302       3,496,085       5,283,885

*

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

  $ 11,769,943     $ 9,121,682     $ 4,407,763  
                         

Earnings per common share attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc. common stockholders

                       

Basic

  $ 2.13     $ 1.88     $ 0.93  

Diluted

  $ 2.08     $ 1.85     $ 0.92  
                         

Weighted average common shares outstanding

    5,531,948       4,844,776       4,724,781  

Weighted average common shares issuable upon exercise of stock options and under the employee stock purchase plan **

    114,978       74,783       64,245  

Weighted average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

    5,646,926       4,919,559       4,789,026  

 

*For the year ended December 31, 2011, includes approximately $1.2 million of accelerated accretion of discount on the redemption of Series D Preferred Stock during the third quarter of 2011. See Note 11 for additional information.

**Excludes anti-dilutive shares of 116,324, 158,375, and 546,521 at December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

 

 
120

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 17.     Commitments and Contingencies

 

In the normal course of business, the subsidiary banks make various commitments and incur certain contingent liabilities that are not presented in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. The commitments and contingent liabilities include various guarantees, commitments to extend credit, and standby letters of credit.

 

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The subsidiary banks evaluate each customer's creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the subsidiary banks upon extension of credit, is based upon management's credit evaluation of the counterparty. Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, marketable securities, inventory, property, plant and equipment, and income-producing commercial properties.

 

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the subsidiary banks to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Those guarantees are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements and, generally, have terms of one year or less. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The subsidiary banks hold collateral, as described above, supporting those commitments if deemed necessary. In the event the customer does not perform in accordance with the terms of the agreement with the third party, the subsidiary banks would be required to fund the commitments. The maximum potential amount of future payments the subsidiary banks could be required to make is represented by the contractual amount. If the commitment is funded, the subsidiary banks would be entitled to seek recovery from the customer. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, no amounts had been recorded as liabilities for the subsidiary banks’ potential obligations under these guarantees.

 

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, commitments to extend credit aggregated $432,601,000 and $430,058,000, respectively. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, standby letters of credit aggregated $9,697,000 and $15,179,000, respectively. Management does not expect that all of these commitments will be funded.

 

The Company has also executed contracts for the sale of mortgage loans in the secondary market in the amount of $1,358,290 and $4,577,233 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. These amounts are included in loans held for sale at the respective balance sheet dates.

 

 
121

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 17.     Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

 

Residential mortgage loans sold to investors in the secondary market are sold with varying recourse provisions. Essentially, all loan sales agreements require the repurchase of a mortgage loan by the seller in situations such as, breach of representation, warranty, or covenant, untimely document delivery, false or misleading statements, failure to obtain certain certificates or insurance, unmarketability, etc. Certain loan sales agreements contain repurchase requirements based on payment-related defects that are defined in terms of the number of days/months since the purchase, the sequence number of the payment, and/or the number of days of payment delinquency. Based on the specific terms stated in the agreements of investors purchasing residential mortgage loans from the Company’s subsidiary banks, the Company had $16,151,133 and $38,846,068 of sold residential mortgage loans with recourse provisions still in effect at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The subsidiary banks did not repurchase any loans from secondary market investors under the terms of loans sales agreements during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011. In the opinion of management, the risk of recourse and the subsequent requirement of loan repurchase to the subsidiary banks is not significant, and accordingly no liabilities have been established related to such.

 

Aside from cash on-hand and in-vault, the majority of the Company's cash is maintained at upstream correspondent banks. The total amount of cash on deposit, certificates of deposit, and federal funds sold exceeded federal insured limits by approximately $54,163,895 and $30,020,230 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. In the opinion of management, no material risk of loss exists due to the financial condition of the upstream correspondent banks. In addition, some of the Company’s cash maintained at upstream correspondent banks is in non-interest bearing deposit accounts. In accordance with the FDIC’s Transaction Account Guarantee (“TAG”) Program, cash maintained in non-interest bearing deposit accounts was fully insured through December 31, 2012. As scheduled, the unlimited coverage for noninterest-bearing transaction accounts provided under the Dodd-Frank Act expired on December 31, 2012. Effective January 1, 2013, deposits held in noninterest-bearing transaction accounts are now aggregated with interest-bearing deposits the owner holds, and the combined total is insured up to $250,000.

 

In an arrangement with Goldman Sachs and Company (“Goldman Sachs”), certain subsidiary banks offer a cash management program for select customers. Based on a predetermined minimum balance, which must be maintained in the account, excess funds are automatically swept daily to an institutional money market fund administered by Goldman Sachs. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, the Company had $78,880,300 and $66,783,049, respectively of customer funds invested in this cash management program. In the opinion of management, no material risk of loss exists due to the financial condition of Goldman Sachs.

 

In April 2011, CNB was named as one of 36 co-defendants in a complaint alleging unjust enrichment relating to participation loans originated, sold and repaid in a fraudulent scheme perpetuated by a loan broker. At acquisition, CNB had not settled the claims and, using all available information, including the settlement amounts of many of the initial co-defendants who had already settled, CNB’s management recorded a contingent liability of $1,028,000 which was assumed by the Company upon acquisition of CNB. In December 2013, the Company settled the claim in the amount of $940,333.

 

 
122

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 18.     Quarterly Results of Operations (Unaudited)

 

   

Year Ended December 31, 2013

 
   

March

2013

   

June

2013

   

September

2013

   

December

2013

 
                                 

Total interest income

  $ 18,537,482     $ 20,139,401     $ 21,996,243     $ 21,198,832  

Total interest expense

    4,346,165       4,431,349       4,685,907       4,303,100  

Net interest income

    14,191,317       15,708,052       17,310,336       16,895,732  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    1,057,782       1,520,137       1,366,984       1,985,517  

Noninterest income

    5,204,029       6,948,756       5,934,653       7,726,390  

Noninterest expense

    13,958,500       15,234,349       17,027,268       18,212,541  

Income before taxes

    4,379,064       5,902,322       4,850,737       4,424,064  

Federal and state income tax expense

    1,113,920       1,857,091       1,038,793       608,138  

Net income and net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

  $ 3,265,144     $ 4,045,231     $ 3,811,944     $ 3,815,926  
                                 

Earnings per common share:

                               

Basic

  $ 0.50     $ 0.60     $ 0.52     $ 0.51  

Diluted

  $ 0.49     $ 0.59     $ 0.51     $ 0.50  

 

 

   

Year Ended December 31, 2012

 
   

March

2012

   

June

2012

   

September

2012

   

December

2012

 
                                 

Total interest income

  $ 19,373,804     $ 19,534,528     $ 19,487,525     $ 18,980,016  

Total interest expense

    5,170,351       5,019,035       4,858,007       4,679,220  

Net interest income

    14,203,453       14,515,493       14,629,518       14,300,796  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    780,446       1,048,469       1,496,194       1,045,658  

Noninterest income

    3,956,878       4,067,509       4,117,182       4,479,726  

Noninterest expense

    12,738,080       13,109,083       13,031,517       13,380,267  

Income before taxes

    4,641,805       4,425,450       4,218,989       4,354,597  

Federal and state income tax expense

    1,238,956       1,152,071       1,034,479       1,109,095  

Net income

  $ 3,402,849     $ 3,273,379     $ 3,184,510     $ 3,245,502  

Less net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    166,031       201,223       127,177       (5,958 )

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

  $ 3,236,818     $ 3,072,156     $ 3,057,333     $ 3,251,460  
                                 

Earnings per common share:

                               

Basic

  $ 0.48     $ 0.44     $ 0.45     $ 0.50  

Diluted

  $ 0.48     $ 0.44     $ 0.44     $ 0.49  

 

 
123

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 19.     Parent Company Only Financial Statements

 

The following is condensed financial information of QCR Holdings, Inc. (parent company only):

 

Condensed Balance Sheets

December 31, 2013 and 2012

 

   

2013

   

2012

 
Assets                
                 

Cash and due from banks

  $ 7,212,584     $ 1,072,434  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

    187,401       185,113  

Securities available for sale, at fair value

    1,644,663       1,406,876  

Investment in bank subsidiaries

    187,410,269       182,465,733  

Investment in nonbank subsidiaries

    1,396,632       1,202,791  

Premises and equipment, net

    3,243,575       3,318,757  

Other assets

    8,709,546       7,720,933  

Total assets

  $ 209,804,670     $ 197,372,637  
                 

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

               

Liabilities:

               

Other borrowings

  $ 14,104,323     $ 10,077,769  

Junior subordinated debentures

    40,289,830       36,085,000  

Other liabilities

    7,833,737       10,776,047  

Total liabilities

    62,227,890       56,938,816  
                 

Stockholders' Equity:

               

Preferred stock

    29,867       54,867  

Common stock

    8,005,708       5,039,448  

Additional paid-in capital

    90,154,528       78,912,791  

Retained earnings

    64,637,173       53,326,542  

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

    (13,643,986 )     4,706,683  

Treasury stock

    (1,606,510 )     (1,606,510 )

Total stockholders' equity

    147,576,780       140,433,821  

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 209,804,670     $ 197,372,637  

 

 
124

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 19.     Parent Company Only Financial Statements (continued)

 

Condensed Statements of Income

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
                         

Total interest income

  $ 43,476     $ 57,136     $ 62,521  

Equity in net income of bank subsidiaries

    20,499,070       17,206,086       14,449,843  

Equity in net income of nonbank subsidiaries

    31,540       168,934       174,058  

Bargain purchase gain on Community National acquisition

    1,841,385       -       -  

Other *

    7,942       657,733       129,773  

Total income

    22,423,413       18,089,889       14,816,195  
                         

Interest expense

    1,714,814       1,408,948       1,562,323  

Salaries and employee benefits

    4,765,762       4,717,609       4,078,474  

Professional fees

    977,571       988,306       1,103,910  

Acquisition and data conversion costs

    2,037,684       -       -  

Other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities

    -       62,400       118,847  

Other

    642,044       760,618       783,460  

Total expenses

    10,137,875       7,937,881       7,647,014  
                         

Income before income tax benefit

    12,285,538       10,152,008       7,169,181  
                         

Income tax benefit

    2,652,707       2,465,759       2,522,467  

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 12,617,767     $ 9,691,648  

 

*For the year ended December 31, 2012, includes pre-tax gain of approximately $580 thousand on the sale of a 2.25% equity interest in a company providing data processing services to merchant credit card acquiring businesses.

 

 
125

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 19.     Parent Company Only Financial Statements (continued)

 

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities:

                       

Net income

  $ 14,938,245     $ 12,617,767     $ 9,691,648  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

                       

Distributions in excess of (less than) earnings of:

                       

Bank subsidiaries

    5,500,930       (3,706,086 )     (4,449,843 )

Nonbank subsidiaries

    (103 )     (132,911 )     133,951  

Bargain purchase gain on Community National acquisition

    (1,841,385 )     -       -  

Accretion of acquisition fair value adjustments

    79,655       -       -  

Depreciation

    75,182       -       54  

Other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities

    -       62,400       118,847  

Stock-based compensation expense

    792,279       849,760       646,419  

Increase in other assets

    (725,105 )     (437,827 )     (65,205 )

(Decrease) increase in other liabilities

    (2,978,106 )     1,938,832       666,240  

Net cash provided by operating activities

    15,841,592       11,191,935       6,742,111  
                         

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:

                       

Net increase in interest-bearing deposits at financial instituions

    (2,288 )     (1,937 )     (1,227 )

Purchase of securities available for sale

    (34,040 )     (53,501 )     (58,149 )

Capital infusion, bank subsidiaries

    -       -       (1,693,679 )

Net cash paid for Community National acquisition

    (6,261,684 )     -       -  

Increase in cash from dissolution of VPHC

    -       99,645       -  

Net cash (used in) provided by' investing activities

    (6,298,012 )     44,207       (1,753,055 )
                         

Cash Flows from Financing Activities:

                       

Net (decrease) increase in other borrowings

    (373,446 )     -       -  

Proceeds from other borrowings term note

    10,000,000       -       -  

Advance (payment) on 364-day revolving note

    (5,600,000 )     2,000,000       1,100,000  

Repayment of Community National's other borrowings at acquisition

    (3,950,000 )     -       -  

Payment of cash dividends on common and preferred stock

    (4,062,726 )     (4,088,949 )     (3,712,493 )

Redemption of 10,223 shares of Series F Noncumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, net

    -       (10,223,000 )     -  

Proceeds from issuance of 40,090 shares of Series F Noncumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, net

    -       -       39,996,922  

Redemption of Series D Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, net

    -       -       (38,237,000 )

Repurchase of 521,888 shares of common stock warrants issued in conjunction with Series D

                       

Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock

    -       -       (1,100,000 )

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

    582,742       994,174       477,339  

Purchase of noncontrolling interests

    -       (2,388,417 )     -  

Net cash used in financing activities

    (3,403,430 )     (13,706,192 )     (1,475,232 )
                         

Net increase (decrease) in cash and due from banks

    6,140,150       (2,470,050 )     3,513,824  
                         

Cash and due from banks:

                       

Beginning

    1,072,434       3,542,484       28,660  

Ending

  $ 7,212,584     $ 1,072,434     $ 3,542,484  

 

 
126

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


 

Note 20.     Fair Value

 

Accounting guidance on fair value measurements uses a hierarchy intended to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. This hierarchy includes three levels and is based upon the valuation techniques used to measure assets and liabilities. The three levels are as follows:

 

 

Level 1 – Inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in markets;

 

Level 2 – Inputs to the valuation methodology include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets and inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly, for substantially the full term of the financial instrument; and

 

Level 3 – Inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable and significant to the fair value measurement

 

Assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis comprise the following at December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

           

Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using

 
   

Fair Value

   

Quoted Prices

in Active

Markets for

Identical Assets

(Level 1)

   

Significant

Other

Observable

Inputs

(Level 2)

   

Significant

Unobservable

Inputs

(Level 3)

 
                                 

December 31, 2013:

                               

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 356,472,987     $ -     $ 356,472,987     $ -  

Residential mortgage-backed securities

    157,429,451       -       157,429,451       -  

Municipal securities

    35,958,857       -       35,958,857       -  

Other securities

    1,897,163       317,698       1,579,465       -  
    $ 551,758,458     $ 317,698     $ 551,440,760     $ -  
                                 

December 31, 2012:

                               

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. govt. sponsored agency securities

  $ 338,609,371     $ -     $ 338,609,371     $ -  

Residential mortgage-backed securities

    163,601,103       -       163,601,103       -  

Municipal securities

    26,185,736       -       26,185,736       -  

Trust preferred securities

    139,400       -       139,400       -  

Other securities

    1,624,376       234,453       1,389,923       -  
    $ 530,159,986     $ 234,453     $ 529,925,533     $ -  

 

There were no transfers of assets or liabilities between Levels 1, 2, and 3 of the fair value hierarchy during the years ended December 31, 2013 or 2012.

 

A small portion of the securities available for sale portfolio consists of common stocks issued by various unrelated bank holding companies and mutual funds. The fair values used by the Company are obtained from an independent pricing service, which represent quoted market prices for the identical securities (Level 1 inputs).

 

 
127

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


 

Note 20.     Fair Value (continued)

 

The remainder of the securities available for sale portfolio consists of securities whereby the Company obtains fair values from an independent pricing service. The fair values are determined by pricing models that consider observable market data, such as interest rate volatilities, LIBOR yield curve, credit spreads and prices from market makers and live trading systems (Level 2 inputs).

 

Certain financial assets are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the assets are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).

 

Assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis comprise the following at December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

           

Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using

 
   

Fair Value

   

Quoted Prices

in Active

Markets for

Identical Assets

(Level 1)

   

Significant

Other

Observable

Inputs

(Level 2)

   

Significant

Unobservable

Inputs

(Level 3)

 

December 31, 2013:

                               

Impaired loans/leases

  $ 9,009,557     $ -     $ -     $ 9,009,557  

Other real estate owned

    10,507,377       -       -       10,507,377  
    $ 19,516,934     $ -     $ -     $ 19,516,934  
                                 

December 31, 2012:

                               

Impaired loans/leases

  $ 18,054,234     $ -     $ -     $ 18,054,234  

Other real estate owned

    4,270,901       -       -       4,270,901  
    $ 22,325,135     $ -     $ -     $ 22,325,135  

 

Impaired loans/leases are evaluated and valued at the time the loan/lease is identified as impaired, at the lower of cost or fair value and are classified as a Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.  Fair value is measured based on the value of the collateral securing these loans/leases.  Collateral may be real estate and/or business assets including equipment, inventory and/or accounts receivable and is determined based on appraisals by qualified licensed appraisers hired by the Company.  Appraised and reported values may be discounted based on management’s historical knowledge, changes in market conditions from the time of valuation, and/or management’s expertise and knowledge of the client and client’s business.  

 

Other real estate owned in the table above consists of property acquired through foreclosures and settlements of loans.  Property acquired is carried at the estimated fair value of the property, less disposal costs, and is classified as a Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.   The estimated fair value of the property is determined based on appraisals by qualified licensed appraisers hired by the Company.  Appraised and reported values are discounted based on management’s historical knowledge, changes in market conditions from the time of valuation, and/or management’s expertise and knowledge of the property.

 

 
128

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 20.     Fair Value (continued)

 

The following table presents additional quantitative information about assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis for which the Company has utilized Level 3 inputs to determine fair value:

   

Quantitave Information about Level Fair Value Measurments

 
   

Fair Value

 

Valuation Technique

Unobservable Input

 

Range

 
                       

December 31, 2013:

                     

Impaired loans/leases

  $ 9,009,557  

Appraisal of collateral

Appraisal adjustments

  -10.00% to -50.00%  

Other real estate owned

    10,507,377  

Appraisal of collateral

Appraisal adjustments

  0.00% to -35.00%  

 

 

   

Quantitave Information about Level Fair Value Measurments

 
   

Fair Value

 

Valuation Technique

Unobservable Input

 

Range

 
                       

December 31, 2012:

                     

Impaired loans/leases

  $ 18,054,234  

Appraisal of collateral

Appraisal adjustments

  -10.00% to -50.00%  

Other real estate owned

    4,270,901  

Appraisal of collateral

Appraisal adjustments

  0.00% to -35.00%  

 

For impaired loans/leases and other real estate owned, the Company records carrying value at fair value less disposal or selling costs. The amounts reported in the tables above are fair values before the adjustment for disposal or selling costs.

 

There have been no changes in valuation techniques used for any assets measured at fair value during the years ended December 31, 2013 or 2012.

 

The following table presents the carrying values and estimated fair values of financial assets and liabilities carried on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets, including those financial assets and liabilities that are not measured and reported at fair value on a recurring basis or non-recurring basis:

 

 

Fair Value

 

As of December 31, 2013

   

As of December 31, 2012

 
 

Heirarchy

Level

 

Carrying

Value

   

Estimated

Fair Value

   

Carrying

Value

   

Estimated

Fair Value

 
                                   

Cash and due from banks

Level 1

  $ 41,950,790     $ 41,950,790     $ 61,568,446     $ 61,568,446  

Federal funds sold

Level 2

    39,435,000       39,435,000       26,560,000       26,560,000  

Interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions

Level 2

    33,044,917       33,044,917       22,359,490       22,359,490  

Investment securities:

                                 

Held to maturity

Level 3

    145,451,895       138,640,105       72,079,385       73,005,706  

Available for sale

See Previous Table

    551,758,458       551,758,458       530,159,986       530,159,986  

Loans/leases receivable, net

Level 3

    8,342,182       9,009,557       16,716,883       18,054,234  

Loans/leases receivable, net

Level 2

    1,430,489,328       1,441,952,443       1,250,745,552       1,262,090,766  

Deposits:

                                 

Nonmaturity deposits

Level 2

    1,256,209,352       1,256,209,352       1,039,572,326       1,039,572,326  

Time deposits

Level 2

    390,781,891       394,202,000       334,541,774       337,343,000  

Short-term borrowings

Level 2

    149,292,967       149,292,967       171,082,961       171,082,961  

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

Level 2

    231,350,000       241,623,000       202,350,000       220,815,000  

Other borrowings

Level 2

    142,448,362       152,761,000       138,239,762       154,101,000  

Junior subordinated debentures

Level 2

    40,289,830       28,094,228       36,085,000       18,786,000  

 

 
129

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


  

Note 20.     Fair Value (continued)

 

The methodologies for estimating the fair value of financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring or non-recurring basis are discussed above. For certain financial assets and liabilities, carrying value approximates fair value due to the nature of the financial instrument. These instruments include: cash and due from banks, federal funds sold, interest-bearing deposits at financial institutions, non-maturity deposits, and short-term borrowings. The Company used the following methods and assumptions in estimating the fair value of the following instruments:

 

Securities held to maturity: The fair values are estimated using pricing models that consider certain observable market data, however, as most of the securities have limited or no trading activity and are not rated, the fair value is partially dependent upon unobservable inputs.

 

Loans/leases receivable: The fair values for all types of loans/leases are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans/leases with similar terms to borrowers with similar credit quality. The fair value of loans held for sale is based on quoted market prices of similar loans sold in the secondary market.

 

Deposits: The fair values disclosed for demand deposits equal their carrying amounts, which represent the amount payable on demand. Fair values for time deposits are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on time deposits to a schedule of aggregate expected monthly maturities on time deposits.

 

FHLB advances and junior subordinated debentures: The fair value of these instruments is estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, based on the Company's current incremental borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements.

 

Other borrowings: The fair value for the wholesale repurchase agreements and fixed rate other borrowings is estimated using rates currently available for debt with similar terms and remaining maturities. The fair value for variable rate other borrowings is equal to its carrying value.

 

Commitments to extend credit: The fair value of these commitments is not material.

 

 

Note 21.     Business Segment Information

 

Selected financial and descriptive information is required to be disclosed for reportable operating segments, applying a “management perspective” as the basis for identifying reportable segments. The management perspective is determined by the view that management takes of the segments within the Company when making operating decisions, allocating resources, and measuring performance. The segments of QCR Holdings, Inc. have been defined by the structure of the Company’s internal organization, focusing on the financial information that the Company’s operating decision-makers routinely use to make decisions about operating matters.

 

The Company’s primary segment, Commercial Banking, is geographically divided by markets into the secondary segments which are the three subsidiary banks wholly-owned by the Company: QCBT, CRBT, and RB&T. CRBT includes CNB’s operations from acquisition date (May 13, 2013) to December 31, 2013. Each of these secondary segments offer similar products and services, but are managed separately due to different pricing, product demand, and consumer markets. Each offers commercial, consumer, and mortgage loans and deposit services.

 

The Company’s Wealth Management segment represents trust and asset management and investment management and advisory services offered at the Company’s three subsidiary banks in aggregate. This segment generates income primarily from fees charged based on assets under administration for corporate and personal trusts, custodial services, and investments managed. No assets of the subsidiary banks have been allocated to the Wealth Management segment.

 

 
130

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


 

Note 21.     Business Segment Information (continued)

 

The Company’s All Other segment includes the operations of all other consolidated subsidiaries and/or defined operating segments that fall below the segment reporting thresholds. This segment includes the corporate operations of the parent and VPHC, which was dissolved and liquidated effective December 31, 2012.

 

Selected financial information on the Company's business segments, with all intercompany accounts and transactions eliminated, is presented as follows as of and for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

Commercial Banking

                                 
   

Quad City

Bank & Trust

   

Cedar Rapids

Bank & Trust

   

Rockford

Bank & Trust

   

Wealth

Management

   

All other

   

Intercompany

Eliminations

   

Consolidated

Total

 
                                                         

Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2013

                                                       

Total revenue

  $ 48,742,635     $ 36,089,448     $ 13,809,593     $ 7,521,821     $ 1,924,329     $ (402,040 )   $ 107,685,786  

Net interest income

    33,892,035       22,239,329       9,645,411       -       (1,671,338 )     -       64,105,437  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

    9,310,779       7,953,230       1,855,672       1,379,402       (5,560,838 )     -       14,938,245  

Total assets

    1,245,128,136       804,223,453       339,375,139       -       22,394,401       (16,168,205 )     2,394,952,924  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    3,391,406       1,531,014       1,008,000       -       -       -       5,930,420  

Goodwill

    3,222,688       -       -       -       -       -       3,222,688  

Core deposit intangible

    -       1,870,433       -       -       -       -       1,870,433  
                                                         

Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2012

                                                       

Total revenue

  $ 47,984,123     $ 26,697,921     $ 12,955,951     $ 5,993,437     $ 745,682     $ (379,946 )   $ 93,997,168  

Net interest income

    33,770,092       15,717,038       9,630,481       -       (1,468,351 )     -       57,649,260  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

    9,915,267       5,786,446       857,610       646,762       (4,577,566 )     (10,752 )     12,617,767  

Total assets

    1,177,294,502       625,713,218       313,824,607       -       14,906,904       (38,008,739 )     2,093,730,492  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    1,527,767       1,275,000       1,568,000       -       -       -       4,370,767  

Goodwill

    3,222,688       -       -       -       -       -       3,222,688  
                                                         

Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2011

                                                       

Total revenue

  $ 47,952,867     $ 28,406,789     $ 13,518,534     $ 5,477,913     $ 228,900     $ (399,877 )   $ 95,185,126  

Net interest income

    30,831,946       15,856,555       9,085,293       -       (1,628,938 )     -       54,144,856  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

    8,176,665       5,154,769       329,251       789,159       (4,733,869 )     (24,327 )     9,691,648  

Total assets

    1,113,435,783       560,076,246       294,382,640       -       14,826,484       (16,111,099 )     1,966,610,054  

Provision for loan/lease losses

    2,735,014       1,655,000       2,226,000       -       -       -       6,616,014  

Goodwill

    3,222,688       -       -       -       -       -       3,222,688  

 

 

Note 22.     Acquisition of 20% Noncontrolling Interest in m2 Lease Funds

 

On August 27, 2012, the Company’s largest subsidiary bank, QCBT, entered into an amendment to the operating agreement of m2 and purchased the remaining 20% noncontrolling interest in m2 for $4,501,442. The purchase price and related acquisition costs exceeded the book value by $2,133,417. This excess is reflected as a reduction in additional paid in capital. The acquisition is structured in two payments with the initial payment of $1,653,755 made on September 11, 2012 and the final payment of $3,307,509 due in September 2015. QCBT calculated the present value of this future payment using a discount rate of 5% and recorded a resulting liability of $2,847,687. QCBT is accreting the discount of $459,822 using the effective yield method over the three year period to the final payment date. Accretion totaled $148,137 and $47,758 for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The liability related to the final payment due totals $3,043,582 and $2,895,445 at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

In conjunction with the purchase agreement, the Company also entered into an agreement with the Chief Executive Officer and former 20% owner of m2, whereby he will be provided additional consideration equal to 20% of the earnings of m2 for the period from September 2012 through the earlier of August 2015 or his separation from service. The payment under this arrangement will also be due in September 2015. Because the payment is contingent upon future service, QCBT is accruing the liability and related compensation expense over the service period. Expense totaled $725,483 and $195,715 for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The liability related to this future payment totaled $921,198 and $195,715 at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

 
131

 

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiaries

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 


 

Note 23.     Sale of Credit Card Loan Receivables and Credit Card Issuing Operations for QCBT

 

On January 31, 2013, QCBT entered into an agreement to sell its credit card loan receivables totaling $10,179,318. This transaction closed on February 15, 2013 and resulted in a pre-tax gain of $495,405. As part of the agreement, QCBT also agreed to sell its credit card issuing operations to the purchaser. The gain recognized on this transaction was $355,268. QCBT incurred pre-tax expenses related to these transactions of $257,476, resulting in a net pre-tax gain on the transactions of $593,197.

 

 
132 

 

 

 

 

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

 

None.

 

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

 

Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures. An evaluation was performed under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) promulgated under the Exchange Act) as of December 31, 2013. Based on that evaluation, the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports filed and submitted under the Exchange Act was recorded, processed, summarized and reported as and when required.

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act). Internal control over financial reporting includes controls and procedures designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions of the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error and the circumvention of overriding controls. Accordingly, even effective internal control can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. Further, because of changes in conditions, the effectiveness of internal control may vary over time.

 

The Company’s management has excluded the entities Community National Bancorporation and its banking subsidiary Community National Bank from its assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, because they were acquired by the Company in a purchase business combination in the second quarter of 2013.

 

The Company’s management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013. Management’s assessment is based on the criteria established in the Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in 1992 and was designed to provide reasonable assurance that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013. Based on this assessment, management believes that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013.

 

McGladrey LLP, the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm has issued an attestation report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, which is included on the following pages of this Form 10-K.

 

 
133

 

 

 

 
134

 

 

 
135

 

 

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. During 2005, the Company underwent a comprehensive effort to ensure compliance with the requirements under Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Continuing enhancements to the Company’s control environment were made during 2013 as part of the Company’s ongoing efforts to improve internal control over financial reporting. There have been no significant changes to the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the period covered by this report that have materially effected, or are reasonably likely to affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Item 9B. Other Information

 

None.

 

Part III

 

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

 

The information required by this item is set forth under the captions “Proposal 1: Election of Directors,” “Corporate Governance and the Board of Directors” and “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Company’s 2014 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 11. Executive Compensation

 

The information required by this item is set forth under the captions “Executive Compensation” and “Director Compensation” in the Company’s 2014 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

 

The information required by this item is set forth under the caption “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners” in the Company’s 2014 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

 

The table below sets forth the following information as of December 31, 2013 for (i) all compensation plans previously approved by the Company’s stockholders and (ii) all compensation plans not previously approved by the Company’s stockholders:

 

 

(a)

The number of securities to be issued upon the exercise of outstanding options, warrants, and rights;

 

(b)

The weighted-average exercise price of such outstanding options, warrants, and rights; and

 

(c)

Other than securities to be issued upon the exercise of such outstanding options, warrants, and rights, the number of securities remaining available for future issuance under the plans.

 

 

EQUITY COMPENSATION PLAN INFORMATION

   
 

Plan category

Number of securities to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options, warrants, and rights

Weighted-average exercise price of outstanding options, warrants, and rights

Number of securities remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plans (excluding securities reflected in column (a))

   
   

(a)

(b)

(c)

   
             
 

Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders

                                            668,728

$13.82

                                            549,682

(1)

 
             
 

Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders

                                                      -

-

                                                      -

   
             
 

Total

                                            668,728

$13.82

                                            549,682

(1)

 
             

 

(1) Includes 254,851 shares available under the QCR Holdings, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

 

 
136

 

 

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

 

The information required by this item is set forth under the captions “Corporate Governance and the Board of Directors” and “Transactions with Management and Directors” in the Company’s 2014 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services

 

The information required by this item is set forth under the caption “Proposal 4: Ratification of Selection of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Company’s 2014 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

 

 

Part IV

 

Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

 

(a) 1. Financial Statements

 

These documents are listed in the Index to Consolidated Financial Statements under Item 8.

 

(a) 2. Financial Statement Schedules

 

Financial statement schedules are omitted, as they are not required or are not applicable, or the required information is shown in the consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto.

 

(a) 3. Exhibits

 

The following exhibits are either filed as a part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K or are incorporated herein by reference:

 

Exhibit Number

 

Exhibit Description

     

3.1

 

Certificate of Incorporation of QCR Holdings, Inc., as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q/A Amendment No. 1 for the period ended September 30, 2011).

 

 

 

3.2

Bylaws of QCR Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated May 18, 2010).

 

 

 

4.1

 

Amended and Restated Rights Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Quad City Bank and Trust Company dated May 8, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of Registrant’s Form 8-K filed May 8, 2013)

     
4.2  

Certain instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of the Company, none of which authorize a total amount of indebtedness in excess of 10% of the total assets of the Company and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, have not been filed as exhibits. The Company hereby agrees to furnish a copy of any of these agreements to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request.

   

 

10.1

 

Employment Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc., Quad City Bank and Trust Company and Douglas M. Hultquist dated January 1, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003).

 

 
137

 

 

10.2

 

Employment Agreement between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company and Larry J. Helling dated January 1, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003).

   

 

10.3

 

Employment Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd A. Gipple dated January 1, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 of Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003).

   

 

10.4

 

QCR Holdings, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Registrant’s Form S-8, file No. 333-101356 dated November 20, 2002).

   

 

10.5

 

Dividend Reinvestment Plan of QCR Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of Registrant’s Form S-3D, File No. 333-102699 dated January 24, 2003).

   

 

10.6

 

Lease Agreement between Quad City Bank and Trust Company and 127 North Wyman Development, L.L.C. dated November 3, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2004).

   

 

10.7

 

Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement between Quad City Bank and Trust Company and John Engelbrecht dated August 26, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2005).

   

 

10.8

 

First Amendment to the Employment Agreement among QCR Holdings, Inc., Quad City Bank and Trust Company and Douglas M. Hultquist dated December 27, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.9

 

First Amendment to the Employment Agreement between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Companyand Larry J. Helling dated December 30, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

 

 
138

 

 

10.10

 

First Amendment to the Employment Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd A. Gipple dated December 30, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.11

 

Executive Deferred Compensation Plan of QCR Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.12

 

Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement among QCR Holdings, Inc., Quad City Bank and Trust Company and Douglas M. Hultquist dated October 24, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.13

 

Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company and Larry J. Helling dated October 24, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.14

 

Executive Deferred Compensation Plan Participation Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd A. Gipple dated October 24, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.15

 

Amended and Restated Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan of QCR Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.16

 

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement among QCR Holdings, Inc., Quad City Bank and Trust Company and Douglas M. Hultquist dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.17

 

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement between Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company and Larry J. Helling dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.18

 

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement between QCR Holdings, Inc. and Todd A. Gipple dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.19

 

Non-Qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Joinder Agreement among QCR Holdings, Inc., Quad City Bank and Trust Company and Michael A. Bauer dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008).

   

 

10.20

 

Amended and Restated Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A dated March 21, 2012).

 

 
139

 

 

10.21

 

Amendment No. 1 to the Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement between Quad City Bank and Trust Company and John Engelbrecht, dated August 26, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2012).

 

 

 

10.22

 

Agreement and Plan of Merger among QCR Holdings, Inc., QCR Acquisition, LLC and Community National Bancorporation, dated February 13, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated February 14, 2013).

     
10.23   QCR Holdings, Inc. 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the Registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A dated March 20, 2013).

 

 

 

21.1

 

Subsidiaries of QCR Holdings, Inc. (exhibit is being filed herewith).

 

 

 

23.1

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm — McGladrey LLP (exhibit is being filed herewith).

 

 

 

31.1

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) (exhibit is being filed herewith).

   

 

31.2

 

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) (exhibit is being filed herewith).

   

 

32.1

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (exhibit is being filed herewith).

   

 

32.2

 

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (exhibit is being filed herewith).

   

 

101

 

Interactive Data File

 

Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012; (ii) Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2013, December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011; (iii) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2013, December 31, 2012, and December 31, 2011; (iv) Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2013, December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011; (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2013, December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011; and (vi) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

 
140

 

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

 

QCR HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

Dated:  March 10, 2014

By:

/s/ Douglas M. Hultquist 

 

 

 

Douglas M. Hultquist

 

 

 

President and Chief Executive Officer    

 

 

 

 

 

Dated:  March 10, 2014

By:

/s/ Todd A. Gipple 

 

 

 

Todd A. Gipple

 

 

 

Executive Vice President, Chief Operating Officer, and

 

 

 

        Chief Financial Officer

 

       
Dated: March 10, 2014 By: /s/ John R. Oakes  
    John R. Oake  
    1st Vice President, Controller and Director of Financial  
   

        Reporting

 

       

 
141

 

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

 

Title

                 Date

  

 

  

  

/s/ James J. Brownson

 

Chairman of the Board of Directors

March 10, 2014

James J. Brownson

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Douglas M. Hultquist

 

President, Chief Executive

March 10, 2014

Douglas M. Hultquist

 

Officer and Director

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Pat S. Baird

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Pat S. Baird

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Lindsay Y. Corby

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Lindsay Y. Corby

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Todd A. Gipple

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Todd A. Gipple

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Larry J. Helling

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Larry J. Helling

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Mark C. Kilmer

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Mark C. Kilmer

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ John K. Lawson

 

Director

March 10, 2014

John K. Lawson

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Linda K. Neuman   Director March 10, 2014
Linda K. Neuman      
       
/s/ Michael L. Peterson   Director March 10, 2014
Michael L. Peterson      
       

/s/ Ronald G. Peterson

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Ronald G. Peterson

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Donna J. Sorensen, J.D.

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Donna J. Sorensen, J.D.

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ John D. Whitcher

 

Director

March 10, 2014

John D. Whitcher

 

  

  

  

 

  

  

/s/ Marie Z. Ziegler

 

Director

March 10, 2014

Marie Z. Ziegler

 

  

  

 

 
142

 

 

Appendix A          

 

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

 

General

 

Financial institutions, their holding companies and their affiliates are extensively regulated under federal and state law. As a result, the growth and earnings performance of the Company may be affected not only by management decisions and general economic conditions, but also by the requirements of federal and state statutes and by the regulations and policies of various bank regulatory agencies, including the Iowa Superintendent of Banking (the “Iowa Superintendent”), the Illinois Department of Financial and Professional Regulation (the “DFPR”), the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) and the recently-created Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection (the “CFPB”). Furthermore, taxation laws administered by the Internal Revenue Service and state taxing authorities, accounting rules developed by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) and securities laws administered by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and state securities authorities have an impact on the business of the Company. The effect of these statutes, regulations, regulatory policies and accounting rules are significant to the operations and results of the Company and its subsidiary Banks, and the nature and extent of future legislative, regulatory or other changes affecting financial institutions are impossible to predict with any certainty.

 

Federal and state banking laws impose a comprehensive system of supervision, regulation and enforcement on the operations of financial institutions, their holding companies and affiliates that is intended primarily for the protection of the FDIC-insured deposits and depositors of banks, rather than stockholders. These federal and state laws, and the regulations of the bank regulatory agencies issued under them, affect, among other things, the scope of business, the kinds and amounts of investments banks may make, reserve requirements, capital levels relative to operations, the nature and amount of collateral for loans, the establishment of branches, the ability to merge, consolidate and acquire, dealings with insiders and affiliates and the payment of dividends. Moreover, turmoil in the credit markets in recent years prompted the enactment of unprecedented legislation that has allowed the U.S. Department of the Treasury (the “Treasury”) to make equity capital available to qualifying financial institutions to help restore confidence and stability in the U.S. financial markets, which imposes additional requirements on institutions in which the Treasury has an investment.

 

This supervisory and regulatory framework subjects banks and bank holding companies to regular examination by their respective regulatory agencies, which results in examination reports and ratings that are not publicly available and that can impact the conduct and growth of their business. These examinations consider not only compliance with applicable laws and regulations, but also capital levels, asset quality and risk, management ability and performance, earnings, liquidity, and various other factors. The regulatory agencies generally have broad discretion to impose restrictions and limitations on the operations of a regulated entity where the agencies determine, among other things, that such operations are unsafe or unsound, fail to comply with applicable law or are otherwise inconsistent with laws and regulations or with the supervisory policies of these agencies.  

 

The following is a summary of the material elements of the supervisory and regulatory framework applicable to the Company and its subsidiaries. It does not describe all of the statutes, regulations and regulatory policies that apply, nor does it restate all of the requirements of those that are described. The descriptions are qualified in their entirety by reference to the particular statutory and regulatory provision.

 

 

 

 

Financial Regulatory Reform

 

On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) into law. The Dodd-Frank Act represents a sweeping reform of the U.S. supervisory and regulatory framework applicable to financial institutions and capital markets in the wake of the global financial crisis, certain aspects of which are described below in more detail. In particular, and among other things, the Dodd-Frank Act: created a Financial Stability Oversight Council as part of a regulatory structure for identifying emerging systemic risks and improving interagency cooperation; created the CFPB, which is authorized to regulate providers of consumer credit, savings, payment and other consumer financial products and services; narrowed the scope of federal preemption of state consumer laws enjoyed by national banks and federal savings associations and expanded the authority of state attorneys general to bring actions to enforce federal consumer protection legislation; imposed more stringent capital requirements on bank holding companies and subjected certain activities, including interstate mergers and acquisitions, to heightened capital conditions; with respect to mortgage lending, (i) significantly expanded requirements applicable to loans secured by 1-4 family residential real property, (ii) imposed strict rules on mortgage servicing, and (iii) required the originator of a securitized loan, or the sponsor of a securitization, to retain at least 5% of the credit risk of securitized exposures unless the underlying exposures are qualified residential mortgages or meet certain underwriting standards; repealed the prohibition on the payment of interest on business checking accounts; restricted the interchange fees payable on debit card transactions for issuers with $10 billion in assets or greater; in the so-called “Volcker Rule,” subject to numerous exceptions, prohibited depository institutions and affiliates from certain investments in, and sponsorship of, hedge funds and private equity funds and from engaging in proprietary trading; provided for enhanced regulation of advisers to private funds and of the derivatives markets; enhanced oversight of credit rating agencies; and prohibited banking agency requirements tied to credit ratings. These statutory changes shifted the regulatory framework for financial institutions, impacted the way in which they do business and have the potential to constrain revenues.

 

Numerous provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are required to be implemented through rulemaking by the appropriate federal regulatory agencies. Many of the required regulations have been issued and others have been released for public comment, but there remain a number that have yet to be released in any form. Furthermore, while the reforms primarily target systemically important financial service providers, their influence is expected to filter down in varying degrees to smaller institutions over time. Management of the Company and its three subsidiary banks (the “Banks”) will continue to evaluate the effect of the Dodd-Frank Act changes; however, in many respects, the ultimate impact of the Dodd-Frank Act will not be fully known for years, and no current assurance may be given that the Dodd-Frank Act, or any other new legislative changes, will not have a negative impact on the results of operations and financial condition of the Company and its subsidiaries.

 

The Increasing Regulatory Emphasis on Capital

 

Regulatory capital represents the net assets of a financial institution available to absorb losses. Because of the risks attendant to their business, depository institutions are generally required to hold more capital than other businesses, which directly affects earnings capabilities. While capital has historically been one of the key measures of the financial health of both bank holding companies and banks, its role is becoming fundamentally more important in the wake of the global financial crisis, as the banking regulators recognized that the amount and quality of capital held by banks prior to the crisis was insufficient to absorb losses during periods of severe stress. Certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act and Basel III, discussed below, establish strengthened capital standards for banks and bank holding companies, require more capital to be held in the form of common stock and disallow certain funds from being included in capital determinations. Once fully implemented, these standards will represent regulatory capital requirements that are meaningfully more stringent than those in place currently and historically.

 

 
2

 

 

Company and Bank Required Capital Levels. Bank holding companies have historically had to comply with less stringent capital standards than their bank subsidiaries and were able to raise capital with hybrid instruments such as trust preferred securities. The Dodd-Frank Act mandated the Federal Reserve to establish minimum capital levels for bank holding companies on a consolidated basis that are as stringent as those required for insured depository institutions. As a consequence, the components of holding company permanent capital known as “Tier 1 Capital” are being restricted to capital instruments that are considered to be Tier 1 Capital for insured depository institutions. A result of this change is that the proceeds of hybrid instruments, such as trust preferred securities, are being excluded from Tier 1 Capital unless such securities were issued prior to May 19, 2010 by bank holding companies with less than $15 billion of assets, subject to certain restrictions. Because the Company has assets of less than $15 billion, it is able to maintain its trust preferred proceeds, subject to certain restrictions, as Tier 1 Capital but will have to comply with new capital mandates in other respects and will not be able to raise Tier 1 Capital in the future through the issuance of trust preferred securities.

 

Under current federal regulations, each Bank is subject to the following minimum capital standards:

 

 

A leverage requirement, consisting of a minimum ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total adjusted book assets of 3% for the most highly-rated banks with a minimum requirement of at least 4% for all others, and

 

 

A risk-based capital requirement, consisting of a minimum ratio of Total Capital to total risk-weighted assets of 8% and a minimum ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total risk-weighted assets of 4%.

 

 

For this purpose, “Tier 1 Capital” consists primarily of common stock, noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus less intangible assets (other than certain loan servicing rights and purchased credit card relationships). Total Capital consists primarily of Tier 1 Capital plus “Tier 2 Capital,” which includes other non-permanent capital items, such as certain other debt and equity instruments that do not qualify as Tier 1 Capital, and a portion of each Bank’s allowance for loan and lease losses.

 

 

Further, risk-weighted assets for the purposes of the risk-weighted ratio calculations are balance sheet assets and off-balance sheet exposures to which required risk weightings of 0% to 100% are applied.  

 

The capital standards described above are minimum requirements and will be increased under Basel III, as discussed below. Bank regulatory agencies are uniformly encouraging banks and bank holding companies to be “well-capitalized” and, to that end, federal law and regulations provide various incentives for banking organizations to maintain regulatory capital at levels in excess of minimum regulatory requirements. For example, a banking organization that is “well-capitalized” may: (i) qualify for exemptions from prior notice or application requirements otherwise applicable to certain types of activities; (ii) qualify for expedited processing of other required notices or applications; and (iii) accept brokered deposits. Under the capital regulations of the Federal Reserve, in order to be “well-capitalized,” a banking organization, under current federal regulations, must maintain:

 

 

A leverage ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total assets of 5% or greater,

 

 

A ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total risk-weighted assets of 6% or greater, and

 

 

A ratio of Total Capital to total risk-weighted assets of 10% or greater.

 

The Federal Reserve guidelines also provide that banks and bank holding companies experiencing internal growth or making acquisitions will be expected to maintain capital positions substantially above the minimum supervisory levels without significant reliance on intangible assets. Furthermore, the guidelines indicate that the agencies will continue to consider a “tangible Tier 1 leverage ratio” (deducting all intangibles) in evaluating proposals for expansion or to engage in new activities.

 

 
3

 

 

Higher capital levels may also be required if warranted by the particular circumstances or risk profiles of individual banking organizations. For example, the Federal Reserve’s capital guidelines contemplate that additional capital may be required to take adequate account of, among other things, interest rate risk, or the risks posed by concentrations of credit, nontraditional activities or securities trading activities. Further, any banking organization experiencing or anticipating significant growth would be expected to maintain capital ratios, including tangible capital positions (i.e., Tier 1 Capital less all intangible assets), well above the minimum levels.

 

Prompt Corrective Action. A banking organization’s capital plays an important role in connection with regulatory enforcement as well. Federal law provides the federal banking regulators with broad power to take prompt corrective action to resolve the problems of undercapitalized institutions. The extent of the regulators’ powers depends on whether the institution in question is “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” or “critically undercapitalized,” in each case as defined by regulation. Depending upon the capital category to which an institution is assigned, the regulators’ corrective powers include: (i) requiring the institution to submit a capital restoration plan; (ii) limiting the institution’s asset growth and restricting its activities; (iii) requiring the institution to issue additional capital stock (including additional voting stock) or to sell itself; (iv) restricting transactions between the institution and its affiliates; (v) restricting the interest rate that the institution may pay on deposits; (vi) ordering a new election of directors of the institution; (vii) requiring that senior executive officers or directors be dismissed; (viii) prohibiting the institution from accepting deposits from correspondent banks; (ix) requiring the institution to divest certain subsidiaries; (x) prohibiting the payment of principal or interest on subordinated debt; and (xi) ultimately, appointing a receiver for the institution.

 

As of December 31, 2013: (i) none of the Banks was subject to a directive from the Federal Reserve to increase its capital to an amount in excess of the minimum regulatory capital requirements; and (ii) each Bank was “well-capitalized,” as defined by Federal Reserve regulations. As of December 31, 2013, the Company had regulatory capital in excess of the Federal Reserve’s requirements and met the Dodd-Frank Act requirements.

 

The Basel International Capital Accords. The current risk-based capital guidelines described above, which apply to each Bank and are being phased in for the Company, are based upon the 1988 capital accord known as “Basel I” adopted by the international Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, a committee of central banks and bank supervisors, as implemented by the U.S. federal banking regulators on an interagency basis. In 2008, the banking agencies collaboratively began to phase-in capital standards based on a second capital accord, referred to as “Basel II,” for large or “core” international banks (generally defined for United States’ purposes as having total assets of $250 billion or more, or consolidated foreign exposures of $10 billion or more). Basel II emphasized internal assessment of credit, market and operational risk, as well as supervisory assessment and market discipline in determining minimum capital requirements.

 

On September 12, 2010, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, announced agreement on a strengthened set of capital requirements for banking organizations around the world, known as Basel III, to address deficiencies recognized in connection with the global financial crisis.  Basel III was intended to be effective globally on January 1, 2013, with phase-in of certain elements continuing until January 1, 2019, and it is currently effective in many countries.

 

U.S. Implementation of Basel III. After an extended rulemaking process that included a prolonged comment period, in July 2013, the U.S. federal banking agencies approved the implementation of the Basel III regulatory capital reforms in pertinent part, and, at the same time, promulgated rules effecting certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act (the “Basel III Rule”). In contrast to capital requirements historically, which were in the form of guidelines, Basel III was released in the form of regulations by each of the agencies. The Basel III Rule is applicable to all U.S. banks that are subject to minimum capital requirements, including federal and state banks and savings and loan associations, as well as to bank and savings and loan holding companies other than “small bank holding companies” (generally bank holding companies with consolidated assets of less than $500 million).

 

 
4

 

 

The Basel III Rule not only increases most of the required minimum capital ratios, but it introduces the concept of Common Equity Tier 1 Capital, which consists primarily of common stock, related surplus (net of Treasury stock), retained earnings, and Common Equity Tier 1 minority interests subject to certain regulatory adjustments. The Basel III Rule also expanded the definition of capital as in effect currently by establishing more stringent criteria that instruments must meet to be considered Additional Tier 1 Capital (Tier 1 Capital in addition to Common Equity) and Tier 2 Capital. A number of instruments that now qualify as Tier 1 Capital will not qualify, or their qualifications will change. For example, cumulative preferred stock and certain hybrid capital instruments, including trust preferred securities, will no longer qualify as Tier 1 Capital of any kind, with the exception, subject to certain restrictions, of such instruments issued before May 10, 2010, by bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of less than $15 billion as of December 31, 2009. For those institutions, trust preferred securities and other nonqualifying capital instruments currently included in consolidated Tier 1 Capital are permanently grandfathered under the Basel III Rule, subject to certain restrictions. Noncumulative perpetual preferred stock, which now qualifies as simple Tier 1 Capital, will not qualify as Common Equity Tier 1 Capital, but will qualify as Additional Tier 1 Capital. The Basel III Rule also constrains the inclusion of minority interests, mortgage-servicing assets, and deferred tax assets in capital and requires deductions from Common Equity Tier 1 Capital in the event such assets exceed a certain percentage of a bank’s Common Equity Tier 1 Capital.

 

The Basel III Rule requires:

 

 

A new required ratio of minimum Common Equity Tier 1 equal to 4.5% of risk-weighted assets;

 

 

An increase in the minimum required amount of Tier 1 Capital from the current level of 4% of total assets to 6% of risk-weighted assets;

 

 

A continuation of the current minimum required amount of Total Capital (Tier 1 plus Tier 2) at 8% of risk-weighted assets; and

 

 

A minimum leverage ratio of Tier 1 Capital to total assets equal to 4% in all circumstances.

 

In addition, institutions that seek the freedom to make capital distributions (including for dividends and repurchases of stock) and pay discretionary bonuses to executive officers without restriction must also maintain 2.5% in Common Equity Tier 1 attributable to a capital conservation buffer to be phased in over three years beginning in 2016. The purpose of the conservation buffer is to ensure that banks maintain a buffer of capital that can be used to absorb losses during periods of financial and economic stress. Factoring in the fully phased-in conservation buffer increases the minimum ratios depicted above to 7% for Common Equity Tier 1, 8.5% for Tier 1 Capital and 10.5% for Total Capital.

 

The Basel III Rule maintained the general structure of the current prompt corrective action framework, while incorporating the increased requirements. The prompt corrective action guidelines were also revised to add the Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio. In order to be a “well-capitalized” depository institution under the new regime, a bank and holding company must maintain a Common Equity Tier 1 Capital ratio of 6.5% or more; a Tier 1 Capital ratio of 8% or more; a Total Capital ratio of 10% or more; and a leverage ratio of 5% or more. It is possible under the Basel III Rule to be well-capitalized while remaining out of compliance with the capital conservation buffer discussed above.

 

The Basel III Rule revises a number of the risk weightings (or their methodologies) for bank assets that are used to determine the capital ratios. For nearly every class of assets, the Basel III Rule requires a more complex, detailed and calibrated assessment of credit risk and calculation of risk weightings. While Basel III would have changed the risk weighting for residential mortgage loans based on loan-to-value ratios and certain product and underwriting characteristics, there was concern in the U.S. that the proposed methodology for risk weighting residential mortgage exposures and the higher risk weightings for certain types of mortgage products would increase costs to consumers and reduce their access to mortgage credit. As a result, the Basel III Rule did not effect this change, and banks will continue to apply a risk weight of 50% or 100% to their exposure from residential mortgages, with the risk weighting depending on, among other things, whether the mortgage was a prudently underwritten first lien mortgage.

 

 
5

 

 

Furthermore, there was significant concern noted by the financial industry in connection with the Basel III rulemaking as to the proposed treatment of accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”). Basel III requires unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities to flow through to regulatory capital as opposed to the current treatment, which neutralizes such effects. Recognizing the problem for community banks, the U.S. bank regulatory agencies adopted the Basel III Rule with a one-time election for smaller institutions like the Company and the Banks to opt out of including most elements of AOCI in regulatory capital. This opt-out, which must be made in the first quarter of 2015, would exclude from regulatory capital both unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale debt securities and accumulated net gains and losses on cash-flow hedges and amounts attributable to defined benefit post-retirement plans. The Company fully intends to elect the opt-out.

 

Generally, financial institutions (except for large, internationally active financial institutions) become subject to the new rules on January 1, 2015. However, there will be separate phase-in/phase-out periods for: (i) the capital conservation buffer; (ii) regulatory capital adjustments and deductions; (iii) nonqualifying capital instruments; and (iv) changes to the prompt corrective action rules. The phase-in periods commence on January 1, 2016 and extend until 2019.

 

The Company

 

General. The Company, as the sole stockholder of the Banks, is a bank holding company. As a bank holding company, the Company is registered with, and is subject to regulation by, the Federal Reserve under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHCA”). In accordance with Federal Reserve policy, and as now codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company is legally obligated to act as a source of financial strength to the Banks and to commit resources to support the Banks in circumstances where the Company might not otherwise do so. Under the BHCA, the Company is subject to periodic examination by the Federal Reserve. The Company is required to file with the Federal Reserve periodic reports of the Company’s operations and such additional information regarding the Company and its subsidiaries as the Federal Reserve may require.

 

Acquisitions, Activities and Change in Control. The primary purpose of a bank holding company is to control and manage banks. The BHCA generally requires the prior approval of the Federal Reserve for any merger involving a bank holding company or any acquisition by a bank holding company of another bank or bank holding company. Subject to certain conditions (including deposit concentration limits established by the BHCA and the Dodd-Frank Act), the Federal Reserve may allow a bank holding company to acquire banks located in any state of the U.S. In approving interstate acquisitions, the Federal Reserve is required to give effect to applicable state law limitations on the aggregate amount of deposits that may be held by the acquiring bank holding company and its insured depository institution affiliates in the state in which the target bank is located (provided that those limits do not discriminate against out-of-state depository institutions or their holding companies) and state laws that require that the target bank have been in existence for a minimum period of time (not to exceed five years) before being acquired by an out-of-state bank holding company. Furthermore, in accordance with the Dodd-Frank Act, bank holding companies must be well-capitalized and well-managed in order to effect interstate mergers or acquisitions. For a discussion of the capital requirements, see “The Increasing Regulatory Emphasis on Capital” above.

 

 
6

 

 

The BHCA generally prohibits the Company from acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any company that is not a bank and from engaging in any business other than that of banking, managing and controlling banks or furnishing services to banks and their subsidiaries. This general prohibition is subject to a number of exceptions. The principal exception allows bank holding companies to engage in, and to own shares of companies engaged in, certain businesses found by the Federal Reserve prior to November 11, 1999 to be “so closely related to banking ... as to be a proper incident thereto.” This authority would permit the Company to engage in a variety of banking-related businesses, including the ownership and operation of a savings association, or any entity engaged in consumer finance, equipment leasing, the operation of a computer service bureau (including software development) and mortgage banking and brokerage. The BHCA generally does not place territorial restrictions on the domestic activities of non-bank subsidiaries of bank holding companies.

 

Additionally, bank holding companies that meet certain eligibility requirements prescribed by the BHCA and elect to operate as financial holding companies may engage in, or own shares in companies engaged in, a wider range of nonbanking activities, including securities and insurance underwriting and sales, merchant banking and any other activity that the Federal Reserve, in consultation with the Secretary of the Treasury, determines by regulation or order is financial in nature or incidental to any such financial activity or that the Federal Reserve determines by order to be complementary to any such financial activity and does not pose a substantial risk to the safety or soundness of depository institutions or the financial system generally. The Company does not currently operate as a financial holding company.

 

Federal law also prohibits any person or company from acquiring “control” of an FDIC-insured depository institution or its holding company without prior notice to the appropriate federal bank regulator. “Control” is conclusively presumed to exist upon the acquisition of 25% or more of the outstanding voting securities of a bank or bank holding company, but may arise under certain circumstances between 10% and 24.99% ownership.

 

Capital Requirements. Bank holding companies are required to maintain capital in accordance with Federal Reserve capital adequacy requirements, as affected by the Dodd-Frank Act and Basel III. For a discussion of capital requirements, see “—The Increasing Regulatory Emphasis on Capital” above.

 

U.S. Government Investment in Bank Holding Companies. Events in the U.S. and global financial markets leading up to the global financial crisis, including deterioration of the worldwide credit markets, created significant challenges for financial institutions throughout the country beginning in 2008. In response to this crisis affecting the U.S. banking system and financial markets, on October 3, 2008, the U.S. Congress passed, and the President signed into law, the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (the “EESA”). The EESA authorized the Secretary of the Treasury to implement various temporary emergency programs designed to strengthen the capital positions of financial institutions and stimulate the availability of credit within the U.S. financial system. Financial institutions participating in certain of the programs established under the EESA are required to adopt the Treasury’s standards for executive compensation and corporate governance.

 

On October 14, 2008, the Treasury announced that it would provide Tier 1 capital (in the form of perpetual preferred stock) to eligible financial institutions. This program, known as the TARP Capital Purchase Program (the “CPP”), allocated $250 billion from the $700 billion authorized by the EESA to the Treasury for the purchase of senior preferred shares from qualifying financial institutions (the “CPP Preferred Stock”). Under the program, eligible institutions were able to sell equity interests to the Treasury in amounts equal to between 1% and 3% of the institution’s risk-weighted assets. In conjunction with the purchase of the CPP Preferred Stock, the Treasury received warrants to purchase common stock from the participating public institutions with an aggregate market price equal to 15% of the preferred stock investment. Participating financial institutions were required to adopt the Treasury’s standards for executive compensation and corporate governance for the period during which the Treasury holds equity issued under the CPP.

 

 
7

 

 

Pursuant to the CPP, on February 13, 2009, the Company entered into a Letter Agreement with the Treasury, pursuant to which the Company issued (i) 38,237 shares of its Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series D (the “Series D Preferred Stock”) and (ii) a warrant to purchase 521,888 shares of the Company’s common stock for an aggregate purchase price of $38.237 million in cash.

 

Small Business Lending Fund and CPP Redemption. Under the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010, the Treasury established a Small Business Lending Fund (the “SBLF”), a $30 billion fund that encourages lending to small businesses by providing capital to qualified community banks with assets of less than $10 billion. The Company applied for the SBLF program, was accepted, and on September 15, 2011, entered into a Securities Purchase Agreement (the “Purchase Agreement”) with the Treasury, pursuant to which it issued and sold to the Treasury 40,090 shares of its Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series F (the “Series F Preferred Stock”), having a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share (the “Liquidation Amount”), for aggregate proceeds of $40,090,000. On the same date, the Company redeemed from the Treasury, using the proceeds from the issuance of the Series F Preferred Stock, all 38,237 outstanding shares of its Series D Preferred Stock issued under the CPP, for a redemption price of approximately $38.4 million, including accrued but unpaid dividends to the date of redemption. The Treasury remitted a cash payment to the Company in the amount of approximately $1.7 million to cover the difference between the outstanding balance of the Series D Preferred Stock and the proceeds from the issuance of the Series F Preferred Stock. As a result of its redemption of the Series D Preferred Stock, the Company is no longer subject to the limits on executive compensation and other restrictions stipulated under the CPP. The Company also repurchased the warrant issued to the Treasury in November of 2011 for an aggregate purchase price of $1.1 million.

 

On June 29, 2012, the Company redeemed 10,223 shares of the Series F Preferred Stock from the Treasury for an aggregate redemption amount of $10,223,000 plus unpaid dividends to the date of redemption of $124,948.  The remaining Series F Preferred Stock may be redeemed at any time at the option of the Company, subject to the approval of the Company’s primary federal banking regulator.  All redemptions must be in amounts equal to at least 25% of the number of originally issued shares, or 100% of the then-outstanding shares (if less than 25% of the originally issued shares).

 

Dividend Payments. The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its stockholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies. As a Delaware corporation, the Company is subject to the limitations of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “DGCL”), which allow the Company to pay dividends only out of its surplus (as defined and computed in accordance with the provisions of the DGCL) or if the Company has no such surplus, out of its net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend is declared and/or the preceding fiscal year.

 

As a general matter, the Federal Reserve has indicated that the board of directors of a bank holding company should eliminate, defer or significantly reduce dividends to stockholders if: (i) the company’s net income available to stockholders for the past four quarters, net of dividends previously paid during that period, is not sufficient to fully fund the dividends; (ii) the prospective rate of earnings retention is inconsistent with the company’s capital needs and overall current and prospective financial condition; or (iii) the company will not meet, or is in danger of not meeting, its minimum regulatory capital adequacy ratios. The Federal Reserve also possesses enforcement powers over bank holding companies and their non-bank subsidiaries to prevent or remedy actions that represent unsafe or unsound practices or violations of applicable statutes and regulations. Among these powers is the ability to proscribe the payment of dividends by banks and bank holding companies.

 

 
8

 

 

The terms of the Series F Preferred Stock issued in connection with the SBLF impose limits on the Company’s ability to pay dividends on and repurchase shares of its common stock and other securities. In general, the Company may declare and pay dividends on its common stock or any other stock junior to the Series F Preferred Stock, or repurchase shares of any such stock, only, if after payment of such dividends or repurchase of such shares, the Company’s Tier 1 Capital would be at least 90% of the Signing Date Tier 1 Capital (as defined and set forth in the Certificate of Designation), excluding any subsequent net charge-offs and any redemption of the Series F Preferred Stock (the “Tier 1 Dividend Threshold”). The Tier 1 Dividend Threshold is subject to reduction, beginning on the 2nd anniversary and ending on the 10th anniversary of issuance of the Series F Preferred Stock, by 10% for each one 1% increase in the Banks’ QSBL over the baseline level. If, however, the Company fails to declare and pay dividends on the Series F Preferred Stock in a given quarter, then during such quarter and for the next three quarters following such missed dividend payment the Company may not pay dividends on or repurchase any common stock or any other securities that are junior to (or in parity with) the Series F Preferred Stock, except in very limited circumstances. If any Series F Preferred Stock remains outstanding on the 10th anniversary of issuance, the Company may not pay any further dividends on its common stock or any other junior stock until the Series F Preferred Stock is redeemed in full.

 

Federal Securities Regulation. The Company’s common stock is registered with the SEC under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”). Consequently, the Company is subject to the information, proxy solicitation, insider trading and other restrictions and requirements of the SEC under the Exchange Act.

 

Corporate Governance. The Dodd-Frank Act addresses many investor protection, corporate governance and executive compensation matters that will affect most U.S. publicly traded companies. The Dodd-Frank Act will increase stockholder influence over boards of directors by requiring companies to give stockholders a non-binding vote on executive compensation and so-called “golden parachute” payments, and authorizing the SEC to promulgate rules that would allow stockholders to nominate and solicit voters for their own candidates using a company’s proxy materials. The legislation also directs the Federal Reserve to promulgate rules prohibiting excessive compensation paid to executives of bank holding companies, regardless of whether such companies are publicly traded.

 

The Banks

 

General. The Company owns three subsidiary banks: Quad City Bank and Trust Company (“QCBT”) and Cedar Rapids Bank and Trust Company are chartered under Iowa law (collectively, the “Iowa Banks”) and Rockford Bank and Trust Company (“RB&T”) is chartered under Illinois law. The deposit accounts of the Banks are insured by the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”) to the maximum extent provided under federal law and FDIC regulations. The Banks are also members of the Federal Reserve System (“member banks”).

 

As Iowa-chartered, FDIC-insured member banks, the Iowa Banks are subject to the examination, supervision, reporting and enforcement requirements of the Iowa Superintendent, as the chartering authority for Iowa banks. As an Illinois-chartered, FDIC-insured member bank, RB&T is subject to the examination, supervision, reporting and enforcement requirements of the DFPR, as the chartering authority for Illinois banks. The Banks are also subject to the examination, reporting and enforcement requirements of the Federal Reserve, as the primary federal regulator of member banks. In addition, the FDIC, as administrator of the DIF, has regulatory authority over the Banks.

 

Deposit Insurance. As FDIC-insured institutions, the Banks are each required to pay deposit insurance premium assessments to the FDIC.  The FDIC has adopted a risk-based assessment system whereby FDIC-insured depository institutions pay insurance premiums at rates based on their risk classification.  An institution’s risk classification is assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to the regulators.  

 

 
9

 

 

On November 12, 2009, the FDIC adopted a final rule that required insured depository institutions to prepay on December 30, 2009, their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and for all of 2010, 2011, and 2012. As such, on December 31, 2009, each Bank prepaid its assessments based on its actual September 30, 2009 assessment base, adjusted quarterly by an estimated 5% annual growth rate through the end of 2012. The FDIC also used the institution’s total base assessment rate in effect on September 30, 2009, increasing it by an annualized three basis points beginning in 2011. The FDIC began to offset prepaid assessments on March 30, 2010, representing payment of the regular quarterly risk-based deposit insurance assessment for the fourth quarter of 2009. Any prepaid assessment not exhausted after collection of the amount due on June 30, 2013, was returned to the institution and normal quarterly payments resumed.

 

Amendments to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act also revise the assessment base against which an insured depository institution’s deposit insurance premiums paid to the DIF will be calculated.  Under the amendments, the assessment base will no longer be the institution’s deposit base, but rather its average consolidated total assets less its average tangible equity.  This may shift the burden of deposit insurance premiums toward those large depository institutions that rely on funding sources other than U.S. deposits.  Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act makes changes to the minimum designated reserve ratio of the DIF, increasing the minimum from 1.15% to 1.35% of the estimated amount of total insured deposits, and eliminating the requirement that the FDIC pay dividends to depository institutions when the reserve ratio exceeds certain thresholds.  The FDIC has until September 3, 2020 to meet the 1.35% reserve ratio target. Several of these provisions could increase each Bank’s FDIC deposit insurance premiums. 

 

The Dodd-Frank Act permanently increases the maximum amount of deposit insurance for banks, savings institutions and credit unions to $250,000 per insured depositor, retroactive to January 1, 2009. Although the legislation provided that non-interest-bearing transaction accounts had unlimited deposit insurance coverage, that program expired on December 31, 2012.

 

FICO Assessments.   The Financing Corporation (“FICO”) is a mixed-ownership governmental corporation chartered by the former Federal Home Loan Bank Board pursuant to the Competitive Equality Banking Act of 1987 to function as a financing vehicle for the recapitalization of the former Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation. FICO issued 30-year noncallable bonds of approximately $8.1 billion that mature in 2017 through 2019. FICO’s authority to issue bonds ended on December 12, 1991. Since 1996, federal legislation has required that all FDIC-insured depository institutions pay assessments to cover interest payments on FICO’s outstanding obligations. These FICO assessments are in addition to amounts assessed by the FDIC for deposit insurance. The FICO assessment rate is adjusted quarterly and for the fourth quarter of 2013 was approximately 0.0064%.

 

Supervisory Assessments. Each of the Banks is required to pay supervisory assessments to its respective state banking regulator to fund the operations of that agency. The amount of the assessment payable by each Bank is calculated on the basis of that Bank’s total assets. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Iowa Banks paid supervisory assessments to the Iowa Superintendent totaling $172,264 and RB&T paid supervisory assessments to the DFPR totaling $48,831.

 

Capital Requirements. Banks are generally required to maintain capital levels in excess of other businesses. For a discussion of capital requirements, see “—The Increasing Regulatory Emphasis on Capital” above.

 

Liability of Commonly Controlled Institutions. Under federal law, institutions insured by the FDIC may be liable for any loss incurred by, or reasonably expected to be incurred by, the FDIC in connection with the default of commonly controlled FDIC-insured depository institutions or any assistance provided by the FDIC to commonly controlled FDIC-insured depository institutions in danger of default. Because the Company controls each of the Banks, the Banks are commonly-controlled for purposes of these provisions of federal law.

 

 
10

 

 

Dividend Payments. The primary source of funds for the Company is dividends from the Banks. In general, the Banks may only pay dividends either out of their historical net income after any required transfers to surplus or reserves have been made or out of their retained earnings. The Federal Reserve Act also imposes limitations on the amount of dividends that may be paid by state member banks, such as the Banks. Without prior Federal Reserve approval, a state member bank may not pay dividends in any calendar year that, in the aggregate, exceed the bank’s calendar year-to-date net income plus the bank’s retained net income for the two preceding calendar years.

 

The payment of dividends by any financial institution is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and a financial institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized. As described above, each of the Banks exceeded its minimum capital requirements under applicable guidelines as of December 31, 2013. As of December 31, 2013, approximately $10,209,000 was available to be paid as dividends by the Banks. Notwithstanding the availability of funds for dividends, however, the Federal Reserve, DFPR and Iowa Superintendent may prohibit the payment of dividends by one of the Banks if it determines such payment would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice.

 

Insider Transactions. The Banks are subject to certain restrictions imposed by federal law on “covered transactions” between each Bank and its “affiliates.” The Company is an affiliate of the Banks for purposes of these restrictions, and covered transactions subject to the restrictions include extensions of credit to the Company, investments in the stock or other securities of the Company and the acceptance of the stock or other securities of the Company as collateral for loans made by any of the Banks. The Dodd-Frank Act enhances the requirements for certain transactions with affiliates as of July 21, 2011, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must be maintained.

 

Certain limitations and reporting requirements are also placed on extensions of credit by each Bank to its directors and officers, to directors and officers of the Company and its subsidiaries, to principal stockholders of the Company and to “related interests” of such directors, officers and principal stockholders. In addition, federal law and regulations may affect the terms upon which any person who is a director or officer of the Company or the Banks, or a principal stockholder of the Company, may obtain credit from banks with which the Banks maintains a correspondent relationship.

 

Safety and Soundness Standards/Risk Management. The federal banking agencies have adopted guidelines that establish operational and managerial standards to promote the safety and soundness of federally insured depository institutions. The guidelines set forth standards for internal controls, information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation, fees and benefits, asset quality and earnings.

 

In general, the safety and soundness guidelines prescribe the goals to be achieved in each area, and each institution is responsible for establishing its own procedures to achieve those goals. If an institution fails to comply with any of the standards set forth in the guidelines, the institution’s primary federal regulator may require the institution to submit a plan for achieving and maintaining compliance. If an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan, or fails in any material respect to implement a compliance plan that has been accepted by its primary federal regulator, the regulator is required to issue an order directing the institution to cure the deficiency. Until the deficiency cited in the regulator’s order is cured, the regulator may restrict the institution’s rate of growth, require the institution to increase its capital, restrict the rates the institution pays on deposits or require the institution to take any action the regulator deems appropriate under the circumstances. Noncompliance with the standards established by the safety and soundness guidelines may also constitute grounds for other enforcement action by the federal banking regulators, including cease and desist orders and civil money penalty assessments.

 

 
11

 

 

During the past decade, the bank regulatory agencies have increasingly emphasized the importance of sound risk management processes and strong internal controls when evaluating the activities of the institutions they supervise.  Properly managing risks has been identified as critical to the conduct of safe and sound banking activities and has become even more important as new technologies, product innovation, and the size and speed of financial transactions have changed the nature of banking markets.  The agencies have identified a spectrum of risks facing a banking institution including, but not limited to, credit, market, liquidity, operational, legal, and reputational risk. In particular, recent regulatory pronouncements have focused on operational risk, which arises from the potential that inadequate information systems, operational problems, breaches in internal controls, fraud, or unforeseen catastrophes will result in unexpected losses. Each Bank is expected to have active board and senior management oversight; adequate policies, procedures, and limits; adequate risk measurement, monitoring, and management information systems; and comprehensive internal controls.

 

Branching Authority. The Iowa Banks have the authority under Iowa law to establish branches anywhere in the State of Iowa, subject to receipt of all required regulatory approvals. In 1997, the Company formed a de novo Illinois bank that was merged into QCBT, resulting in QCBT establishing a branch office in Illinois. Under Illinois law, QCBT may continue to establish offices in Illinois to the same extent permitted for an Illinois bank (subject to certain conditions, including certain regulatory notice requirements). Similarly, RB&T has the authority under Illinois law to establish branches anywhere in the State of Illinois, subject to receipt of all required regulatory approvals.

 

Federal law permits state and national banks to merge with banks in other states subject to: (i) regulatory approval; (ii) federal and state deposit concentration limits; and (iii) state law limitations requiring the merging bank to have been in existence for a minimum period of time (not to exceed five years) prior to the merger. The establishment of new interstate branches or the acquisition of individual branches of a bank in another state (rather than the acquisition of an out-of-state bank in its entirety) has historically been permitted only in those states the laws of which expressly authorize such expansion. However, the Dodd-Frank Act permits well-capitalized and well-managed banks to establish new branches across state lines without these impediments.

 

State Bank Investments and Activities. The Banks are permitted to make investments and engage in activities directly or through subsidiaries as authorized by Iowa or Illinois law, as applicable. However, under federal law, FDIC-insured state banks are prohibited, subject to certain exceptions, from making or retaining equity investments of a type, or in an amount, that are not permissible for a national bank. Federal law also prohibits FDIC-insured state banks and their subsidiaries, subject to certain exceptions, from engaging as principal in any activity that is not permitted for a national bank unless the bank meets, and continues to meet, its minimum regulatory capital requirements and the FDIC determines that the activity would not pose a significant risk to the DIF. These restrictions have not had, and are not currently expected to have, a material impact on the operations of the Banks.

 

Transaction Account Reserves. Federal Reserve regulations require depository institutions to maintain reserves against their transaction accounts (primarily NOW and regular checking accounts). For 2014: the first $13.3 million of otherwise reservable balances are exempt from the reserve requirements; for transaction accounts aggregating more than $13.3 million to $89.0 million, the reserve requirement is 3% of total transaction accounts; and for net transaction accounts in excess of $89.0 million, the reserve requirement is $2,271,000 plus 10% of the aggregate amount of total transaction accounts in excess of $89.0 million. These reserve requirements are subject to annual adjustment by the Federal Reserve. Each Bank is in compliance with the foregoing requirements.

 

Federal Home Loan Bank System. The Banks are each a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Chicago (the “FHLB”), which serves as a central credit facility for its members. The FHLB is funded primarily from proceeds from the sale of obligations of the FHLB system. It makes loans to member banks in the form of FHLB advances. All advances from the FHLB are required to be fully collateralized as determined by the FHLB.

 

 
12

 

 

Community Reinvestment Act Requirements. The Community Reinvestment Act requires the Banks to have a continuing and affirmative obligation in a safe and sound manner to help meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. Federal regulators regularly assess each Bank’s record of meeting the credit needs of its communities. Applications for additional acquisitions would be affected by the evaluation of the Bank’s effectiveness in meeting its Community Reinvestment Act requirements.

 

Anti-Money Laundering. The Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (the “Patriot Act”) is designed to deny terrorists and criminals the ability to obtain access to the U.S. financial system and has significant implications for depository institutions, brokers, dealers and other businesses involved in the transfer of money. The Patriot Act mandates financial services companies to have policies and procedures with respect to measures designed to address any or all of the following matters: (i) customer identification programs; (ii) money laundering; (iii) terrorist financing; (iv) identifying and reporting suspicious activities and currency transactions; (v) currency crimes; and (vi) cooperation between financial institutions and law enforcement authorities.

 

Commercial Real Estate Guidance. The interagency Concentrations in Commercial Real Estate Lending, Sound Risk Management Practices guidance (“CRE Guidance”) provides supervisory criteria, including the following numerical indicators, to assist bank examiners in identifying banks with potentially significant commercial real estate loan concentrations that may warrant greater supervisory scrutiny: (i) commercial real estate loans exceeding 300% of capital and increasing 50% or more in the preceding three years; or (ii) construction and land development loans exceeding 100% of capital. The CRE Guidance does not limit banks’ levels of commercial real estate lending activities, but rather guides institutions in developing risk management practices and levels of capital that are commensurate with the level and nature of their commercial real estate concentrations. Based on the current loan portfolio of each Bank, these guidelines are not exceeded.

 

Consumer Financial Services

 

There are numerous developments in federal and state laws regarding consumer financial products and services that impact the Banks’ businesses. Importantly, the current structure of federal consumer protection regulation applicable to all providers of consumer financial products and services changed significantly on July 21, 2011, when the CFPB commenced operations to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws. The CFPB has broad rulemaking authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all providers of consumer products and services, including the Banks, as well as the authority to prohibit “unfair, deceptive or abusive” acts and practices. The CFPB has examination and enforcement authority over providers with more than $10 billion in assets. Banks and savings institutions with $10 billion or less in assets, like the Banks, will continue to be examined by their applicable bank regulators. Below are additional recent regulatory developments relating to consumer mortgage lending activities. The Company does not currently expect these provisions to have a significant impact on its operations; however, additional compliance resources will be needed to monitor changes.

 

Ability-to-Repay Requirement and Qualified Mortgage Rule. The Dodd-Frank Act contains additional provisions that affect consumer mortgage lending. First, it significantly expands underwriting requirements applicable to loans secured by 1-4 family residential real property and augments federal law combating predatory lending practices. In addition to numerous new disclosure requirements, the Dodd-Frank Act imposes new standards for mortgage loan originations on all lenders, including banks and savings associations, in an effort to strongly encourage lenders to verify a borrower’s ability to repay, while also establishing a presumption of compliance for certain “qualified mortgages.” In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act generally requires lenders or securitizers to retain an economic interest in the credit risk relating to loans that the lender sells, and other asset-backed securities that the securitizer issues, if the loans have not complied with the ability-to-repay standards. The risk retention requirement generally will be 5%, but could be increased or decreased by regulation.

 

 
13

 

 

On January 10, 2013, the CFPB issued a final rule, effective January 10, 2014, that implements the Dodd-Frank Act’s ability-to-repay requirements and clarifies the presumption of compliance for “qualified mortgages.” In assessing a borrower’s ability to repay a mortgage-related obligation, lenders generally must consider eight underwriting factors: (i) current or reasonably expected income or assets; (ii) current employment status; (iii) monthly payment on the subject transaction; (iv) monthly payment on any simultaneous loan; (v) monthly payment for all mortgage-related obligations; (vi) current debt obligations, alimony, and child support; (vii) monthly debt-to-income ratio or residual income; and (viii) credit history. The final rule also includes guidance regarding the application of, and methodology for evaluating, these factors.

 

Further, the final rule also clarifies that qualified mortgages do not include “no-doc” loans and loans with negative amortization, interest-only payments, balloon payments, terms in excess of 30 years, or points and fees paid by the borrower that exceed 3% of the loan amount, subject to certain exceptions. In addition, for qualified mortgages, the monthly payment must be calculated on the highest payment that will occur in the first five years of the loan, and the borrower’s total debt-to-income ratio generally may not be more than 43%. The final rule also provides that certain mortgages that satisfy the general product feature requirements for qualified mortgages and that also satisfy the underwriting requirements of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac (while they operate under federal conservatorship or receivership), or the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development, Department of Veterans Affairs, or Department of Agriculture or Rural Housing Service, are also considered to be qualified mortgages. This second category of qualified mortgages will phase out as the aforementioned federal agencies issue their own rules regarding qualified mortgages, the conservatorship of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac ends, and, in any event, after seven years.

 

As set forth in the Dodd-Frank Act, subprime (or higher-priced) mortgage loans are subject to the ability-to-repay requirement, and the final rule provides for a rebuttable presumption of lender compliance for those loans. The final rule also applies the ability-to-repay requirement to prime loans, while also providing a conclusive presumption of compliance (i.e., a safe harbor) for prime loans that are also qualified mortgages. Additionally, the final rule generally prohibits prepayment penalties (subject to certain exceptions) and sets forth a 3-year record retention period with respect to documenting and demonstrating the ability-to-repay requirement and other provisions.

 

Changes to Mortgage Loan Originator Compensation. Effective April 2, 2011, previously existing regulations concerning the compensation of mortgage loan originators were amended. As a result of these amendments, mortgage loan originators may not receive compensation based on a mortgage transaction’s terms or conditions other than the amount of credit extended under the mortgage loan. Further, the new standards limit the total points and fees that a bank and/or a broker may charge on conforming and jumbo loans to 3% of the total loan amount. Mortgage loan originators may receive compensation from a consumer or from a lender, but not both. These rules contain requirements designed to prohibit mortgage loan originators from “steering” consumers to loans that provide mortgage loan originators with greater compensation. In addition, the rules contain other requirements concerning recordkeeping.

 

 
14

 

 

Servicing. On January 17, 2013, the CFPB announced rules to implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act relating to mortgage servicing. The new servicing rules require servicers to meet certain benchmarks for loan servicing and customer service in general. Servicers must provide periodic billing statements and certain required notices and acknowledgments, promptly credit borrowers’ accounts for payments received and promptly investigate complaints by borrowers and are required to take additional steps before purchasing insurance to protect the lender’s interest in the property. The new servicing rules also call for additional notice, review and timing requirements with respect to delinquent borrowers, including early intervention, ongoing access to servicer personnel and specific loss mitigation and foreclosure procedures. The rules provide for an exemption from most of these requirements for “small servicers.” A small servicer is defined as a loan servicer that services 5,000 or fewer mortgage loans and services only mortgage loans that they or an affiliate originated or own. The new servicing rules took effect on January 10, 2014. Management is continuing to evaluate the full impact of these rules and their impact on mortgage servicing operations.

 

Foreclosure and Loan Modifications. Federal and state laws further impact foreclosures and loan modifications, with many of such laws having the effect of delaying or impeding the foreclosure process on real estate secured loans in default. Mortgages on commercial property can be modified, such as by reducing the principal amount of the loan or the interest rate, or by extending the term of the loan, through plans confirmed under Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code. In recent years, legislation has been introduced in the U.S. Congress that would amend the Bankruptcy Code to permit the modification of mortgages secured by residences, although at this time the enactment of such legislation is not presently proposed. The scope, duration and terms of potential future legislation with similar effect continue to be discussed. The Company cannot predict whether any such legislation will be passed or the impact, if any, it would have on the Company’s business.

 

Additional Constraints on the Company and Banks

 

Monetary Policy. The monetary policy of the Federal Reserve has a significant effect on the operating results of financial or bank holding companies and their subsidiaries. Among the tools available to the Federal Reserve to affect the money supply are open market transactions in U.S. government securities, changes in the discount rate on member bank borrowings and changes in reserve requirements against member bank deposits. These means are used in varying combinations to influence overall growth and distribution of bank loans, investments and deposits, and their use may affect interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

 

The Volcker Rule. In addition to the other implications of the Dodd-Frank Act discussed above, the Dodd-Frank Act amends the BHCA to require the federal regulatory agencies to adopt rules that prohibit banks and their affiliates from engaging in proprietary trading and investing in and sponsoring certain unregistered investment companies (defined as hedge funds and private equity funds). This statutory provision is commonly called the “Volcker Rule.” On December 10, 2013, the federal regulatory agencies issued final rules to implement the prohibitions required by the Volcker Rule. Thereafter, in reaction to industry concern over the adverse impact to community banks of the treatment of certain collateralized debt instruments in the final rule, the federal regulatory agencies approved an interim final rule to permit banking entities to retain interests in collateralized debt obligations backed primarily by trust preferred securities (“TruPS CDOs”) from the investment prohibitions contained in the final rule. Under the interim final rule, the agencies permit the retention of an interest in or sponsorship of covered funds by banking entities under $15 billion in assets if the following qualifications are met:

 

 

The TruPS CDO was established, and the interest was issued, before May 19, 2010;

 

 

The banking entity reasonably believes that the offering proceeds received by the TruPS CDO were invested primarily in qualifying TruPS collateral; and

 

 

The banking entity's interest in the TruPS CDO was acquired on or before December 10, 2013.

 

Although the Volcker Rule has significant implications for many large financial institutions, the Company does not currently anticipate that the Volcker Rule will have a material effect on the operations of the Company or the Banks. The Company may incur costs if it is required to adopt additional policies and systems to ensure compliance with the Volcker Rule, but any such costs are not expected to be material. Until the application of the final rules is fully understood, the precise financial impact of the rule on the Company, the Banks, their customers or the financial industry more generally, cannot be determined.

 

 
15

 

 

Appendix B

 

GUIDE 3 INFORMATION

 

The following tables and schedules show selected comparative financial information required by the Securities and Exchange Commission Securities Act Guide 3, regarding the business of QCR Holdings, Inc. (the "Company") for the periods shown.

 

I.

Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Stockholders Equity; Interest Rates and Interest Differential A. and B. Consolidated Average Balance Sheets and Analysis of Net Interest Earnings

 

The information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

 

C. Analysis of Changes of Interest Income/Interest Expense

The information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

 
B-1

 

 

II. Investment Portfolio

 

A. Investment Securities

 

The following tables present the amortized cost and fair value of investment securities as of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

           

Gross

   

Gross

         
   

Amortized

   

Unrealized

   

Unrealized

   

Fair

 
   

Cost

   

Gains

   

(Losses)

   

Value

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
                                 

December 31, 2013

                               
                                 

Securities held to maturity:

                               

Municipal securities

  $ 144,402     $ 300     $ (7,112 )   $ 137,590  

Other bonds

    1,050       -       -       1,050  
                                 

Totals

  $ 145,452     $ 300     $ (7,112 )   $ 138,640  
                                 

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. gov't.sponsored agency securities

  $ 376,574     $ 42     $ (20,143 )   $ 356,473  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securitiies

    160,110       1,153       (3,834 )     157,429  

Municipal securities

    35,814       923       (778 )     35,959  

Other securities

    1,372       525       -       1,897  
                                 

Totals

  $ 573,870     $ 2,643     $ (24,755 )   $ 551,758  
                                 

December 31, 2012

                               
                                 

Securities held to maturity:

                               

Municipal securities

  $ 71,429     $ 998     $ (71 )   $ 72,356  

Other bonds

    650       -       -       650  
                                 

Totals

  $ 72,079     $ 998     $ (71 )   $ 73,006  
                                 

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. gov't.sponsored agency securities

  $ 336,571     $ 2,198     $ (160 )   $ 338,609  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securitiies

    160,035       3,737       (171 )     163,601  

Municipal securities

    24,508       1,697       (19 )     26,186  

Trust preferred securities

    86       53       -       139  

Other securities

    1,347       301       (23 )     1,625  
                                 

Totals

  $ 522,547     $ 7,986     $ (373 )   $ 530,160  
                                 

December 31, 2011

                               
                                 

Securities held to maturity:

                               

Other bonds

  $ 200     $ -     $ -     $ 200  
                                 

Totals

  $ 200     $ -     $ -     $ 200  
                                 

Securities available for sale:

                               

U.S. gov't.sponsored agency securities

  $ 426,582     $ 2,429     $ (56 )   $ 428,955  

Residential mortgage-backed and related securitiies

    105,374       3,488       (8 )     108,854  

Municipal securities

    23,937       1,752       -       25,689  

Trust preferred securities

    86       -       (5 )     81  

Other securities

    1,355       140       (45 )     1,450  
                                 

Totals

  $ 557,334     $ 7,809     $ (114 )   $ 565,029  

 

NOTE: Stock of the Federal Home Loan Bank and Federal Reserve Bank are NOT included in the above. The Company carries these investments within restricted investment securities on the consolidated balance sheets. Following is a summary of the carrying value of all of the Company's restricted investment securities as of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011:

 

   

As of December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
                         

Federal Home Loan Bank

  $ 12,344     $ 15,748     $ 11,517  

Federal Reserve Bank

    4,631       3,761       3,737  

Other

    53       -       -  

Totals

  $ 17,028     $ 19,509     $ 15,254  

 

 
B-2

 

 

B. Investment Securities, Maturities, and Yields

 

The following table presents the maturity of securities held on December 31, 2013 and the weighted average stated coupon rates by range of maturity:

 

           

Weighted

 
   

Amortized

   

Average

 
   

Cost

   

Yield

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
                 

U.S. gov't.sponsored agency securities:

               

Within 1 year

  $ 5,131       3.22 %

After 1 but within 5 years

    37,780       1.27 %

After 5 but within 10 years

    331,582       1.88 %

After 10 years

    2,081       4.19 %
                 

Total

  $ 376,574       1.85 %
                 

Residential mortgage-backed and related securities:

               

After 5 but within 10 years

  $ 3,955       3.67 %

After 10 years

    156,155       3.66 %
                 

Total

  $ 160,110       3.66 %
                 

Municipal securities:

               

Within 1 year

  $ 3,536       3.20 %

After 1 but within 5 years

    17,871       2.51 %

After 5 but within 10 years

    45,274       3.16 %

After 10 years

    113,535       3.64 %
                 

Total

  $ 180,216       3.40 %
                 

Other bonds:

               

After 1 but within 5 years

  $ 550       2.81 %

After 5 but within 10 years

    742       3.85 %
                 

Total

  $ 1,292       3.41 %
                 

Other securities with no maturity or stated face rate

  $ 1,130          

 

NOTE: Yields above are NOT computed on a tax equivalent basis.

 

C. As of December 31, 2013, there were no securities with aggregate book value and market value purchased from a single issuer (as defined by Sction 2(4) of the Securities Act of 1933) that exceeded 10% of stockholders' equity.

 

 
B-3

 

 

III. Loan/Lease Portfolio

 

A. Types of Loans/Leases

 

The information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

B. Maturities and Sensitivities of Loans/Leases to Changes in Interest Rates

 

The information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

C. Risk Elements

 

1. Nonaccrual, Past Due and Restructured Loans/Leases

 

The gross interest income that would have been recorded if nonaccrual loans/leases and performing troubled debt restructurings had been current in accordance with their original terms was $600,221 and $23,011 respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2013. The amount of interest collected on nonaccrual loans/leases and performing troubled debt restructurings that was included in interest income was none and $167,356, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2013.

The remaining information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

2. Potential Problem Loans/Leases.

 

To management's best knowledge, there are no such significant loans/leases that have not been disclosed in the table presented in the Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

3. Foreign Outstandings. None.

 

4. Loan/Lease Concentrations.

 

As of December 31, 2013, there was a single concentration of loans/leases exceeding 10% of total loans/leases, which is not otherwise disclosed in Item III. A. That concentration is Lessors of Non-Residential Buildings & Dwellings at 16%.

 

D. Other Interest-Bearing Assets

 

As of December 31, 2013, there are no interest-bearing assets required to be disclosed in this Appendix.

 

 

IV. Summary of Loan/Lease Loss Experience

 

A. Analysis of the Allowance for Estimated Losses on Loans/Leases

 

The information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

B. Allocation of the Allowance for Estimated Losses on Loans/Leases

 

The information requested is disclosed in Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

 
B-4

 

 

V. Deposits.

 

The average amount of and average rate paid for the categories of deposits for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 are included in the consolidated average balance sheets and can be found in the Management's Discussion and Analysis section of the Company's Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.

 

The Company has no deposits by foreign depositors in domestic offices as of December 31, 2013.

 

Included in interest bearing deposits at December 31, 2013, were certificates of deposit totaling $305,326,000 that were $100,000 or greater. Maturities of these certificates were as follows:

 

   

December 31,

 
   

2013

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
         

One to three months

  $ 108,272  

Three to six months

    69,363  

Six to twelve months

    63,739  

Over twelve months

    63,952  
         

Total certificates of deposit greater than $100,000

  $ 305,326  

 

 

VI. Return on Equity and Assets.

 

The following tables present the return on assets and equity and the equity to assets ratio of the Company:

 

   

Years ended

December 31,

 
   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
   

(dollars in thousands)

 
                         

Average total assets

  $ 2,330,604     $ 2,025,691     $ 1,907,038  

Average equity

    145,906       141,793       136,700  

Net income attributable to QCR Holdings, Inc.

    14,938       12,618       9,692  

Return on average assets

    0.64 %     0.62 %     0.51 %

Return on average common equity

    11.48 %     10.84 %     5.82 %

Return on average total equity

    10.24 %     8.90 %     7.09 %

Dividend payout ratio

    3.76 %     4.26 %     8.60 %

Average equity to average assets ratio

    6.26 %     7.00 %     7.17 %

 

 
B-5

 

 

VII. Short Term Borrowings.

 

The following tables present the information requested on short-term borrowings of the Company:

 

Short-term borrowings as of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 are summarized as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
    (dollars in thousands)  

Overnight repurchase agreements with customers

  $ 98,823     $ 104,943     $ 110,236  

Federal funds purchased

    50,470       66,140       103,300  
    $ 149,293     $ 171,083     $ 213,536  

 

Information concerning overnight repurchase agreements with customers is summarized as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
    (dollars in thousands)  

Average daily balance during the period

  $ 123,543     $ 111,782     $ 110,469  

Average daily interest rate during the period

    0.12%       0.13%       0.23%  

Maximum month-end balance during the period

  $ 146,075     $ 141,891     $ 117,902  

Weighted average rate as of end of period

    0.13%       0.11%       0.23%  
                         

Securities underlying the agreements as of end of period:

                       

Carrying value

  $ 143,262     $ 160,951     $ 201,054  

Fair value

    143,262       160,951       201,054  

 

Information concerning federal funds purchased is summarized as follows:

 

   

2013

   

2012

   

2011

 
    (dollars in thousands)  

Average daily balance during the period

  $ 41,157     $ 52,380     $ 33,703  

Average daily interest rate during the period

    0.40%       0.27%       0.27%  

Maximum month-end balance during the period

  $ 95,380     $ 80,150     $ 103,300  

Weighted average rate as of end of period

    0.28%       0.26%       0.22%  

 

 

 B-6